Doc: Fix typo
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.85"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 .new
1990 Exim used to
1991 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1992 withdrawn.
1993 .wen
1994
1995
1996
1997 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1998 .cindex "lookup modules"
1999 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2000 .cindex ".so building"
2001 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2002 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2003 on demand.
2004 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2005 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2006 dependencies.
2007 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2008
2009 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2010 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2011 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2012 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2013 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2014 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2015
2016 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2017 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2018 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2019 on demand:
2020 .code
2021 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2022 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2023 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2024 .endd
2025
2026
2027 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2028 .cindex "build directory"
2029 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2030 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2031 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2032 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2033 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2034 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2035 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2036
2037 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2038 building process fails if it is set.
2039
2040 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2041 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2042 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2043 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2044 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2045 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2046 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2047 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2048
2049 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2050 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2051 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2052
2053
2054
2055 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2056 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2057 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2058 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2059 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2060 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2061 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2062 .code
2063 FULLECHO='' make -e
2064 .endd
2065 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2066 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2067 given in addition to the short output.
2068
2069
2070
2071 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2072 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2073 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2074 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2075 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2076 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2077 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2078 order:
2079 .display
2080 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2081 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile_&
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2084 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2085 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2086 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2087 .endd
2088 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2089 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2090 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2091 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2092 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2093 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2094 and are often not needed.
2095
2096 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2097 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2098 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2099 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2100 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2101 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2102 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2103 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2104 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2105
2106
2107 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2108 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2109 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2110 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2111 default values are.
2112
2113
2114 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2115 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2116 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2117 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2118 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2119 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2120 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2121 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2122 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2123 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2124 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2125 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2126 containing the lines
2127 .code
2128 CC=cc
2129 CFLAGS=-std1
2130 .endd
2131 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2132 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2133
2134 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2135 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2136 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2137
2138
2139 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2141 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2142 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2143 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2144 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2145 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2146 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2147 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2148 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2149 .code
2150 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2151 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2152 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2153 .endd
2154 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2155 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2156 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2157 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2158 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2159 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2160 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2161 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2162 errors.
2163
2164 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2165 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2166 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2167 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2168 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2169 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2170 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2171 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2172 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2173 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2174 syntax. For instance:
2175 .code
2176 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2177 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2178 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2179 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2180 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2181 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2182 .endd
2183
2184 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2185 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2186 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2187 .code
2188 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2189 .endd
2190 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2191 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2192
2193 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2194 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2195 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2196 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2197 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2198 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2199 .code
2200 X11=/usr/X11R6
2201 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2202 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2203 .endd
2204 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2205 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2206 .code
2207 X11=/usr/openwin
2208 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2210 .endd
2211 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2212 definition of all three of these variables into your
2213 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2214
2215 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2216 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2217 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2218 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2219 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2220
2221 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2222 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2223 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2224 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2225 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2226 libraries.
2227
2228 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2229 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2230 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2231 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2232 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2233
2234
2235 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2236 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2237 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2238 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2239 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2240 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2241 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2242 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2243
2244
2245
2246 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2247 .cindex "building Eximon"
2248 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2249 where the files that are involved are
2250 .display
2251 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2252 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2255 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2257 .endd
2258 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2259 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2260 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2261 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2262 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2263 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2264 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2265 .ecindex IIDbuex
2266
2267
2268 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2269 .cindex "installing Exim"
2270 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2271 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2272 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2273 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2274 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2275 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2276 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2277 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2278 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2279 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2280 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2281 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2282
2283 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2284 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2285 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2286 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2287 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2288 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2289 alternative files, no default is installed.
2290
2291 .cindex "system aliases file"
2292 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2293 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2294 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2295 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2296 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2297 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2298 and outputs a comment to the user.
2299
2300 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2301 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2302 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2303 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2304 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2305
2306 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2307 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2308 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2309 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2310 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2311 over SMTP.
2312
2313 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2314 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2315 command such as
2316 .code
2317 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2318 .endd
2319 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2320 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2321 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2322 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2323 but this usage is deprecated.
2324
2325 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2326 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2327 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2328 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2329 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2330 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2331
2332 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2333 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2334 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2335 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2336 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2337 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2338 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2339
2340 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2341 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2342 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2343 command:
2344 .code
2345 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2346 .endd
2347 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2348 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2349 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2350 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2351 command:
2352 .code
2353 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2354 .endd
2355 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2356 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2357
2358 .ilist
2359 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2360 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2361 .next
2362 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2363 installed binary.
2364 .endlist
2365
2366 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2367 .code
2368 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2369 .endd
2370 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2371 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2372 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2373 .code
2374 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2375 .endd
2376
2377
2378
2379 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2380 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2381 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2382 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2383 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2384 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2385
2386 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2387 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2388 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2389
2390
2391
2392 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2393 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2394 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2395 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2396 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2397 necessary.
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2403 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2404 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2405 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2406 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2407 .code
2408 exim -bV
2409 .endd
2410 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2411 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2412 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2413 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2414 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2415 example,
2416 .display
2417 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2418 .endd
2419 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2420 .display
2421 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2422 .endd
2423 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2424 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2425 user agent. For example:
2426 .code
2427 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 From: user@your.domain.example
2429 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2430 Subject: Testing Exim
2431
2432 This is a test message.
2433 ^D
2434 .endd
2435 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2436 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2437 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2438
2439 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2440 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2441 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2442 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2443 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2444 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2445 .display
2446 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2447 .endd
2448 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2449 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2450 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2451 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2452 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2453
2454 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2455 .cindex "lock files"
2456 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2457 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2458 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2459 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2460 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2461 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2462 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2463 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2464 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2465 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2466 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2467 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2468
2469 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2470 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2471 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2472 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2473 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2474 incoming SMTP mail.
2475
2476 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2477 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2478 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2479 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2480 production version.
2481
2482
2483 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2484 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2485 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2486 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2487 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2488 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2489 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2490 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2491 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2492 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2493 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2494 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2495 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2496
2497 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2498 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2499 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2500 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2501 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2502 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2503 as follows:
2504 .code
2505 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2506 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2507 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2508 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2509 .endd
2510 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2511 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2512 favourite user agent.
2513
2514 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2515 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2516 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2517 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2518 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2519 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2520
2521
2522
2523 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2524 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2525 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2526 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2527 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2528 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2529 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2530 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2531 configuration file.
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2537 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2538 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2539 .code
2540 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2541 .endd
2542 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2543 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2544 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2545 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2546 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2547 .code
2548 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2549 .endd
2550 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2551
2552 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2553 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2554 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2561
2562 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2563 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2564 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2565 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2566 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2567 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2568 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2569 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2570 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2571
2572
2573 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2574 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2575 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2576 were present before any other options.
2577 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2578 standard output.
2579 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2580 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2581 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2582
2583 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2586 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2587 format.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2590 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2591 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2592 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2593
2594 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2595 .cindex "queue runner"
2596 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2597 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2598 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2599
2600 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2601 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2602 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2603 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2604 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2605 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2606 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2607 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2608
2609
2610 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2611 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2612 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2613 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2614 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2615 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2616
2617 .ilist
2618 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2619 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2620 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2621 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2622 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2623 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2624
2625 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2626 .cindex "envelope sender"
2627 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2628 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2629 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2630 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2631 users to set envelope senders.
2632
2633 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2634 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2635 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2636 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2637 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2638
2639 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2640 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2641 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2642 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2643 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2644 that are available to trusted users.
2645 .next
2646 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2647 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2648 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2649 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2650 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2651
2652 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2653 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2654 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2655 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2656
2657 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2658 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2659 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2660 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2661
2662 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2663 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2664 false.
2665 .endlist
2666
2667
2668 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2669 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2670 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2671 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2677 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2678 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2679 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2680 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2681 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2682 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2683 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2684
2685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2686 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2687 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2688 . creates a man page for the options.
2689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2690
2691 .literal xml
2692 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2693 .literal off
2694
2695
2696 .vlist
2697 .vitem &%--%&
2698 .oindex "--"
2699 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2700 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2701 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2702 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2703
2704 .vitem &%--help%&
2705 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2706 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2707 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2708 no arguments.
2709
2710 .vitem &%--version%&
2711 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2712 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2713 displayed.
2714
2715 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2716 &%-Am%&
2717 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2718 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2719 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2720 ignored by Exim.
2721
2722 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2723 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2724 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2725 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2726 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2727 clean; it ignores this option.
2728
2729 .vitem &%-bd%&
2730 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2731 .cindex "daemon"
2732 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2733 .cindex "queue runner"
2734 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2735 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2736 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2737
2738 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2739 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2740 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2741 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2742
2743 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2744 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2745 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2746 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2747
2748 When a listening daemon
2749 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2750 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2751 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2752 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2753 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2754 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2755 running as root.
2756
2757 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2758 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2759 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2760
2761 The SIGHUP signal
2762 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2763 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2764 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2765 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2766 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2767 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2768 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2769 because these are reread each time they are used.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2772 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2773 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2774 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2775
2776 .vitem &%-be%&
2777 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2778 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2779 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2780 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2781 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2782 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2783 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2784
2785 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2786 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2787 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2788 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2789 test data. A line history is supported.
2790
2791 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2792 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2793 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2794 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2795 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2796 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2797 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2798
2799 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2800 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2801 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2802 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2803
2804 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2805 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2806 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2807 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2808 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2809 of a file. For example:
2810 .code
2811 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2812 .endd
2813 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2814 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2815 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2816 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2817 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2818 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2819 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2820 &%-be%&).
2821
2822 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2823 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2824 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2825 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2826 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2827 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2828 system filters are recognized.
2829
2830 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2831 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2832 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2834 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2835 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2836 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2837 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2838 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2839 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2840 supplied.
2841
2842 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2843 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2844 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2845 .code
2846 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2847 .endd
2848 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2849 variables that are used by the user filter.
2850
2851 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2852 .code
2853 # Exim filter
2854 # Sieve filter
2855 .endd
2856 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2857 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2858 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2859 redirection lists.
2860
2861 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2862 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2863 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2864 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2865
2866 When testing a filter file,
2867 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2868 .cindex "envelope sender"
2869 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2870 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2871 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2872 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2873 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2874 options).
2875
2876 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2877 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2878 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2879 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2880 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2881 &$qualify_domain$&.
2882
2883 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2884 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2885 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2886 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2887 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2888 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2889 actually being delivered.
2890
2891 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2892 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2893 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2894 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2895 prefix.
2896
2897 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2898 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2899 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2900 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2901 suffix.
2902
2903 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2904 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2905 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2906 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2907 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2908 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2909 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2910 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2911 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2912 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2913 after a full stop. For example:
2914 .code
2915 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2916 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2917 .endd
2918 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2919 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2920 conversion to the canonical form is
2921 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2922
2923 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2924 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2925 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2926 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2927 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2928
2929 &*Warning 1*&:
2930 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2931 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2932 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2933 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2934 connection.
2935
2936 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2937 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2938 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2939
2940 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2941 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2942 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2943 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2944 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2945 session were authenticated.
2946
2947 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2948 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2949 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2950
2951 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2952 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2953 specialized SMTP test program such as
2954 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2955
2956 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2957 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2958 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2959 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2960 updating the callout cache database.
2961
2962 .vitem &%-bi%&
2963 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2964 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2965 .cindex "building alias file"
2966 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2967 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2968 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2969 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2970 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2971 recognized.
2972
2973 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2974 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2975 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2976 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2977 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2978 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2979 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2980
2981 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2982 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2983 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2984 .cindex "querying exim information"
2985 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2986 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2987 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2988 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2989 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2990
2991 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2992 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2993 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2994 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2995 recognised DSCP names.
2996
2997 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2998 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2999 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3000 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3001 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3002 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3003 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3004 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3005 way to guarantee a correct response.
3006
3007 .vitem &%-bm%&
3008 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3009 .cindex "local message reception"
3010 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3011 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3012 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3013 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3014 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3015 if no other conflicting option is present.
3016
3017 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3018 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3019 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3020 suppressing this for special cases.
3021
3022 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3023 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3024
3025 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3026 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3027 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3028
3029 The format
3030 .cindex "message" "format"
3031 .cindex "format" "message"
3032 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3033 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3034 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3035 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3036 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3037 .code
3038 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3039 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3040 .endd
3041 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3042 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3043 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3044 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3045 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3046
3047 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3048 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3049 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3050 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3051 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3052
3053 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3054 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3055 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3056 .cindex "malware scan test"
3057 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3058 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3059 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3060 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3061 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3062 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3063
3064 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3065 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3066 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3067 This option requires admin privileges.
3068
3069 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3070 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3071 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3072
3073 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3074 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3075 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3076 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3077 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3078 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3079 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3080 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3081 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3082
3083 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3084 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3085 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3086 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3087 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3088
3089 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3090 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3091 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3092 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3093
3094
3095 .vitem &%-bP%&
3096 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3097 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3098 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3099 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3100 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3101 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3102 arguments, for example:
3103 .code
3104 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3105 .endd
3106 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3107 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3108 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3109 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3110 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3111 users, the output is as in this example:
3112 .code
3113 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3114 .endd
3115 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3116 configuration file is output.
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3123
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3131
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133 .code
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3135 .endd
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3145 .code
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147 .endd
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 &%authenticators%&.
3154
3155 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3156 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3157 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3158 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3159 The output format is one item per line.
3160
3161 .vitem &%-bp%&
3162 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3163 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3164 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3165 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3166 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3167 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3168 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3169 to allow any user to see the queue.
3170
3171 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3172 .code
3173 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3174 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3175 <other addresses>
3176 .endd
3177 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3178 .cindex "size" "of message"
3179 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3180 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3181 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3182 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3183 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3184 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3185 before the sender address.
3186
3187 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3188 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3189 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3190
3191 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3192 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3193 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3194 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3195 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3196 complete.
3197
3198
3199 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3200 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3201 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3202 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3203 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3204 of just &"D"&.
3205
3206
3207 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3208 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3209 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3210 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3211 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3212 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3213
3214
3215 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3216 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3217 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3218 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3219 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3220 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3221
3222 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3223 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3224 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3225
3226 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3227 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3228 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3229
3230
3231 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3232 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3233 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3234 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3235 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3236 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3237
3238
3239 .vitem &%-brt%&
3240 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3241 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3242 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3243 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3244 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3245 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3246 .code
3247 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3248 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3249 .endd
3250 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3251 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3252 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3253 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3254 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3255 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3256 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3257 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3258 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3259 .code
3260 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3261 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3262 .endd
3263
3264 .vitem &%-brw%&
3265 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3266 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3267 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3268 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3269 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3270 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3271 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3272 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3273
3274 .vitem &%-bS%&
3275 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3276 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3277 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3278 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3279 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3280 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3281 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3282 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3283 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3284 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3285
3286 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3287 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3288 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3289
3290 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3291 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3292 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3293 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3294
3295 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3296 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3297 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3298
3299 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3300 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3301 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3302 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3303 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3304
3305 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3306 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3307
3308 .vitem &%-bs%&
3309 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3310 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3311 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3312 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3313 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3314 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3315 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3316 messages to the MTA.
3317
3318 In
3319 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3320 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3321 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3322 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3323 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3324 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3325 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3326
3327 .cindex "inetd"
3328 The
3329 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3330 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3331 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3332 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3333 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3334 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3335 the listening daemon.
3336
3337 .vitem &%-bt%&
3338 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3339 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3340 .cindex "address" "testing"
3341 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3342 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3343 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3344 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3345 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3346
3347 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3348 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3349
3350 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3351 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3352 security issues.
3353
3354 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3355 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3356 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3357 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3358 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3359 program.
3360
3361 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3362 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3363 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3364 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3365
3366 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3367 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3368 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3369 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3370 always shown.
3371
3372 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3373 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3374 message,
3375 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3376 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3377 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3378 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3379 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3380 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3381 doing such tests.
3382
3383 .vitem &%-bV%&
3384 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3385 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3386 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3387 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3388 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3389 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3390 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3391
3392 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3393 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3394 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3395 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3396 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3397 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3398 dynamic testing facilities.
3399
3400 .vitem &%-bv%&
3401 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3402 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3403 .cindex "address" "verification"
3404 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3405 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3406 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3407 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3408 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3409 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3410
3411 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3412 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3413 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3414
3415 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3416 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3417
3418 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3419 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3420 security issues.
3421
3422 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3423 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3424 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3425 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3426 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3427
3428 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3429 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3430 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3431 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3432 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3433 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3434 to succeed.
3435
3436 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3437 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3438 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3439
3440 The
3441 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3442 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3443 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3444 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3445
3446 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3447 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3448 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3449 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3450
3451 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3452 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3453 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3454 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3455 might happen.
3456
3457 .vitem &%-bw%&
3458 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3459 .cindex "daemon"
3460 .cindex "inetd"
3461 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3462 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3463 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3464 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3465
3466 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3467 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3468 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3469 each port only when the first connection is received.
3470
3471 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3472 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3473
3474 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3475 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3476 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3477 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3478 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3479 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3480 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3481 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3482 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3483 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3484 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3485
3486 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3487 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3488 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3489 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3490 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3491 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3492 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3493 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3494 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3495
3496 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3497 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3498 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3499 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3500 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3501 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3502 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3503
3504 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3505 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3506 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3507 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3508 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3509 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3510 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3511
3512 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3513 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3514 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3515 configuration file.
3516
3517 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3518 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3519 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3520 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3521 specified by this option.
3522
3523
3524 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3525 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3526 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3527 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3528 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3529 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3530 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3531 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3532
3533 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3534 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3535 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3536 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3537 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3538 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3539 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3540
3541 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3542 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3543 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3544 synonymous:
3545 .code
3546 exim -DABC ...
3547 exim -DABC= ...
3548 .endd
3549 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3550 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3551 example:
3552 .code
3553 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3554 .endd
3555 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3556
3557
3558 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3559 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3560 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3561 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3562 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3563 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3564 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3565 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3566 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3567 return code.
3568
3569 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3570 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3571 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3572 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3573 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3574 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3575 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3576 are:
3577 .display
3578 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3579 &`auth `& authenticators
3580 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3581 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3582 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3583 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3584 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3585 &`filter `& filter handling
3586 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3587 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3588 &`ident `& ident lookup
3589 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3590 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3591 &`load `& system load checks
3592 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3593 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3594 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3595 &`memory `& memory handling
3596 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3597 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3598 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3599 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3600 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3601 &`retry `& retry handling
3602 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3603 &`route `& address routing
3604 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3605 &`tls `& TLS logic
3606 &`transport `& transports
3607 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3608 &`verify `& address verification logic
3609 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3610 .endd
3611 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3612 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3613 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3614 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3615 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3616 turn everything off.
3617
3618 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3619 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3620 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3621 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3622 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3623 rather than stderr.
3624
3625 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3626 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3627 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3628 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3629 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3630 run in parallel.
3631
3632 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3633 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3634 in processing.
3635
3636 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3637 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3638
3639 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3640 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3641 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3642 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3643 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3644 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3645
3646 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3647 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3648 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3649 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3650 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3651
3652 .vitem &%-E%&
3653 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3654 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3655 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3656 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3657 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3658 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3659 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3660 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3661 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3662
3663 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3664 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3665 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3666 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3667 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3668 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3669
3670 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3671 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3672 .cindex "sender" "name"
3673 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3674 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3675 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3676 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3677 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3678 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3679
3680 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3681 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3682 .cindex "sender" "address"
3683 .cindex "address" "sender"
3684 .cindex "trusted users"
3685 .cindex "envelope sender"
3686 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3687 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3688 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3689 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3690 users to use it.
3691
3692 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3693 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3694 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3695 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3696 domain.
3697
3698 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3699 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3700 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3701 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3702 examples of shell commands:
3703 .code
3704 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3705 exim -f "" user@domain
3706 .endd
3707 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3708 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3709 &%-bv%& options.
3710
3711 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3712 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3713 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3714 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3715
3716 White
3717 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3718 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3719 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3720 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3721 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3722 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3723
3724 .vitem &%-G%&
3725 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3726 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3727 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3728 .code
3729 control = suppress_local_fixups
3730 .endd
3731 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3732 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3733 in future.
3734
3735 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3736 this option.
3737
3738 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3739 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3740 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3741 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3742 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3743 headers.)
3744
3745 .vitem &%-i%&
3746 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3747 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3748 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3749 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3750 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3751 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3752 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3753
3754 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3755 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3756 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3757 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3758 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3759 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3760 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3761 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3762
3763 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3764
3765 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3766 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3767 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3768 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3769 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3770 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3771 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3772 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3773 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3774
3775 Retry
3776 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3777 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3778 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3779 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3780 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3781 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3782
3783 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3784 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3785 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3786 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3787
3788 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3789 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3790 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3791 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3792 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3793 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3794 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3795 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3796 can be used only by an admin user.
3797
3798 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3799 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3800 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3801 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3802 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3803 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3804 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3805 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3806 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3807 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3808 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3809
3810 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3811 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3812 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3813 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3814 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3815
3816 .new
3817 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3818 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3821 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3822 .wen
3823
3824 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3825 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3826 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3827 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3828 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3829
3830 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3831 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3832 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3833 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3834 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3835 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3836 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3837 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3844 connection.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3847 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3850 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3851
3852 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3853 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3854 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3855 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3856 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3857 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3858 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3859 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3860 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3861 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3862 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3863 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3864 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3865 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3866 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3869 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3870 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3871 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3872 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3873 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3874 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3875 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3876 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3877 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878
3879 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3881 .cindex "freezing messages"
3882 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3884 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3885 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3886 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3887 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3888 user.
3889
3890 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3892 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3893 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3895 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3896 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3897 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3898 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3899 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3900 user.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3904 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3906 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3907 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3908 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3909
3910 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3911 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3912 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3913 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3914 .cindex "removing recipients"
3915 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3916 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3917 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3918 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3919 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3920 can be used only by an admin user.
3921
3922 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3923 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3924 .cindex "removing messages"
3925 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3926 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3927 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3928 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3929 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3930 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3931 placed on the queue.
3932
3933 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3934 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3935 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3936 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3937 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3938 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3939 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3940 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3941 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3942 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3943 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3944
3945 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3947 .cindex "thawing messages"
3948 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3949 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3950 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3951 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3952 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3953 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3954 by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3958 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3959 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3960 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3961 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962
3963 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3967 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3968 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3969 only by an admin user.
3970
3971 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3972 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3973 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3974 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3977 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3981 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3984 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-m%&
3987 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3988 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3989 treats it that way too.
3990
3991 .vitem &%-N%&
3992 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3993 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3994 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3995 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3996 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3997 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3998 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3999 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4000 than &"=>"&.
4001
4002 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4003 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4004 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4005 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4006 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4007 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4008 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4009 for that message.
4010
4011 .vitem &%-n%&
4012 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4013 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4014 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4015 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4016
4017 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4018 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4019 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4020 Exim.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4024 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4025 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4026 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4027 description above.
4028
4029 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4030 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4031 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4032 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4033 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4034 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4035 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4036 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-odb%&
4039 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4040 .cindex "background delivery"
4041 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4042 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4043 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4044 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4045 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4046 processes to finish.
4047
4048 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4049 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4050 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4051 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4052
4053 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4054 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4055 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4056 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4057
4058 .vitem &%-odf%&
4059 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4060 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4061 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4062 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4063 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4064 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4065 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4066
4067 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4068 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4069 during deliveries.
4070
4071 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4072 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4073
4074 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4075 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4076 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4077 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4078
4079
4080 .vitem &%-odi%&
4081 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4082 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4083 Sendmail.
4084
4085 .vitem &%-odq%&
4086 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4087 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4088 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4089 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4090 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4091 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4092 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4093 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4094 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4095 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4096 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4097 forces queueing.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4100 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4102 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4103 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4104 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4105 configuration file is in effect.
4106
4107 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4108 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4109 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4110 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4111 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4112 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4113 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4114 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4115 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4116 &%-qq%& option.
4117
4118 .vitem &%-oee%&
4119 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4120 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4121 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4122 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4123 message.
4124
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4126 Provided
4127 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4128 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4129 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4130 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4131
4132 .vitem &%-oem%&
4133 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4134 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4136 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4137 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4138 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4139
4140 .vitem &%-oep%&
4141 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4142 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4143 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4144 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4145 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4146 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4147
4148 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4149 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4150 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4151 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152 effect as &%-oep%&.
4153
4154 .vitem &%-oew%&
4155 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4156 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4157 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4158 effect as &%-oem%&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oi%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4162 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4163 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4164 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4165 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4166 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4167 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4170 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4171 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4172
4173 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4174 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4175 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4176 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4177 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4178 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4179 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4180 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4181
4182 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4183 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4184 .code
4185 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4186 .endd
4187 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4188 followed by a colon and the port number:
4189 .code
4190 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4191 .endd
4192 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4193 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4194 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4195 whichever one is last.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4199 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4200 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4201 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4202 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4203 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4204 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4205
4206 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4207 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4208 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4209 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4210 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4211 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4212 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4213 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4214
4215 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4216 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4217 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4219 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4220 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4221 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4222 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4223 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4224 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4225
4226 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4227 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4228 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4229 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4230 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4231 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4232 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4236 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4238 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4239 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4240 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4241 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4242 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4243
4244 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4245 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4246 is sending the bounce.
4247
4248 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4249 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4250 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4251 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4252 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4253 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4254 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4255 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4256 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4257 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4258 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4259 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4260
4261 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4262 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4263 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4264 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4265 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4266 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4267 uses the name it is given.
4268
4269 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4270 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4271 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4272 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4273 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4274 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4275 used, when there is no default.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-om%&
4278 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4280 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4281 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4282 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-oo%&
4285 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4286 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4287 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4288 whatever that means.
4289
4290 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4291 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4292 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4293 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4294 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4295 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4296 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4297 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4298 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4299
4300 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4301 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4302 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4303 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4304 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4305 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4306 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4309 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4310 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4311 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4312 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4313 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4314 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4315 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4316
4317 .vitem &%-ov%&
4318 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4319 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4322 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4323 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4324 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4325 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4326 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4327 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4328 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4329 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4330 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-pd%&
4333 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4334 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4335 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4336 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4337 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4338 needed.
4339
4340 .vitem &%-ps%&
4341 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4342 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4343 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4344 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4345 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4346 started.
4347
4348 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4349 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4350 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4351 .display
4352 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4353 .endd
4354 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4355 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4356 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4357 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4358 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4359
4360 .vitem &%-q%&
4361 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4362 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4363 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4364 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4365 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4366 and &%-S%& options).
4367
4368 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4369 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4370 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4371 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4372 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4373 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4374
4375 If
4376 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4377 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4378 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4379 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4380 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4381 proceeding.
4382
4383 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4384 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4385 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4386 this to be repeated periodically.
4387
4388 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4389 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4390 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4391 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4392
4393 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4394 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4395 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4396
4397 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4398 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4399 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4400 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4403 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4404 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4405 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4406 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4407 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4408 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4409 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4410 transports are run.
4411
4412 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4413 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4414 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4415 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4416 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4417 delivered down a single SMTP
4418 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4419 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4420 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4421 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4422 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4423 intermittently.
4424
4425 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4426 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4427 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4428 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4429 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4430 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4431 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4432
4433 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4434 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4435 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4436 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4437 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4438 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4439 their retry times are tried.
4440
4441 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4442 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4443 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4444 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4445 frozen or not.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4448 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4449 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4450 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4451 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4452 for later delivery.
4453
4454 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4455 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4456 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4457 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4458 starting message id. For example:
4459 .code
4460 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4461 .endd
4462 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4463 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4464 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4465 .code
4466 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4467 .endd
4468 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4469 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4470 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4471 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4472 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4473 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4474
4475 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4476 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4477 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4478 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4479 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4480 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4481 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4482 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4483 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4484 .code
4485 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4486 .endd
4487 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4488 process every 30 minutes.
4489
4490 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4491 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4492
4493 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4494 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4495 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4496 compatibility.
4497
4498 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4500 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4501
4502 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4503 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4504 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4505 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4506 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4507 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4508 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4509 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4510 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4511
4512 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4513 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4514 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4515 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4516 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4517 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4518
4519 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4520 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4521 .code
4522 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4523 .endd
4524 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4525 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4526 applied to each queue run.
4527
4528 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4529 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4530 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4531 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4532 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4533 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4534 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4535 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4536 address will be skipped.
4537
4538 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4539 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4540 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4541 &'ff'& is present.
4542
4543 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4544 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4545 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4546 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4547 an arbitrary command instead.
4548
4549 .vitem &%-r%&
4550 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4551 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4552
4553 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4554 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4555 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4556 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4557 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4558 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4559 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4560 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4561
4562 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4563 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4564 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4565 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4566 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4567
4568 .vitem &%-t%&
4569 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4570 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4571 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4572 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4573 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4574 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4575 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4576 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4577 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4578 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4579
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4581 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4582 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4583 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4584 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4585 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4586 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4587 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4588 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4589 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4590 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4591
4592 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4593 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4594 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4595 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4596 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4597 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4598
4599 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4600 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4601 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4602 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4603 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4604 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4605 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4606 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4607 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4608
4609 .vitem &%-ti%&
4610 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4611 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4612 compatibility with Sendmail.
4613
4614 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4615 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4616 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4617 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4618 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4619 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4620 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4621 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4622
4623
4624 .vitem &%-U%&
4625 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4626 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4627 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4628 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4629 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4630 set. Exim ignores this option.
4631
4632 .vitem &%-v%&
4633 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4634 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4635 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4636 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4637 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4638 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4639 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4640 unconditional.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-x%&
4643 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4644 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4645 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4646 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4647 this option.
4648
4649 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4650 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4651 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4652 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4653
4654 .new
4655 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4656 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4657 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4658 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4659 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4660 under most shells.
4661 .wen
4662 .endlist
4663
4664 .ecindex IIDclo1
4665 .ecindex IIDclo2
4666
4667
4668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4669 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4670 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4671 . creates a man page for the options.
4672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4673
4674 .literal xml
4675 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4676 .literal off
4677
4678
4679
4680
4681
4682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4684
4685
4686 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4687 "The runtime configuration file"
4688
4689 .cindex "run time configuration"
4690 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4691 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4692 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4693 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4694 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4695 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4696 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4697 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4698 control.
4699
4700 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4701 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4702 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4703 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4704 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4705 actually alter the string.
4706
4707 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4708 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4709 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4710 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4711 existing file in the list.
4712
4713 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4714 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4715 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4716 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4717 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4718 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4719 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4720 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4721 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4722 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4723 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4724
4725 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4726 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4727 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4728 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4729 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4730
4731 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4732 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4733 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4734 compromise the Exim user account.
4735
4736 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4737 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4738 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4739 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4740 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4741 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4742 configuration.
4743
4744
4745
4746 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4747 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4748 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4749 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4750 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4751 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4752 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4753 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4754 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4755 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4756 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4757
4758 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4759 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4760 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4761 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4762 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4763 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4764 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4765 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4766 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4767 &%-M%&).
4768
4769 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4770 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4771 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4772 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4773 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4774
4775 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4776 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4777 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4778 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4779 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4780 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4781
4782 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4783 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4784 necessarily be discarded.
4785 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4786 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4787 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4788 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4789 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4790 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4791
4792 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4793 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4794 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4795 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4796 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4797 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4798 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4799
4800 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4801 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4802 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4803
4804
4805
4806 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4807 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4808 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4809 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4810 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4811 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4812 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4813 optional parts are:
4814
4815 .ilist
4816 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4817 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4818 .next
4819 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4820 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4821 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4822 .next
4823 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4824 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4825 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4826 .next
4827 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4828 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4829 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4830 .next
4831 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4832 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4833 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4834 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4835 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4836 .next
4837 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4838 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4839 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4840 .next
4841 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4842 want to use this feature, you must set
4843 .code
4844 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4845 .endd
4846 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4847 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4848 .endlist
4849
4850 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4851 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4852 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4853 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4854
4855 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4856 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4857 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4858 and does not introduce a comment.
4859
4860 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4861 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4862 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4863 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4864 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4865
4866 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4867 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4868 change settings as required.
4869
4870 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4871 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4872 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4873 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4874 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4875 described.
4876
4877
4878
4879 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4880 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4881 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4882 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4883 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4884 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4885 using this syntax:
4886 .display
4887 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4888 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4889 .endd
4890 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4891 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4892 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4893 name is required.
4894
4895 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4896 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4897 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4898 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4899
4900 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4901 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4902 for example:
4903 .code
4904 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4905 .include /some/file
4906 .endd
4907 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4908 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4909 inclusion appears.
4910
4911
4912
4913 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4914 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4915 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4916 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4917 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4918 definition, and must be of the form
4919 .display
4920 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4921 .endd
4922 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4923 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4924 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4925 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4926 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4927
4928 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4929 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4930 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4931
4932 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4933 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4934 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4935 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4936 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4937 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4938 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4939 define
4940 .display
4941 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4942 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4943 .endd
4944 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4945 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4946 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4947 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4948 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4949 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4950
4951
4952 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4953 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4954 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4955 &'='&. For example:
4956 .code
4957 MAC = initial value
4958 ...
4959 MAC == updated value
4960 .endd
4961 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4962 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4963 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4964 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4965 .code
4966 MAC = initial value
4967 ...
4968 MAC == MAC and something added
4969 .endd
4970 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4971 from a number of other files.
4972
4973 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4974 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4975 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4976 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4977 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4978 file to be ignored.
4979
4980
4981
4982 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4983 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4984 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4985 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4986 .code
4987 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4988 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4989 .endd
4990 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4991 .code
4992 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4993 .endd
4994 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4995 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4996 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4997
4998
4999 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5000 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5001 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5002 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5003 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5004 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5005 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5006
5007 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5008 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5009 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5010 line. Thus:
5011 .code
5012 .ifdef AAA
5013 message_size_limit = 50M
5014 .else
5015 message_size_limit = 100M
5016 .endif
5017 .endd
5018 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5019 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5020 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5021 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5022 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5023
5024 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5025 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5026 in this line"& will always be true.
5027
5028 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5029 to clarify complicated nestings.
5030
5031
5032
5033 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5034 .cindex "common option syntax"
5035 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5036 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5037 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5038 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5039 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5040 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5041 space) and then the value. For example:
5042 .code
5043 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5044 .endd
5045 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5046 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5047 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5048 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5049 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5050 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5051 word &"hide"&. For example:
5052 .code
5053 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5054 .endd
5055 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5056 .code
5057 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5058 .endd
5059 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5060 all instances of the same driver.
5061
5062 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5063 that are found in option settings.
5064
5065
5066 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5067 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5068 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5069 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5070 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5071 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5072 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5073 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5074 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5075 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5076 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5077 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5078 .code
5079 queue_only
5080 queue_only = true
5081 .endd
5082 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5083 .code
5084 no_queue_only
5085 queue_only = false
5086 .endd
5087 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5088
5089
5090
5091
5092 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5093 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5094 .cindex "format" "integer"
5095 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5096 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5097 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5098 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5099 hexadecimal number.
5100
5101 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5102 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5103 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5104 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5105 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5106 used.
5107
5108
5109 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5110 .cindex "integer format"
5111 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5112 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5113 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5114 Such options are always output in octal.
5115
5116
5117 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5118 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5119 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5120 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5121 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5122
5123
5124
5125 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5126 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5127 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5128 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5129 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5130
5131 .table2 30pt
5132 .irow &%s%& seconds
5133 .irow &%m%& minutes
5134 .irow &%h%& hours
5135 .irow &%d%& days
5136 .irow &%w%& weeks
5137 .endtable
5138
5139 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5140 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5141 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5142
5143
5144
5145 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5146 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5147 .cindex "format" "string"
5148 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5149 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5150 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5151 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5152 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5153 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5154 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5155 therefore equivalent:
5156 .code
5157 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5158 trusted_users = uucp:\
5159 # This comment line is ignored
5160 mail
5161 .endd
5162 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5163 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5164 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5165 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5166 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5167
5168 .table2 100pt
5169 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5170 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5171 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5172 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5173 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5174 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5175 character"
5176 .endtable
5177
5178 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5179 character, that character replaces the pair.
5180
5181 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5182 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5183 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5184 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5185 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5186 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5187
5188
5189 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5190 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5191 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5192 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5193 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5194 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5195 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5196 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5197 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5198 within a quoted configuration string.
5199
5200
5201 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5202 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5203 .cindex "format" "user name"
5204 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5205 .cindex "format" "group name"
5206 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5207 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5208 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5209 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5210
5211
5212 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5213 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5214 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5215 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5216 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5217 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5218 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5219 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5220 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5221 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5222 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5223
5224 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5225 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5226 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5227 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5228 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5229 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5230 example, the list
5231 .code
5232 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5233 .endd
5234 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5235
5236 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5237 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5238 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5239 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5240
5241 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5242 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5243 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5244 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5245 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5246 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5247 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5248 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5249 .code
5250 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5251 .endd
5252 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5253 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5254 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5255
5256 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5257 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5258 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5259 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5260 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5261 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5262 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5263 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5264 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5265 .code
5266 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5267 .endd
5268 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5269 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5270 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5271 the value in quotes. For example:
5272 .code
5273 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5274 .endd
5275 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5276 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5277 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5278 enclosing an empty list item.
5279
5280
5281
5282 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5283 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5284 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5285 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5286 .code
5287 senders = user@domain :
5288 .endd
5289 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5290 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5291 items, the second of which is empty:
5292 .code
5293 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5294 .endd
5295 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5296 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5297 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5298 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5299 .code
5300 senders = :
5301 .endd
5302 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5303 is at the end of the list.
5304
5305
5306
5307
5308 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5309 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5310 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5311 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5312 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5313 a sequence of lines like this:
5314 .display
5315 <&'instance name'&>:
5316 <&'option'&>
5317 ...
5318 <&'option'&>
5319 .endd
5320 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5321 followed by three options settings:
5322 .code
5323 localuser:
5324 driver = accept
5325 check_local_user
5326 transport = local_delivery
5327 .endd
5328 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5329 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5330 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5331 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5332 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5333 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5334
5335 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5336 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5337
5338 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5339 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5340 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5341 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5342 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5343 server.
5344
5345 .cindex "generic options"
5346 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5347 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5348 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5349 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5350 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5351 .cindex "private options"
5352 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5353 they all have default values.
5354
5355 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5356 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5357 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5358
5359 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5360 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5361 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5362 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5363 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5364 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5365 configuration lines:
5366 .code
5367 remote_smtp:
5368 driver = smtp
5369 .endd
5370 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5371 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5372 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5373 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5374 thus:
5375 .code
5376 special_smtp:
5377 driver = smtp
5378 port = 1234
5379 command_timeout = 10s
5380 .endd
5381 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5382 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5383 lines.
5384
5385 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5386 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5387 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5388 option.
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393
5394
5395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5397
5398 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5399 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5400 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5401 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5402 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5403 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5404 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5405 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5406 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5407 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5408 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5409
5410
5411
5412 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5413 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5414 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5415 the line
5416 .code
5417 # primary_hostname =
5418 .endd
5419 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5420 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5421 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5422 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5423
5424 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5425 .code
5426 domainlist local_domains = @
5427 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5428 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5429 .endd
5430 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5431 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5432 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5433 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5434
5435 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5436 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5437 on the local host.
5438
5439 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5440 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5441 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5442 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5443 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5444 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5445
5446 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5447 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5448 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5449 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5450 domain is permitted.
5451
5452 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5453 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5454 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5455 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5456 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5457 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5458
5459 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5460 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5461 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5462
5463 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5464 .code
5465 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5466 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5467 .endd
5468 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5469 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5470 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5471 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5472 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5473 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5474 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5475 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5476 contents of a message to be checked.
5477
5478 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5479 .code
5480 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5481 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5482 .endd
5483 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5484 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5485 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5486 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5487
5488 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5489 .code
5490 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5491 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5492 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5493 .endd
5494 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5495 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5496 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5497 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5498 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5499 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5500 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5501
5502 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5503 .code
5504 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5505 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5506 .endd
5507 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5508 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5509 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5510 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5511 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5512 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5513 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5514 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5515 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5516 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5517 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5518 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5519 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5520 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5521 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5522 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5523
5524 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5525 .code
5526 # qualify_domain =
5527 # qualify_recipient =
5528 .endd
5529 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5530 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5531 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5532 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5533 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5534 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5535
5536 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5537 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5538 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5539 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5540 .code
5541 # allow_domain_literals
5542 .endd
5543 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5544 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5545 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5546 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5547 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5548 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5549
5550 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5551 .code
5552 never_users = root
5553 .endd
5554 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5555 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5556 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5557 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5558 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5559 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5560 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5561 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5562
5563 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5564 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5565 line,
5566 .code
5567 host_lookup = *
5568 .endd
5569 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5570 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5571 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5572 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5573 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5574 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5575 unreachable.
5576
5577 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5578 1413 (hence their names):
5579 .code
5580 rfc1413_hosts = *
5581 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5582 .endd
5583 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5584 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5585 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5586 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5587 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5588 information, you can change this.
5589
5590 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5591 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5592 .code
5593 prdr_enable = true
5594 .endd
5595
5596 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5597 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5598 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5599 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5600 .code
5601 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5602 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5603 .endd
5604 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5605 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5606
5607 .new
5608 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5609 over the default:
5610 .code
5611 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5612 +tls_certificate_verified
5613 .endd
5614 .wen
5615
5616 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5617 .code
5618 # percent_hack_domains =
5619 .endd
5620 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5621 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5622 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5623
5624 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5625 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5626 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5627 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5628 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5629 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5630 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5631 always bounce messages.
5632 .code
5633 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5634 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5635 .endd
5636 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5637 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5638 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5639 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5640 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5641
5642
5643
5644 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5645 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5646 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5647 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5648 It starts with the line
5649 .code
5650 begin acl
5651 .endd
5652 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5653 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5654 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5655
5656 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5657 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5658 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5659 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5660 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5661 result of the ACL processing.
5662 .code
5663 acl_check_rcpt:
5664 .endd
5665 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5666 ACL, and names it.
5667 .code
5668 accept hosts = :
5669 .endd
5670 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5671 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5672 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5673 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5674 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5675 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5676
5677 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5678 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5679 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5680 manner.
5681 .code
5682 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5683 domains = +local_domains
5684 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5685
5686 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5687 domains = !+local_domains
5688 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5689 .endd
5690 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5691 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5692 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5693 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5694 in Internet mail addresses.
5695
5696 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5697 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5698 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5699 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5700 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5701 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5702 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5703 policy of being as safe as possible.
5704
5705 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5706 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5707 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5708 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5709 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5710 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5711
5712 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5713 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5714 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5715 have to modify this rule.
5716
5717 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5718 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5719 common convention of local parts constructed as
5720 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5721 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5722 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5723 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5724 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5725 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5726
5727 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5728 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5729 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5730 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5731 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5732 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5733 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5734 .code
5735 accept local_parts = postmaster
5736 domains = +local_domains
5737 .endd
5738 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5739 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5740 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5741 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5742 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5743
5744 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5745 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5746 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5747 .code
5748 require verify = sender
5749 .endd
5750 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5751 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5752 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5753 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5754 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5755 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5756 discusses the details of address verification.
5757 .code
5758 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5759 control = submission
5760 .endd
5761 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5762 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5763 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5764 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5765 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5766 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5767 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5768 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5769 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5770 .code
5771 accept authenticated = *
5772 control = submission
5773 .endd
5774 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5775 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5776 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5777 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5778 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5779 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5780 .code
5781 require message = relay not permitted
5782 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5783 .endd
5784 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5785 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5786 .code
5787 require verify = recipient
5788 .endd
5789 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5790 fails, the address is rejected.
5791 .code
5792 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5793 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5794 # $dnslist_text
5795 # dnslists = black.list.example
5796 #
5797 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5798 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5799 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5800 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5801 .endd
5802 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5803 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5804 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5805 line.
5806 .code
5807 # require verify = csa
5808 .endd
5809 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5810 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5811 records.
5812 .code
5813 accept
5814 .endd
5815 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5816 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5817 .code
5818 acl_check_data:
5819 .endd
5820 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5821 of this ACL are commented out:
5822 .code
5823 # deny malware = *
5824 # message = This message contains a virus \
5825 # ($malware_name).
5826 .endd
5827 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5828 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5829 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5830 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5831 .code
5832 # warn spam = nobody
5833 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5834 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5835 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5836 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5837 .endd
5838 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5839 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5840 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5841 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5842 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5843 whatever the spam score.
5844 .code
5845 accept
5846 .endd
5847 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5848
5849
5850 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5851 .cindex "default" "routers"
5852 .cindex "routers" "default"
5853 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5854 by the line
5855 .code
5856 begin routers
5857 .endd
5858 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5859 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5860 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5861 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5862 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5863 .code
5864 # domain_literal:
5865 # driver = ipliteral
5866 # domains = !+local_domains
5867 # transport = remote_smtp
5868 .endd
5869 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5870 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5871 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5872 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5873 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5874 .code
5875 dnslookup:
5876 driver = dnslookup
5877 domains = ! +local_domains
5878 transport = remote_smtp
5879 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5880 no_more
5881 .endd
5882 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5883 domains. This is specified by the line
5884 .code
5885 domains = ! +local_domains
5886 .endd
5887 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5888 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5889 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5890 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5891 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5892 passed on to the following routers.
5893
5894 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5895 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5896 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5897 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5898 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5899
5900 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5901 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5902 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5903 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5904 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5905 the address fails and is bounced.
5906
5907 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5908 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5909 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5910 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5911 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5912 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5913 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5914 out.
5915 .code
5916 system_aliases:
5917 driver = redirect
5918 allow_fail
5919 allow_defer
5920 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5921 # user = exim
5922 file_transport = address_file
5923 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5924 .endd
5925 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5926 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5927 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5928 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5929 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5930 the next router.
5931
5932 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5933 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5934 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5935 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5936 .code
5937 userforward:
5938 driver = redirect
5939 check_local_user
5940 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5941 # local_part_suffix_optional
5942 file = $home/.forward
5943 # allow_filter
5944 no_verify
5945 no_expn
5946 check_ancestor
5947 file_transport = address_file
5948 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5949 reply_transport = address_reply
5950 .endd
5951 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5952 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5953 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5954 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5955 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5956 namely:
5957 .code
5958 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5959 # local_part_suffix_optional
5960 .endd
5961 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5962 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5963 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5964 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5965 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5966 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5967 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5968
5969 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5970 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5971 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5972 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5973
5974 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5975 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5976 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5977 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5978 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5979 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5980 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5981
5982 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5983 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5984 There are two reasons for doing this:
5985
5986 .olist
5987 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5988 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5989 unnecessary work.
5990 .next
5991 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5992 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5993 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5994 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5995 this time.
5996 .endlist
5997
5998 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5999 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6000 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6001 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6002
6003 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6004 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6005 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6006 .code
6007 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6008 .endd
6009 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6010 transport.
6011 .code
6012 localuser:
6013 driver = accept
6014 check_local_user
6015 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6016 # local_part_suffix_optional
6017 transport = local_delivery
6018 .endd
6019 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6020 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6021 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6022 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6023 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6024
6025
6026 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6027 .cindex "default" "transports"
6028 .cindex "transports" "default"
6029 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6030 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6031 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6032 .code
6033 begin transports
6034 .endd
6035 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6036 .code
6037 remote_smtp:
6038 driver = smtp
6039 hosts_try_prdr = *
6040 .endd
6041 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6042 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6043 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6044 It is negotiated between client and server
6045 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6046 All other options are defaulted.
6047 .code
6048 local_delivery:
6049 driver = appendfile
6050 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6051 delivery_date_add
6052 envelope_to_add
6053 return_path_add
6054 # group = mail
6055 # mode = 0660
6056 .endd
6057 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6058 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6059 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6060 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6061 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6062 show how this can be done.
6063
6064 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6065 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6066 similarly-named options above.
6067 .code
6068 address_pipe:
6069 driver = pipe
6070 return_output
6071 .endd
6072 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6073 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6074 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6075 sender.
6076 .code
6077 address_file:
6078 driver = appendfile
6079 delivery_date_add
6080 envelope_to_add
6081 return_path_add
6082 .endd
6083 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6084 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6085 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6086 .code
6087 address_reply:
6088 driver = autoreply
6089 .endd
6090 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6091 filter files.
6092
6093
6094
6095 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6096 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6097 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6098 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6099 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6100 introduced by the line
6101 .code
6102 begin retry
6103 .endd
6104 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6105 errors:
6106 .code
6107 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6108 .endd
6109 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6110 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6111 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6112 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6113
6114 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6115 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6116 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6117
6118
6119 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6120 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6121 .code
6122 begin rewrite
6123 .endd
6124 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6125 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6126
6127
6128
6129 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6130 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6131 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6132 .code
6133 begin authenticators
6134 .endd
6135 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6136 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6137 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6138 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6139 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6140 to support most MUA software.
6141
6142 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6143 .code
6144 #PLAIN:
6145 # driver = plaintext
6146 # server_set_id = $auth2
6147 # server_prompts = :
6148 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6149 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6150 .endd
6151 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6152 .code
6153 #LOGIN:
6154 # driver = plaintext
6155 # server_set_id = $auth1
6156 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6157 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6158 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6159 .endd
6160
6161 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6162 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6163 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6164 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6165 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6166 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6167 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6168 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6169
6170 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6171 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6172 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6173 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6174
6175 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6176 usercode and password are in different positions.
6177 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6178
6179 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6180
6181
6182
6183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6185
6186 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6187
6188 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6189 .cindex "PCRE"
6190 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6191 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6192 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6193 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6194 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6195 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6196
6197 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6198 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6199 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6200 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6201 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6202 case-insensitive.
6203
6204 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6205 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6206 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6207 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6208 .code
6209 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6210 .endd
6211 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6212 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6213 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6214 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6215 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6216 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6217 matched.
6218
6219 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6220 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6221 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6222 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6223 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6224 match anywhere in the subject string.
6225
6226 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6227 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6228 .code
6229 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6230 .endd
6231 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6232 You need to use:
6233 .code
6234 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6235 .endd
6236 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6237 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6238
6239
6240
6241 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6242 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6243
6244 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6245 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6246 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6247 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6248 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6249 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6250
6251 .olist
6252 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6253 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6254 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6255 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6256 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6257 .next
6258 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6259 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6260 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6261 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6262 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6263 .endlist
6264
6265 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6266 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6267 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6268 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6269 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6270 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6271
6272 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6273 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6274 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6275 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6276 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6277 .code
6278 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6279 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6280 .endd
6281 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6282 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6283 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6284 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6285 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6286 .code
6287 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6288 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6289 .endd
6290 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6291 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6292
6293 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6294 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6295 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6296 .code
6297 domain1:
6298 domain2:
6299 .endd
6300 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6301 matches the list item.
6302
6303 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6304 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6305 .code
6306 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6307 .endd
6308 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6309 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6310 causes a second lookup to occur.
6311
6312 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6313 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6314 lookup is permitted.
6315
6316
6317 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6318 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6319 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6320 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6321
6322 .ilist
6323 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6324 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6325 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6326 .next
6327 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6328 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6329 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6330 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6331 .endlist
6332
6333 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6334 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6335 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6336 .code
6337 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6338 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6339 .endd
6340 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6341 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6342 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6343
6344
6345
6346
6347 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6348 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6349 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6350 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6351
6352 .ilist
6353 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6354 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6355 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6356 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6357 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6358 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6359 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6360 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6361 be found in several places:
6362 .display
6363 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6364 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6365 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6366 .endd
6367 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6368 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6369 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6370 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6371 .next
6372 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6373 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6374 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6375 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6376 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6377 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6378 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6379
6380 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6381 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6382 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6383 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6384 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6385 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6386 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6387 .next
6388 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6389 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6390 .cindex "sasldb2"
6391 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6392 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6393 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6394 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6395 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6396 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6397 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6398 .next
6399 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6400 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6401 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6402 .cindex "Courier"
6403 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6404 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6405 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6406 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6407 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6408 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6409 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6410 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6411 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6412 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6413 .next
6414 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6415 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6416 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6417 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6418 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6419 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6420 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6421 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6422 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6423 .next
6424 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6425 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6426 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6427 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6428 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6429 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6430 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6431 .code
6432 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6433 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6434 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6435 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6436 .endd
6437 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6438 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6439 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6440 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6441 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6442
6443 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6444 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6445 lookup types support only literal keys.
6446
6447 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6448 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6449 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6450 .next
6451 .cindex "linear search"
6452 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6453 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6454 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6455 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6456 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6457 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6458 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6459 in the file is used.
6460
6461 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6462 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6463 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6464 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6465 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6466 colon, for example:
6467 .code
6468 baduser: :fail:
6469 .endd
6470 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6471 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6472 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6473 wildcarding of any kind.
6474
6475 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6476 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6477 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6478 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6479 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6480 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6481 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6482 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6483 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6484
6485 .next
6486 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6487 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6488 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6489 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6490 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6491 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6492 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6493 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6494
6495 .next
6496 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6497 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6498 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6499 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6500 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6501 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6502 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6503 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6504 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6505
6506 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6507 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6508 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6509 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6510
6511 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6512 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6513
6514 .olist
6515 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6516 .code
6517 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6518 *fish data for anythingfish
6519 .endd
6520 .next
6521 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6522 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6523 .code
6524 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6525 .endd
6526 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6527 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6528 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6529 .code
6530 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6531 .endd
6532 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6533 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6534 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6535 .code
6536 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6537 .endd
6538
6539 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6540 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6541 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6542 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6543 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6544
6545 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6546 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6547 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6548 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6549 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6550
6551 .next
6552 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6553 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6554 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6555 example:
6556 .code
6557 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6558 .endd
6559 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6560 .endlist olist
6561
6562 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6563 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6564 be followed by optional colons.
6565
6566 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6567 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6568 lookup types support only literal keys.
6569 .endlist ilist
6570
6571
6572 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6573 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6574 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6575 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6576 many of them are given in later sections.
6577
6578 .ilist
6579 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6580 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6581 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6582 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6583 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6584 .next
6585 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6586 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6587 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6588 .next
6589 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6590 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6591 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6592 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6593 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6594 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6595 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6596 .next
6597 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6598 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6599 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6600 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6601 .next
6602 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6603 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6604 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6605 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6606 .next
6607 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6608 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6609 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6610 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6611 .next
6612 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6613 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6614 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6615 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6616 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6617 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6618 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6619 password value. For example:
6620 .code
6621 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6622 .endd
6623 .next
6624 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6626 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6627 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6628
6629 .next
6630 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6631 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6632 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6633 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6634
6635 .next
6636 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6637 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6638 .next
6639 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6640 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6641 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6642 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6643 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6644 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6645 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6646 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6647 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6648 .code
6649 require condition = \
6650 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6651 .endd
6652 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6653 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6654 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6655 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6656 .endlist
6657
6658
6659
6660 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6661 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6662 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6663 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6664 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6665 options such as a list of local domains.
6666
6667 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6668 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6669 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6670 or may give up altogether.
6671
6672
6673
6674 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6675 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6676 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6677 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6678 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6679 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6680 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6681 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6682
6683 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6684 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6685 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6686
6687 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6688 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6689 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6690
6691 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6692 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6693 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6694 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6695 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6696 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6697 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6698 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6699 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6700 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6701 .code
6702 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6703 .endd
6704 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6705 looks up these keys, in this order:
6706 .code
6707 jane@eyre.example
6708 *@eyre.example
6709 *
6710 .endd
6711 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6712 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6713 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6714 Exim move on to try the next key.
6715
6716
6717
6718 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6719 .cindex "partial matching"
6720 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6721 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6722 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6723 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6724 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6725 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6726 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6727 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6728 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6729 a key in a DBM file is
6730 .code
6731 *.dates.fict.example
6732 .endd
6733 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6734 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6735 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6736 file.
6737
6738 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6739 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6740 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6741
6742 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6743 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6744 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6745 partial matching keys
6746 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6747 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6748 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6749
6750 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6751 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6752 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6753 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6754 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6755 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6756 remains.
6757
6758 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6759 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6760 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6761 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6762 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6763 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6764 .code
6765 2250.dates.fict.example
6766 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6767 *.dates.fict.example
6768 *.fict.example
6769 .endd
6770 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6771 finishes.
6772
6773 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6774 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6775 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6776 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6777 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6778 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6779 .code
6780 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6781 .endd
6782 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6783 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6784 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6785 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6786 .code
6787 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6788 .endd
6789 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6790 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6791
6792 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6793 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6794 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6795
6796 .ilist
6797 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6798 .next
6799 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6800 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6801 .next
6802 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6803 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6804 for &"*"& on its own.
6805 .next
6806 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6807 .endlist
6808
6809
6810 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6811 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6812 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6813 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6814 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6815 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6816 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6817
6818 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6819 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6820 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6821 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6822 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6823
6824
6825
6826
6827 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6828 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6829 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6830 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6831 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6832 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6833 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6834
6835 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6836 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6837 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6838 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6839 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6840 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6841
6842 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6843 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6844 complete.
6845
6846
6847
6848
6849 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6850 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6851 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6852 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6853 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6854 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6855 .code
6856 [name=$local_part]
6857 .endd
6858 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6859 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6860 .code
6861 [name="$local_part"]
6862 .endd
6863 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6864 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6865 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6866 of the following form is provided:
6867 .code
6868 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6869 .endd
6870 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6871 .code
6872 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6873 .endd
6874 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6875 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6876 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6877
6878
6879
6880
6881 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6882 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6883 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6884 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6885 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6886 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6887 an expansion string could contain:
6888 .code
6889 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6890 .endd
6891 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6892 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6893 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6894 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6895
6896 .new
6897 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6898 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6899 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6900 .wen
6901
6902 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6903 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6904 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6905 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6906 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6907 .code
6908 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6909 .endd
6910 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6911 white space is ignored.
6912 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6913 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6914 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6915
6916 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917 When the type is PTR,
6918 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6919 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6920 .code
6921 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6922 .endd
6923 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6924 altered and nothing is added.
6925
6926 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6927 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6928 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6929 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6930 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6931 The field separator can be modified as above.
6932
6933 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6934 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6935 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6936 unless a field separator is specified.
6937 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6938 For SPF records the
6939 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6940 .code
6941 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6942 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6943 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6944 .endd
6945 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6946 white space is ignored.
6947
6948 .new
6949 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6950 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6951 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6952 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6953 specified.
6954 .code
6955 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6956 .endd
6957 .wen
6958
6959 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6960 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6961 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6962 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6963 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6964 each followed by a comma,
6965 that may appear before the record type.
6966
6967 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6968 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6969 a defer-option modifier.
6970 The possible keywords are
6971 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6972 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6973 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6974 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6975 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6976 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6977 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6978 .code
6979 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6980 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6981 .endd
6982 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6983 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6984
6985 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6986 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6987 The possible keywords are
6988 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6989 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6990 with the lookup.
6991 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6992 is not labelled as authenticated data
6993 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6994 The default is &"never"&.
6995
6996 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6997
6998 .new
6999 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7000 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7001 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7002 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7003 (eg &"5s"&).
7004 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7005
7006 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7007 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7008 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7009 .wen
7010
7011
7012 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7013 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7014 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7015 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7016 the pseudo-type MXH:
7017 .code
7018 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7019 .endd
7020 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7021 returned.
7022
7023 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7024 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7025 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7026 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7027 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7028 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7029 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7030 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7031 .code
7032 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7033 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7034 .endd
7035 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7036 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7037 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7038
7039 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7040 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7041 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7042 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7043 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7044 such a list.
7045
7046 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7047 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7048 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7049 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7050 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7051 result of a successful lookup such as:
7052 .code
7053 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7054 .endd
7055 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7056 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7057 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7058
7059 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7060 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7061 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7062 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7063 .code
7064 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7065 .endd
7066
7067
7068 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7069 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7070 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7071 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7072 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7073 .code
7074 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7075 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7076 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7077 .endd
7078 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7079 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7080 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7081 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7082
7083 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7084 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7085 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7086
7087
7088
7089
7090 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7091 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7092 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7093 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7094 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7095 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7096 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7097 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7098 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7099 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7100 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7101 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7102 .code
7103 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7104 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7105 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7106 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7107 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7108 .endd
7109 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7110 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7111
7112 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7113 the way they handle the results of a query:
7114
7115 .ilist
7116 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7117 gives an error.
7118 .next
7119 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7120 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7121 .next
7122 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7123 from all of them are returned.
7124 .endlist
7125
7126
7127 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7128 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7129 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7130 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7131
7132
7133 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7134 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7135 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7136 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7137 .code
7138 data = ${lookup ldap \
7139 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7140 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7141 .endd
7142 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7143 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7144 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7145 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7146
7147 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7148 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7149 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7150
7151 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7152 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7153 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7154 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7155 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7156 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7157 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7158 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7159 &_exim.conf_&.
7160
7161
7162 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7163 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7164 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7165 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7166 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7167 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7168
7169 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7170 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7171 the string:
7172 .code
7173 * => \2A
7174 ( => \28
7175 ) => \29
7176 \ => \5C
7177 .endd
7178 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7179 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7180 .code
7181 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7182 .endd
7183 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7184 .code
7185 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7186 .endd
7187 yields
7188 .code
7189 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7190 .endd
7191 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7192 .code
7193 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7194 .endd
7195 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7196 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7197 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7198 .code
7199 , + " \ < > ;
7200 .endd
7201 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7202 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7203 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7204 .code
7205 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7206 .endd
7207 yields
7208 .code
7209 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7210 .endd
7211 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7212 .code
7213 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7214 .endd
7215 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7216 authentication below.
7217
7218
7219 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7220 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7221 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7222 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7223 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7224 by starting it with
7225 .code
7226 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7227 .endd
7228 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7229 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7230 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7231 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7232 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7233 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7234 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7235 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7236 failures, and timeouts.
7237
7238 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7239 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7240 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7241 doubled. For example
7242 .code
7243 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7244 .endd
7245 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7246 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7247 the local host) is used.
7248
7249 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7250 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7251 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7252 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7253 not available.
7254
7255 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7256 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7257 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7258 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7259 .code
7260 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7261 .endd
7262 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7263 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7264 .code
7265 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7266 .endd
7267 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7268 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7269 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7270 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7271 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7272 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7273 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7274 backup host.
7275
7276 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7277 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7278 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7279
7280 .ilist
7281 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7282 interface.
7283 .next
7284 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7285 .endlist
7286
7287
7288 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7289 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7290
7291
7292
7293 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7294 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7295 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7296 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7297 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7298 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7299 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7300 them. The following names are recognized:
7301 .display
7302 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7303 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7304 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7305 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7306 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7307 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7308 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7309 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7310 .endd
7311 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7312 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7313 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7314 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7315
7316 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7317 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7318 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7319 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7320 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7321 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7322 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7323 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7324 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7325
7326 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7327 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7328
7329 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7330 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7331 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7332 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7333 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7334 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7335 alternate list (colon-separated).
7336
7337 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7338 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7339 .code
7340 ${lookup ldap
7341 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7342 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7343 {$value}fail}
7344 .endd
7345 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7346 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7347 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7348 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7349
7350 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7351 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7352 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7353
7354 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7355 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7356 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7357 quoting has two advantages:
7358
7359 .ilist
7360 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7361 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7362 .next
7363 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7364 .endlist
7365
7366 For example, a setting such as
7367 .code
7368 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7369 .endd
7370 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7371
7372 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7373 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7374 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7375 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7376 .code
7377 PASS=${quote:$3}
7378 .endd
7379 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7380 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7381 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7382
7383
7384
7385 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7386 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7387 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7388 as a sequence of values, for example
7389 .code
7390 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7391 .endd
7392 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7393 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7394 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7395 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7396 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7397 directory.
7398
7399 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7400 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7401 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7402
7403 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7404 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7405 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7406 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7407 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7408 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7409 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7410 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7411 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7412
7413 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7414 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7415 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7416 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7417 .code
7418 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7419 value1.1,value1,,2
7420
7421 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7422 value two
7423
7424 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7425 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7426
7427 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7428 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7429 .endd
7430 You can
7431 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7432 results of LDAP lookups.
7433 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7434 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7435 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7436 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7437 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7438 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7439
7440
7441
7442
7443 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7444 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7445 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7446 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7447 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7448 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7449 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7450 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7451 .code
7452 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7453 .endd
7454 might return the string
7455 .code
7456 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7457 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7458 .endd
7459 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7460 .code
7461 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7462 .endd
7463 would just return
7464 .code
7465 Martin Guerre
7466 .endd
7467 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7468 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7469 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7470
7471
7472
7473 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7474 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7475 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7476 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7477 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7478 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7479 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7480 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7481 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7482 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7483 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7484 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7485 might be
7486 .code
7487 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7488 {$value}fail}
7489 .endd
7490 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7491 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7492 .code
7493 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7494 {$value}}
7495 .endd
7496 might be
7497 .code
7498 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7499 .endd
7500 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7501 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7502 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7503 .code
7504 Mister X
7505 .endd
7506 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7507 with a newline between the data for each row.
7508
7509
7510 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7511 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7512 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7513 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7514 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7515 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7516 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7517 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7518 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7519 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7520 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7521 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7522 information.
7523 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7524 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7525 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7526 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7527 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7528 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7529 .code
7530 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7531 .endd
7532 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7533 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7534 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7535 .code
7536 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7537 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7538 .endd
7539 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7540 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7541 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7542 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7543 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7544 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7545
7546 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7547 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7548 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7549 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7550 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7551 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7552 characters are not special.
7553
7554 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7555 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7556 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7557 done by starting the query with
7558 .display
7559 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7560 .endd
7561 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7562 .olist
7563 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7564 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7565 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7566 taken from there.
7567 .next
7568 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7569 .endlist
7570 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7571 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7572 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7573
7574 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7575 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7576 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7577 like this:
7578 .code
7579 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7580 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7581 master/db/name/pw
7582 .endd
7583 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7584 .code
7585 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7586 .endd
7587 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7588 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7589 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7590 .code
7591 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7592 .endd
7593
7594
7595 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7596 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7597 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7598 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7599 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7600 .display
7601 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7602 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7603 .endd
7604 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7605 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7606
7607 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7608 the queries.
7609
7610 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7611 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7612
7613 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7614 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7615 is zero because no rows are affected.
7616
7617
7618 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7619 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7620 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7621 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7622 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7623 looks like this:
7624 .code
7625 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7626 .endd
7627 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7628 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7629 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7630
7631 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7632 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7633 affected.
7634
7635 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7636 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7637 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7638 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7639 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7640 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7641 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7642 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7643 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7644 .code
7645 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7646 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7647 .endd
7648 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7649 .code
7650 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7651 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7652 .endd
7653 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7654 quote, which it doubles.
7655
7656 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7657 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7658 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7659 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7660 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7661 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7662 option.
7663 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7664 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7665
7666
7667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7669
7670 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7671 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7672 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7673 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7674 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7675 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7676 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7677 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7678 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7679
7680 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7681 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7682 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7683 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7684
7685
7686
7687 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7688 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7689 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7690 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7691 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7692 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7693 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7694 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7695
7696
7697 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7698 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7699 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7700
7701 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7702 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7703 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7704 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7705 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7706 .code
7707 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7708 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7709 .endd
7710 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7711 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7712 senders based on the receiving domain.
7713
7714
7715
7716
7717 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7718 .cindex "list" "negation"
7719 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7720 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7721 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7722 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7723 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7724 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7725
7726 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7727 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7728 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7729 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7730 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7731 .code
7732 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7733 .endd
7734 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7735 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7736 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7737 .code
7738 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7739 .endd
7740 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7741 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7742 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7743
7744 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7745 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7746 item.
7747
7748
7749
7750 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7751 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7752 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7753 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7754 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7755 file names are not allowed,
7756 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7757 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7758 lines:
7759
7760 .ilist
7761 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7762 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7763 .next
7764 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7765 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7766 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7767 .code
7768 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7769 .endd
7770 .endlist
7771
7772 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7773 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7774 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7775 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7776
7777 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7778 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7779 .code
7780 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7781 .endd
7782 and the file contains the lines
7783 .code
7784 !a.b.c
7785 *.b.c
7786 .endd
7787 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7788 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7789
7790
7791
7792 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7793 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7794 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7795 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7796 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7797 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7798 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7799 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7800
7801 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7802 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7803 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7804 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7805
7806
7807
7808
7809 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7810 .cindex "named lists"
7811 .cindex "list" "named"
7812 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7813 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7814 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7815 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7816 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7817 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7818 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7819 .code
7820 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7821 .endd
7822 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7823 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7824 configured with the line
7825 .code
7826 domains = +local_domains
7827 .endd
7828 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7829 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7830 .code
7831 dnslookup:
7832 driver = dnslookup
7833 domains = ! +local_domains
7834 transport = remote_smtp
7835 no_more
7836 .endd
7837 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7838 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7839 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7840 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7841 .code
7842 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7843 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7844 .endd
7845 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7846 .code
7847 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7848 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7849 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7850 .endd
7851 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7852 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7853 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7854 .code
7855 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7856 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7857 .endd
7858 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7859 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7860 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7861 .code
7862 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7863 .endd
7864 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7865 referenced lists if you can.
7866
7867 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7868 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7869 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7870 .code
7871 domains = +local_domains
7872 .endd
7873 on several of your routers
7874 or in several ACL statements,
7875 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7876 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7877 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7878 the same each time they are referenced.
7879
7880 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7881 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7882 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7883 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7884
7885
7886
7887 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7888 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7889 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7890 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7891 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7892 write
7893 .code
7894 ALIST = host1 : host2
7895 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7896 .endd
7897 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7898 .code
7899 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7900 .endd
7901 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7902 list, and write
7903 .code
7904 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7905 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7906 .endd
7907 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7908 .code
7909 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7910 .endd
7911
7912
7913 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7914 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7915 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7916 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7917 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7918 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7919 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7920 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7921 message. For example:
7922 .code
7923 domainlist special_domains = \
7924 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7925 .endd
7926 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7927 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7928 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7929 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7930 same list each time.
7931
7932 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7933 cache the result anyway. For example:
7934 .code
7935 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7936 .endd
7937 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7938 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7939
7940
7941
7942 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7943 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7944 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7945 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7946 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7947
7948 .ilist
7949 .cindex "primary host name"
7950 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7951 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7952 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7953 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7954 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7955 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7956 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7957 differ only in their names.
7958 .next
7959 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7960 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7961 .cindex "domain literal"
7962 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7963 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7964 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7965 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7966 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7967 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7968 .next
7969 .cindex "@mx_any"
7970 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7971 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7972 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7973 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7974 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7975 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7976 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7977 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7978 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7979 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7980 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7981
7982 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7983 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7984 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7985 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7986 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7987
7988 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7989 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7990 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7991 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7992 on a router). For example:
7993 .code
7994 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7995 .endd
7996 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7997 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7998
7999 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8000 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8001 contain negative items.
8002
8003 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8004 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8005 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8006 .code
8007 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8008 an.other.domain : ...
8009 .endd
8010 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8011 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8012 .code
8013 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8014 an.other.domain ? ...
8015 .endd
8016 .next
8017 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8018 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8019 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8020 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8021 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8022 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8023 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8024 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8025 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8026 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8027
8028 .next
8029 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8030 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8031 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8032 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8033 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8034 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8035 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8036 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8037 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8038
8039 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8040 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8041 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8042 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8043 expression by expansion, of course).
8044 .next
8045 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8046 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8047 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8048 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8049 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8050 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8051 .code
8052 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8053 .endd
8054 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8055 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8056 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8057 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8058 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8059 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8060 other statements in the same ACL.
8061
8062 .next
8063 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8064 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8065 .code
8066 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8067 .endd
8068 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8069 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8070
8071 .next
8072 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8073 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8074 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8075 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8076 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8077 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8078 expansion variable.
8079 .next
8080 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8081 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8082 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8083 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8084 .code
8085 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8086 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8087 .endd
8088 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8089 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8090 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8091 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8092 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8093 .next
8094 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8095 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8096 between the pattern and the domain.
8097 .endlist
8098
8099 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8100 .code
8101 domainlist funny_domains = \
8102 @ : \
8103 lib.unseen.edu : \
8104 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8105 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8106 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8107 nis;domains.byname : \
8108 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8109 .endd
8110 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8111 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8112 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8113 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8114 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8115 patterns earlier.
8116
8117
8118
8119 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8120 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8121 .cindex "list" "host list"
8122 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8123 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8124 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8125 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8126 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8127 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8128 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8129
8130
8131 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8132 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8133 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8134 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8135 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8136 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8137 not used.
8138
8139 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8140 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8141 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8142
8143
8144
8145 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8146 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8147 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8148 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8149 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8150 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8151 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8152 concerns.)
8153
8154 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8155 inspecting its IP address:
8156
8157 .ilist
8158 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8159 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8160 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8161 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8162 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8163 with the IP address of the subject host.
8164
8165 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8166 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8167 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8168 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8169 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8170
8171 .next
8172 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8173 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8174 domain name, as just described.
8175
8176 .next
8177 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8178 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8179 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8180 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8181 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8182 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8183 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8184 that can never match a client host.
8185
8186 .next
8187 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8188 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8189 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8190 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8191 .code
8192 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8193 accept hosts = @[]
8194 .endd
8195 .next
8196 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8197 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8198 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8199 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8200 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8201 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8202 significant end of the address.
8203
8204 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8205 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8206 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8207 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8208 .code
8209 192.168.23.236/31
8210 .endd
8211 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8212 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8213 matches.
8214
8215 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8216 .code
8217 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8218 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8219 .endd
8220 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8221 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8222 For example:
8223 .code
8224 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8225 .endd
8226 could make use of a file containing
8227 .code
8228 172.16.0.0/12
8229 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8230 .endd
8231 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8232 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8233 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8234 .code
8235 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8236 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8237 .endd
8238 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8239 list.
8240 .endlist
8241
8242
8243
8244 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8245 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8246 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8247 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8248 address, the pattern takes this form:
8249 .display
8250 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8251 .endd
8252 For example:
8253 .code
8254 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8255 .endd
8256 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8257 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8258 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8259 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8260 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8261 returned by the lookup is not used.
8262
8263 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8264 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8265 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8266 patterns of this form:
8267 .display
8268 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8269 .endd
8270 For example:
8271 .code
8272 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8273 .endd
8274 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8275 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8276 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8277 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8278 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8279
8280 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8281 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8282 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8283 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8284 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8285 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8286 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8287 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8288 addresses are always used.
8289
8290 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8291 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8292 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8293 configurations.
8294
8295 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8296 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8297 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8298 case the IP address is used on its own.
8299
8300
8301
8302 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8303 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8304 .cindex "unknown host name"
8305 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8306 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8307 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8308 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8309 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8310 above.)
8311
8312 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8313 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8314 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8315 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8316 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8317 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8318 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8319
8320 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8321 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8322
8323 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8324 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8325 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8326 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8327 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8328 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8329 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8330 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8331 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8332
8333 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8334 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8335
8336 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8337 .cindex "alias for host"
8338 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8339 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8340
8341 .ilist
8342 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8343 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8344 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8345 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8346 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8347 expression.
8348 .next
8349 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8350 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8351 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8352 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8353 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8354 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8355 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8356 example,
8357 .code
8358 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8359 .endd
8360 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8361 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8362 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8363 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8364 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8365 .code
8366 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8367 .endd
8368 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8369 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8370 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8371 required.
8372 .endlist
8373
8374
8375
8376
8377 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8378 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8379 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8380 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8381 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8382 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8383
8384 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8385 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8386
8387 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8388 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8389 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8390 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8391 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8392 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8393 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8394 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8395 not recognized in an indirected file).
8396
8397 .ilist
8398 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8399 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8400 .code
8401 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8402 .endd
8403 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8404 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8405
8406 .next
8407 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8408 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8409 example:
8410 .code
8411 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8412 192.168.4.5
8413 .endd
8414 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8415 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8416 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8417 .endlist
8418
8419 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8420 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8421 list.
8422
8423 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8424 "SECTmixwilhos"
8425 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8426
8427 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8428 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8429 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8430
8431 .ilist
8432 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8433 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8434 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8435 .code
8436 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8437 .endd
8438 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8439 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8440 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8441 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8442 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8443 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8444 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8445
8446 .next
8447 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8448 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8449 .code
8450 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8451 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8452 .endd
8453 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8454 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8455 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8456 this section.
8457 .endlist
8458
8459
8460 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8461 "SECTtemdnserr"
8462 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8463 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8464 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8465 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8466 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8467 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8468 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8469 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8470 host lists such as whitelists.
8471
8472
8473
8474 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8475 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8476 .cindex "unknown host name"
8477 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8478 If a pattern is of the form
8479 .display
8480 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8481 .endd
8482 for example
8483 .code
8484 dbm;/host/accept/list
8485 .endd
8486 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8487 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8488 is not used.
8489
8490 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8491 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8492 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8493 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8494 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8495 lookup, both using the same file.
8496
8497
8498
8499 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8500 If a pattern is of the form
8501 .display
8502 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8503 .endd
8504 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8505 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8506 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8507 .code
8508 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8509 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8510 .endd
8511 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8512 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8513 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8514 operator.
8515
8516 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8517 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8518 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8519
8520 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8521 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8522 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8523 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8524 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8525 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8526
8527
8528
8529
8530
8531 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8532 .cindex "list" "address list"
8533 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8534 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8535 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8536 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8537 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8538 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8539 using this option setting:
8540 .code
8541 senders = :
8542 .endd
8543 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8544 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8545 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8546 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8547
8548 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8549 example:
8550 .code
8551 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8552 .endd
8553 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8554 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8555 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8556 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8557 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8558 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8559 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8560 .code
8561 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8562 *@+hostile_domains:\
8563 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8564 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8565 .endd
8566 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8567 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8568 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8569 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8570 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8571
8572 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8573 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8574 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8575 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8576 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8577 .code
8578 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8579 .endd
8580
8581 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8582 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8583 senders:
8584
8585 .ilist
8586 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8587 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8588 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8589 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8590 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8591 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8592 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8593 .code
8594 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8595 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8596 .endd
8597 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8598 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8599
8600 .next
8601 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8602 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8603 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8604 example:
8605 .code
8606 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8607 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8608 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8609 .endd
8610 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8611 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8612 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8613 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8614
8615 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8616 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8617 panic log.
8618 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8619 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8620 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8621 default. For example, with this lookup:
8622 .code
8623 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8624 .endd
8625 the file could contains lines like this:
8626 .code
8627 user1@domain1.example
8628 *@domain2.example
8629 .endd
8630 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8631 that are tried is:
8632 .code
8633 nimrod@jaeger.example
8634 *@jaeger.example
8635 *
8636 .endd
8637 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8638 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8639
8640 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8641 .code
8642 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8643 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8644 .endd
8645 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8646 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8647 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8648 .endlist
8649
8650
8651 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8652 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8653 always fails.
8654
8655
8656 .ilist
8657 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8658 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8659 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8660 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8661 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8662 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8663 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8664 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8665 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8666
8667 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8668 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8669 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8670 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8671 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8672 with
8673 .code
8674 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8675 .endd
8676 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8677 .code
8678 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8679 .endd
8680 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8681
8682 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8683 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8684 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8685 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8686 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8687 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8688 .code
8689 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8690 spammer3 : spammer4
8691 .endd
8692 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8693 doubling.
8694
8695 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8696 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8697 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8698 might have entries like
8699 .code
8700 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8701 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8702 *: ^\d{8}$
8703 .endd
8704 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8705 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8706 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8707 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8708
8709 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8710 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8711 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8712
8713 .next
8714 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8715 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8716 can only return a single list of local parts.
8717 .endlist
8718
8719 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8720 in these two examples:
8721 .code
8722 senders = +my_list
8723 senders = *@+my_list
8724 .endd
8725 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8726 example it is a named domain list.
8727
8728
8729
8730
8731 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8732 .cindex "case of local parts"
8733 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8734 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8735 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8736 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8737 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8738 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8739 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8740 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8741 default.
8742
8743 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8744 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8745 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8746 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8747 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8748 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8749 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8750 case-independent.
8751
8752 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8753 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8754 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8755 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8756 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8757 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8758 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8759 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8760
8761
8762
8763 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8764 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8765 .cindex "local part" "list"
8766 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8767 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8768 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8769 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8770 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8771 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8772 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8773 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8774
8775 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8776 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8777 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8778 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8779 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8780 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8781 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8782 types.
8783 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8784
8785
8786
8787
8788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8790
8791 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8792 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8793 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8794 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8795
8796 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8797 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8798 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8799 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8800 escape character, as described in the following section.
8801
8802 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8803 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8804 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8805 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8806 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8807 reasons.
8808
8809
8810
8811 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8812 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8813 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8814 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8815 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8816 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8817 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8818 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8819
8820 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8821 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8822 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8823 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8824 .code
8825 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8826 .endd
8827 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8828 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8829 string.
8830
8831
8832
8833 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8834 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8835 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8836 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8837 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8838 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8839 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8840 encoding.
8841
8842 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8843 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8844 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8845
8846
8847 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8848 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8849 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8850 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8851 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8852 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8853 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8854 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8855 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8856 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8857 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8858 and &%nhash%&.
8859
8860 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8861 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8862 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8863
8864 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8865 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8866 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8867 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8868 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8869 .code
8870 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8871 .endd
8872 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8873 Exim message identifier. For example:
8874 .code
8875 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8876 .endd
8877 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8878 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8879
8880
8881 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8882 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8883 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8884 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8885 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8886 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8887 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8888 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8889 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8890 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8891 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8892 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8893 being expanded.
8894
8895
8896
8897
8898 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8899 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8900 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8901 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8902 white space is significant.
8903
8904 .vlist
8905 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8906 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8907 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8908 .code
8909 $local_part
8910 ${domain}
8911 .endd
8912 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8913 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8914 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8915 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8916 given, the expansion fails.
8917
8918 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8919 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8920 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8921 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8922 .code
8923 ${lc:$local_part}
8924 .endd
8925 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8926 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8927 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8928 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8929 string easier to understand.
8930
8931 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8932 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8933 expansion item below.
8934
8935
8936 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8937 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8938 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8939 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8940 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8941 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8942 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8943 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8944 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8945 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8946 the result of the expansion.
8947 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8948 the expansion result is an empty string.
8949 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8950
8951
8952 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8953 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8954 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8955 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8956 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8957 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8958 The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8959 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8960 .display
8961 &`version `&
8962 &`serial_number `&
8963 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8964 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8965 &`notbefore `& time
8966 &`notafter `& time
8967 &`sig_algorithm `&
8968 &`signature `&
8969 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8970 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8971 &`crl_uri `& list
8972 .endd
8973 If the field is found,
8974 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8975 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8976 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8977 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8978
8979 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8980 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8981 extracted is used.
8982
8983 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8984
8985 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8986 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8987 not quite
8988 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8989 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8990 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8991 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8992 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8993 The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8994 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8995 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8996
8997 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8998 take an optional modifier of "int"
8999 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9000 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9001 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9002
9003 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9004 newline-separated by default,
9005 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9006 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9007 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9008
9009 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9010 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9011 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9012 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9013 if so the elenment tags are omitted.
9014
9015 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9016
9017 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9018 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9019 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9020 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9021 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9022 .code
9023 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9024 .endd
9025 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9026 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9027 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9028
9029 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9030 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9031 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9032 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9033 must have the following type:
9034 .code
9035 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9036 .endd
9037 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9038 function should return one of the following values:
9039
9040 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9041 into the expanded string that is being built.
9042
9043 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9044 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9045
9046 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9047 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9048
9049 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9050
9051 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9052 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9053 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9054
9055
9056 .new
9057 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9058 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9059 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9060 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9061 removed.
9062 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9063 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9064 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9065
9066 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9067 appear, for example:
9068 .code
9069 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9070 .endd
9071 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9072 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9073
9074 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9075 search failure.
9076 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9077 search success.
9078 .wen
9079
9080
9081 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9082 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9083 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9084 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9085 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9086 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9087 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9088 form:
9089 .display
9090 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9091 .endd
9092 .vindex "&$value$&"
9093 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9094 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9095 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9096 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9097 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9098 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9099 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9100 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9101 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9102
9103 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9104 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9105 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9106 yield &"2001"&:
9107 .code
9108 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9109 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9110 .endd
9111 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9112 appear, for example:
9113 .code
9114 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9115 .endd
9116 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9117 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9118
9119
9120 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9121 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9122 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9123 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9124 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9125 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9126 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9127 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9128 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9129 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9130 <&'string3'&> as before.
9131
9132 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9133 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9134 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9135 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9136 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9137 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9138 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9139 provided. For example:
9140 .code
9141 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9142 .endd
9143 yields &"42"&, and
9144 .code
9145 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9146 .endd
9147 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9148 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9149
9150
9151 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9152 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9153 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9154 .vindex "&$item$&"
9155 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9156 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9157 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9158 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9159 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9160 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9161 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9162 .code
9163 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9164 .endd
9165 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9166 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9167
9168
9169 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9170 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9171 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9172 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9173 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9174 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9175
9176 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9177 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9178 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9179 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9180 .code
9181 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9182 .endd
9183 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9184 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9185 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9186 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9187 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9188 .code
9189 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9190 .endd
9191 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9192 letters appear. For example:
9193 .display
9194 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9195 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9196 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9197 .endd
9198
9199 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9200 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9201 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9202 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9203 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9204 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9205 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9206 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9207 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9208 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9209 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9210 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9211 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9212 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9213 .code
9214 $header_reply-to:
9215 .endd
9216 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9217 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9218 lines) may be present.
9219
9220 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9221 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9222
9223 .ilist
9224 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9225 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9226 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9227
9228 .next
9229 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9230 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9231 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9232 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9233 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9234 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9235 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9236 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9237
9238 .next
9239 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9240 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9241 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9242 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9243 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9244 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9245 .endlist ilist
9246
9247 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9248 command of the following form:
9249 .code
9250 headers charset "UTF-8"
9251 .endd
9252 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9253 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9254 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9255 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9256 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9257 ISO-8859-1.
9258
9259 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9260 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9261 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9262 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9263
9264 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9265 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9266 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9267 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9268 router or transport are not accessible.
9269
9270 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9271 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9272 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9273 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9274 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9275 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9276
9277 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9278 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9279 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9280 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9281 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9282 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9283 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9284
9285 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9286 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9287 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9288 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9289 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9290 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9291 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9292 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9293
9294
9295 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9296 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9297 .cindex &%hmac%&
9298 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9299 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9300 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9301 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9302 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9303 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9304 present. For example:
9305 .code
9306 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9307 .endd
9308 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9309 produces:
9310 .code
9311 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9312 .endd
9313 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9314 an Exim configuration:
9315 .code
9316 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9317 .endd
9318 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9319 .code
9320 headers_add = \
9321 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9322 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9323 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9324 .endd
9325 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9326 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9327 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9328 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9329 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9330 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9331
9332
9333 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9334 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9335 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9336 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9337 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9338 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9339 .code
9340 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9341 .endd
9342 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9343 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9344 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9345 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9346 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9347
9348 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9349 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9350 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9351 .code
9352 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9353 .endd
9354 you can use
9355 .code
9356 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9357 .endd
9358
9359 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9360 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9361 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9362 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9363 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9364 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9365 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9366 some of the braces:
9367 .code
9368 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9369 .endd
9370 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9371 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9372 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9373
9374
9375 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9376 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9377 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9378 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9379 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9380 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9381 apart from an optional leading minus,
9382 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9383
9384 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9385 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9386
9387 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9388 If the number is negative, the fields are
9389 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9390 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9391 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9392
9393 If the modulus of the
9394 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9395 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9396
9397 For example:
9398 .code
9399 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9400 .endd
9401 yields &"42"&, and
9402 .code
9403 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9404 .endd
9405 yields &"result: 99"&.
9406
9407 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9408 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9409 extracted is used.
9410 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9411
9412
9413 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9414 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9415 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9416 described in the next item.
9417
9418 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9419 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9420 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9421 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9422 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9423 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9424 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9425 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9426 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9427
9428 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9429 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9430 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9431 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9432 out by the system administrator.
9433
9434 .vindex "&$value$&"
9435 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9436 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9437 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9438 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9439 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9440 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9441 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9442 original lookup fails.
9443
9444 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9445 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9446 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9447 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9448 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9449 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9450 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9451 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9452
9453 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9454 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9455 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9456 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9457
9458 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9459 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9460 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9461 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9462
9463 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9464 .code
9465 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9466 .endd
9467 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9468 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9469 .code
9470 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9471 {$value}fail}
9472 .endd
9473
9474
9475 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9476 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9477 .vindex "&$item$&"
9478 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9479 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9480 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9481 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9482 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9483 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9484 .code
9485 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9486 .endd
9487 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9488 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9489 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9490
9491 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9492 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9493 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9494 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9495 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9496 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9497 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9498 .code
9499 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9500 .endd
9501 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9502 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9503 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9504 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9505 example,
9506 .code
9507 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9508 .endd
9509 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9510
9511
9512
9513 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9514 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9515 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9516 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9517 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9518 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9519 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9520 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9521
9522 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9523 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9524 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9525 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9526 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9527 not its contents.
9528
9529 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9530 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9531 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9532
9533 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9534 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9535
9536
9537 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9538 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9539 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9540 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9541 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9542 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9543 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9544 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9545
9546 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9547 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9548 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9549 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9550 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9551 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9552 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9553 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9554 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9555 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9556
9557 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9558 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9559 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9560 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9561
9562 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9563 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9564 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9565 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9566 is the expansion of the third argument.
9567
9568 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9569 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9570 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9571
9572 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9573 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9574 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9575 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9576 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9577 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9578 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9579 newlines are left in the string.
9580 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9581 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9582 the string expansion fails.
9583
9584 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9585 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9586
9587
9588
9589 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9590 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9591 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9592 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9593 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9594 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9595 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9596 examples:
9597 .code
9598 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9599 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9600 .endd
9601 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9602 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9603 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9604 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9605 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9606 example:
9607 .code
9608 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9609 .endd
9610 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9611 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9612 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9613 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9614 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9615 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9616 .code
9617 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9618 .endd
9619 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9620 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9621 turns them into spaces:
9622 .code
9623 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9624 .endd
9625 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9626 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9627 addition, the following errors can occur:
9628
9629 .ilist
9630 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9631 .next
9632 Failure to connect the socket;
9633 .next
9634 Failure to write the request string;
9635 .next
9636 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9637 .endlist
9638
9639 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9640 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9641 errors occurs. For example:
9642 .code
9643 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9644 {socket failure}}
9645 .endd
9646 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9647 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9648 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9649 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9650 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9651
9652 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9653 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9654
9655
9656 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9657 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9658 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9659 .vindex "&$value$&"
9660 .vindex "&$item$&"
9661 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9662 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9663 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9664 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9665 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9666 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9667 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9668 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9669 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9670 .code
9671 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9672 .endd
9673 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9674 can be found:
9675 .code
9676 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9677 .endd
9678 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9679 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9680 expansion items.
9681
9682 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9683 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9684 expansion item above.
9685
9686 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9687 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9688 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9689 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9690 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9691 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9692 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9693 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9694 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9695
9696 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9697 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9698 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9699 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9700 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9701 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9702 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9703 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9704 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9705 character.
9706
9707 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9708 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9709 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9710 .vindex "&$value$&"
9711 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9712 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9713 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9714 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9715 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9716 &$value$&.
9717
9718 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9719 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9720 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9721 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9722
9723 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9724 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9725 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9726 troubleshoot:
9727 .code
9728 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9729 log_message = Output of id: $value
9730 .endd
9731 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9732 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9733 .code
9734 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9735 .endd
9736
9737 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9738 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9739 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9740 .code
9741 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9742 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9743 ...
9744 endif
9745 .endd
9746 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9747 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9748 commands.
9749
9750 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9751 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9752 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9753 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9754
9755 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9756 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9757
9758
9759 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9760 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9761 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9762 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9763 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9764 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9765 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9766 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9767 .code
9768 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9769 .endd
9770 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9771 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9772 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9773 .code
9774 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9775 .endd
9776 yields &"defabc"&, and
9777 .code
9778 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9779 .endd
9780 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9781 the regular expression from string expansion.
9782
9783
9784
9785 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9786 .cindex sorting "a list"
9787 .cindex list sorting
9788 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9789 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9790 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9791 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9792 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9793 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9794 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9795 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9796 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9797 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9798 to give values for comparison.
9799
9800 The item result is a sorted list,
9801 with the original list separator,
9802 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9803
9804 Examples:
9805 .code
9806 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9807 .endd
9808 sorts a list of numbers, and
9809 .code
9810 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9811 .endd
9812 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9813
9814
9815 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9816 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9817 .cindex "substring extraction"
9818 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9819 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9820 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9821 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9822 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9823 .code
9824 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9825 .endd
9826 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9827 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9828 omitted.
9829
9830 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9831 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9832 length required. For example
9833 .code
9834 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9835 .endd
9836 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9837 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9838 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9839 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9840
9841 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9842 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9843 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9844 .code
9845 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9846 .endd
9847 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9848 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9849 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9850 .code
9851 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9852 .endd
9853 yields an empty string, but
9854 .code
9855 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9856 .endd
9857 yields &"1"&.
9858
9859 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9860 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9861 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9862 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9863 .code
9864 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9865 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9866 .endd
9867 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9868
9869
9870
9871 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9872 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9873 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9874 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9875 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9876 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9877 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9878 replacement list. For example
9879 .code
9880 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9881 .endd
9882 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9883 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9884 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9885 place.
9886 .endlist
9887
9888
9889
9890 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9891 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9892 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9893 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9894 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9895 following operations can be performed:
9896
9897 .vlist
9898 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9899 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9900 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9901 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9902 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9903 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9904
9905
9906 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9907 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9908 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9909 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9910 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9911 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9912 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9913 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9914 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9915
9916 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9917 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9918 character. For example:
9919 .code
9920 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9921 .endd
9922 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9923 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9924 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9925 processing lists.
9926
9927 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9928 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9929 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9930 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9931 .code
9932 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9933 .endd
9934 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9935 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9936 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9937 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9938 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9939 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9940 quoted.
9941 .code
9942 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9943 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9944 user@example.com
9945 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9946 Last:user@example.com
9947 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9948 user@example.com
9949 .endd
9950
9951 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9952 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9953 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9954 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9955 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9956 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9957 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9958 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9959 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9960
9961 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9962 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9963 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9964 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9965 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9966 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9967 string.
9968
9969
9970 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9971 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9972 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9973 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9974 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9975
9976
9977 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9978 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9979 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9980 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9981 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9982 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9983 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9984
9985
9986 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9987 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9988 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9989 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9990 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9991 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9992 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9993 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9994 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9995 C programming language):
9996 .table2 70pt 300pt
9997 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9998 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9999 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10000 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10001 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10002 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10003 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10004 .endtable
10005 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10006 space is permitted before or after operators.
10007
10008 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10009 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10010 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10011 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10012 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10013
10014 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10015 or 1024*1024*1024,
10016 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10017 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10018
10019 .display
10020 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10021 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10022 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10023 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10024 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10025 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10026 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10027 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10028 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10029 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10030 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10031 .endd
10032
10033 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10034 .code
10035 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10036 condition = \
10037 ${if and { \
10038 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10039 { \
10040 < \
10041 {$recipients_count} \
10042 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10043 } \
10044 }{yes}{no}}
10045 .endd
10046 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10047 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10048
10049
10050 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10051 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10052 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10053 example,
10054 .code
10055 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10056 .endd
10057 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10058 and then re-expands what it has found.
10059
10060
10061 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10062 .cindex "Unicode"
10063 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10064 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10065 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10066 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10067 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10068 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10069 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10070 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10071 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10072
10073 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10074 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10075 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10076 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10077 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10078 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10079 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10080
10081
10082 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10083 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10084 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10085 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10086 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10087 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10088 .code
10089 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10090 .endd
10091 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10092 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10093
10094
10095
10096 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10097 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10098 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10099 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10100 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10101 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10102
10103
10104
10105 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10106 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10107 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10108 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10109 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10110 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10111 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10112
10113
10114 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10115 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10116 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10117 .cindex "lower casing"
10118 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10119 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10120 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10121 .code
10122 ${lc:$local_part}
10123 .endd
10124
10125 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10126 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10127 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10128 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10129 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10130 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10131 .code
10132 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10133 .endd
10134 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10135 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10136 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10137
10138
10139 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10140 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10141 .cindex "list" "item count"
10142 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10143 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10144 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10145
10146
10147 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10148 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10149 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10150 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10151 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10152 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10153 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10154 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10155 matching list is returned.
10156
10157
10158 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10159 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10160 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10161 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10162 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10163 empty.
10164
10165
10166 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10167 .cindex "masked IP address"
10168 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10169 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10170 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10171 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10172 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10173 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10174 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10175 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10176 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10177 .code
10178 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10179 .endd
10180 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10181 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10182 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10183 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10184 .code
10185 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10186 .endd
10187 returns the string
10188 .code
10189 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10190 .endd
10191 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10192
10193
10194 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10195 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10196 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10197 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10198 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10199 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10200 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10201
10202
10203 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10204 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10205 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10206 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10207 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10208 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10209 .code
10210 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10211 .endd
10212 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10213
10214
10215 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10216 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10217 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10218 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10219 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10220 is an empty string or
10221 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10222 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10223 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10224 respectively For example,
10225 .code
10226 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10227 .endd
10228 becomes
10229 .code
10230 "ab\"*\"cd"
10231 .endd
10232 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10233 variable or a message header.
10234
10235 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10236 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10237 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10238 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10239 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10240 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10241 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10242
10243
10244 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10246 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10247 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10248 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10249 .code
10250 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10251 .endd
10252 returns
10253 .code
10254 two%20%5C2A%20two
10255 .endd
10256 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10257 yields an unchanged string.
10258
10259
10260 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10261 .cindex "random number"
10262 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10263 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10264 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10265 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10266 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10267 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10268 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10269 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10270 random().
10271
10272
10273 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10274 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10275 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10276 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10277 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10278 for DNS. For example,
10279 .code
10280 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10281 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10282 .endd
10283 returns
10284 .code
10285 4.2.0.192
10286 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10287 .endd
10288
10289
10290 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10291 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10292 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10293 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10294 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10295 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10296 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10297 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10298 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10299 characters
10300 .code
10301 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10302 .endd
10303 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10304 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10305 characters.
10306
10307
10308 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10309 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10310 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10311 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10312 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10313 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10314 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10315 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10316
10317 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10318 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10319 to use this operator as well.
10320
10321
10322
10323 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10324 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10325 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10326 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10327 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10328 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10329 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10330
10331
10332 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10333 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10334 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10335 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10336 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10337 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10338 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10339
10340
10341 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10342 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10343 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10344 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10345 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10346 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10347 certificate,
10348 and returns
10349 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10350 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10351
10352
10353 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10354 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10355 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10356 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10357 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10358 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10359 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10360 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10361 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10362 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10363 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10364 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10365 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10366
10367 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10368 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10369 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10370
10371 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10372 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10373 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10374 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10375 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10376
10377
10378
10379 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10380 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10381 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10382 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10383 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10384 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10385
10386
10387 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10388 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10389 .cindex "substring extraction"
10390 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10391 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10392 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10393 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10394 .code
10395 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10396 .endd
10397 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10398 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10399
10400 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10401 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10402 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10403 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10404 seconds.
10405
10406 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10407 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10408 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10409 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10410 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10411 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10412 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10413
10414 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10415 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10416 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10417 .cindex "upper casing"
10418 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10419 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10420 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10421
10422 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10423 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10424 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10425 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10426 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10427 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10428 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10429 .endlist
10430
10431
10432
10433
10434
10435
10436 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10437 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10438 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10439 while expanding strings:
10440
10441 .vlist
10442 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10443 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10444 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10445 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10446 condition.
10447
10448 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10449 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10450 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10451 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10452 are:
10453 .display
10454 &`= `& equal
10455 &`== `& equal
10456 &`> `& greater
10457 &`>= `& greater or equal
10458 &`< `& less
10459 &`<= `& less or equal
10460 .endd
10461 For example:
10462 .code
10463 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10464 .endd
10465 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10466 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10467 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10468 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10469 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10470 zero.
10471
10472 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10473 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10474 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10475
10476
10477 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10478 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10479 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10480 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10481 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10482 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10483 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10484 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10485 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10486 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10487 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10488 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10489 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10490 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10491
10492 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10493 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10494 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10495 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10496 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10497 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10498 false if zero.
10499 An empty string is treated as false.
10500 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10501 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10502 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10503
10504 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10505 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10506 For example:
10507 .code
10508 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10509 .endd
10510
10511
10512 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10513 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10514 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10515 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10516 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10517 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10518 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10519 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10520
10521 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10522
10523 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10524 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10525 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10526 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10527 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10528 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10529 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10530 included in the binary.
10531
10532 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10533 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10534 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10535 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10536 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10537 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10538 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10539 string in LDAP form is:
10540 .code
10541 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10542 .endd
10543 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10544 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10545 .code
10546 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10547 .endd
10548 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10549 supported:
10550
10551 .ilist
10552 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10553 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10554 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10555 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10556 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10557 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10558 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10559 comparison fails.
10560
10561 .next
10562 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10563 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10564 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10565 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10566 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10567 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10568
10569 .next
10570 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10571 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10572 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10573 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10574 whatever its length.
10575
10576 .next
10577 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10578 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10579 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10580 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10581 .endlist
10582 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10583 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10584 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10585 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10586 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10587 support &[crypt16()]&.
10588
10589 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10590 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10591 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10592 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10593 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10594
10595 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10596 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10597 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10598
10599 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10600 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10601 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10602 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10603 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10604
10605 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10606 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10607 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10608 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10609 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10610 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10611 .code
10612 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10613 .endd
10614 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10615 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10616
10617 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10618 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10619 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10620 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10621 exists in the message. For example,
10622 .code
10623 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10624 .endd
10625 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10626 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10627
10628 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10629 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10630 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10631 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10632 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10633 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10634 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10635 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10636 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10637
10638 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10639 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10640 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10641 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10642 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10643 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10644 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10645 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10646
10647 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10648 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10649 .cindex "first delivery"
10650 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10651 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10652 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10653 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10654
10655
10656 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10657 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10658 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10659 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10660 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10661 .vindex "&$item$&"
10662 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10663 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10664 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10665 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10666 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10667 .ilist
10668 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10669 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10670 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10671 .next
10672 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10673 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10674 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10675 .endlist
10676 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10677 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10678 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10679 list separator is changed to a comma:
10680 .code
10681 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10682 .endd
10683 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10684 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10685
10686 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10687
10688
10689 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10690 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10691 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10692 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10693 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10694 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10695 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10696 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10697 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10698 case-independent.
10699
10700 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10701 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10702 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10703 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10704 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10705 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10706 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10707 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10708 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10709 case-independent.
10710
10711 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10712 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10713 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10714 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10715 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10716 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10717 is true.
10718
10719 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10720 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10721 .code
10722 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10723 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10724 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10725 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10726 .endd
10727
10728 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10729 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10730 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10731 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10732 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10733 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10734 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10735 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10736 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10737 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10738 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10739
10740 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10741 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10742 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10743 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10744 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10745
10746 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10747 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10748 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10749 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10750 .code
10751 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10752 .endd
10753 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10754
10755 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10756 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10757 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10758 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10759 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10760 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10761 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10762 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10763 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10764 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10765 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10766 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10767 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10768 this can be used.
10769
10770
10771 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10772 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10773 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10774 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10775 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10776 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10777 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10778 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10779 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10780 case-independent.
10781
10782 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10783 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10784 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10785 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10786 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10787 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10788 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10789 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10790 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10791 case-independent.
10792
10793
10794 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10795 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10796 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10797 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10798 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10799 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10800 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10801 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10802 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10803 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10804 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10805 For example,
10806 .code
10807 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10808 .endd
10809 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10810 backslashes is also required.
10811
10812 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10813 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10814 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10815 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10816 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10817 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10818
10819 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10820 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10821 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10822 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10823 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10824 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10825 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10826 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10827
10828 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10829 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10830 See &*match_local_part*&.
10831
10832 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10833 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10834 See &*match_local_part*&.
10835
10836 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10837 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10838 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10839 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10840 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10841 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10842 .code
10843 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10844 .endd
10845 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10846
10847 .ilist
10848 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10849 .next
10850 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10851 .next
10852 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10853 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10854 in a single test such as
10855 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10856 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10857 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10858 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10859 .code
10860 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10861 .endd
10862 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10863 .next
10864 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10865 .next
10866 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10867 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10868 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10869 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10870 masks. For example:
10871 .code
10872 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10873 .endd
10874 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10875 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10876 address mask, for example:
10877 .code
10878 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10879 .endd
10880 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10881 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10882 .code
10883 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10884 .endd
10885 .endlist ilist
10886
10887 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10888 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10889
10890 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10891
10892 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10893 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10894 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10895 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10896 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10897 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10898 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10899 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10900 example is:
10901 .code
10902 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10903 .endd
10904 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10905 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10906 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10907 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10908 .code
10909 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10910 .endd
10911 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10912 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10913 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10914 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10915 caselessly.
10916
10917 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10918 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10919
10920 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10921 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10922 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10923 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10924
10925 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10926 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10927 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10928 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10929 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10930 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10931 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10932 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10933 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10934 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10935 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10936 .code
10937 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10938 .endd
10939 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10940 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10941
10942 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10943 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10944 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10945 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10946 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10947 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10948 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10949
10950 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10951 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10952 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10953 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10954 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10955 .code
10956 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10957 .endd
10958 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10959 .code
10960 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10961 .endd
10962 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10963 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10964 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10965 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10966 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10967 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10968 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10969 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10970
10971
10972 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10973 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10974 .cindex "Cyrus"
10975 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10976 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10977 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10978 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10979 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10980 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10981
10982 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10983 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10984 building Exim. For example:
10985 .code
10986 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10987 .endd
10988 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10989 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10990 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10991 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10992
10993 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10994 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10995 configuration, you might have this:
10996 .code
10997 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10998 .endd
10999 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11000 .code
11001 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11002 .endd
11003 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11004 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11005 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11006 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11007 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11008 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11009
11010
11011 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11012 .cindex "Radius"
11013 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11014 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11015 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11016 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11017 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11018 support.
11019
11020 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11021 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11022 this library, you need to set
11023 .code
11024 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11025 .endd
11026 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11027 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11028 .code
11029 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11030 .endd
11031 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11032 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11033 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11034
11035 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11036 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11037 the authentication is successful. For example:
11038 .code
11039 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11040 .endd
11041
11042
11043 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11044 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11045 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11046 .cindex "Cyrus"
11047 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11048 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11049 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11050 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11051 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11052 by a process that is not running as root.
11053
11054 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11055 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11056 building Exim. For example:
11057 .code
11058 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11059 .endd
11060 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11061 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11062 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11063
11064 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11065 two are mandatory. For example:
11066 .code
11067 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11068 .endd
11069 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11070 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11071 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11072 .endlist vlist
11073
11074
11075
11076 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11077 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11078 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11079 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11080 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11081 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11082 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11083
11084
11085 .vlist
11086 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11087 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11088 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11089 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11090 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11091 For example,
11092 .code
11093 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11094 .endd
11095 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11096 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11097 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11098
11099 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11100 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11101 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11102 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11103 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11104 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11105 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11106 parsed but not evaluated.
11107 .endlist
11108 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11109
11110
11111
11112
11113 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11114 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11115 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11116 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11117 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11118
11119 .vlist
11120 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11121 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11122 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11123 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11124 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11125 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11126 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11127 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11128 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11129 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11130 matching condition.
11131
11132 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11133 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11134 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11135 any unused variables being made empty.
11136
11137 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11138 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11139 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11140 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11141 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11142 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11143 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11144 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11145 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11146 during subsequent delivery.
11147
11148 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11149 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11150 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11151 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11152 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11153 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11154 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11155 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11156 delivery.
11157
11158 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11159 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11160 this variable has the number of arguments.
11161
11162 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11163 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11164 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11165 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11166 be preserved by coding like this:
11167 .code
11168 warn !verify = sender
11169 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11170 .endd
11171 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11172 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11173 failure.
11174
11175 .vitem &$address_data$&
11176 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11177 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11178 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11179 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11180 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11181 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11182 user filter files.
11183
11184 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11185 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11186 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11187 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11188 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11189 from the child's routing.
11190
11191 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11192 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11193 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11194 address.
11195
11196 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11197 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11198 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11199
11200 .vitem &$address_file$&
11201 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11202 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11203 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11204 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11205 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11206 .code
11207 /home/r2d2/savemail
11208 .endd
11209 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11210 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11211 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11212 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11213 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11214 to the relevant file.
11215
11216 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11217 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11218 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11219 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11220
11221 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11222 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11223 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11224 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11225
11226 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11227 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11228 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11229 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11230 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11231 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11232 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11233 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11234 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11235 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11236 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11237 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11238 command line option.
11239
11240 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11241 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11242 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11243 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11244 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11245 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11246 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11247 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11248 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11249 the ACL's as well.
11250
11251
11252 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11253 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11254 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11255 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11256 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11257 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11258 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11259 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11260 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11261 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11262 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11263
11264 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11265 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11266 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11267 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11268 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11269
11270
11271 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11272 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11273 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11274 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11275 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11276 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11277 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11278 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11279 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11280 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11281 an undefined mechanism.
11282
11283 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11284 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11285 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11286 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11287 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11288 the ACL malware condition.
11289
11290 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11291 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11292 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11293 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11294 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11295 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11296
11297 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11298 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11299 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11300 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11301 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11302 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11303 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11304
11305 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11306 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11307 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11308 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11309 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11310
11311 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11312 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11313 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11314 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11315 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11316
11317 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11318 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11319 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11320 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11321 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11322 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11323 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11324
11325 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11326 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11327 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11328 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11329 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11330 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11331 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11332
11333 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11334 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11335 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11336
11337 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11338 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11339 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11340 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11341 compilations of the same version of the program.
11342
11343 .new
11344 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11345 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11346 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11347 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11348 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11349 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11350
11351 .vitem &$config_file$&
11352 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11353 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11354 .wen
11355
11356 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11357 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11358 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11359 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11360 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11361
11362 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11363 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11364 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11365 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11366 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11367
11368 .new
11369 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11370 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11371 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11372 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11373 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11374 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11375 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11376 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11377 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11378 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11379 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11380 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11381 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11382 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11383 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11384 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11385 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11386 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11387 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11388 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11389 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11390
11391 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11392 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11393 When a message has been received this variable contains
11394 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11395 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11396 .wen
11397
11398 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11399 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11400 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11401 &$dnslist_value$&
11402 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11403 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11404 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11405 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11406 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11407 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11408 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11409 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11410 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11411
11412 .vitem &$domain$&
11413 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11414 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11415 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11416 case for &$domain$&.
11417
11418 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11419 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11420 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11421 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11422
11423 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11424 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11425 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11426 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11427 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11428 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11429
11430 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11431 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11432 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11433
11434 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11435
11436 .ilist
11437 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11438 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11439 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11440 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11441 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11442 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11443 the &(smtp)& transport.
11444
11445 .next
11446 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11447 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11448 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11449 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11450
11451 .next
11452 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11453 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11454 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11455 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11456 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11457 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11458
11459 .next
11460 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11461 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11462 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11463 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11464 .endlist
11465
11466
11467 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11468 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11469 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11470 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11471 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11472 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11473 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11474 used.
11475
11476 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11477 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11478 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11479 to nothing.
11480
11481 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11482 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11483 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11484
11485 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11486 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11487 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11488
11489 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11490 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11491 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11492
11493 .new
11494 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11495 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11496 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11497 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11498 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11499 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11500 .wen
11501
11502 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11503 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11504 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11505 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11506 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11507
11508 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11509 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11510 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11511 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11512 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11513
11514 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11515 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11516 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11517 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11518 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11519
11520 .vitem &$home$&
11521 .vindex "&$home$&"
11522 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11523 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11524 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11525 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11526 by a setting on the transport itself.
11527
11528 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11529 of the environment variable HOME.
11530
11531 .vitem &$host$&
11532 .vindex "&$host$&"
11533 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11534 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11535 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11536 to local and remote transports.
11537
11538 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11539 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11540 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11541 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11542 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11543 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11544 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11545 is connected.
11546
11547 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11548 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11549 client is connected.
11550
11551
11552 .vitem &$host_address$&
11553 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11554 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11555 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11556 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11557
11558 .vitem &$host_data$&
11559 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11560 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11561 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11562 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11563 .code
11564 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11565 message = $host_data
11566 .endd
11567 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11568 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11569 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11570 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11571 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11572 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11573 variables is set to &"1"&.
11574
11575 .ilist
11576 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11577 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11578
11579 .next
11580 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11581 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11582 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11583 .endlist ilist
11584
11585 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11586 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11587 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11588 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11589 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11590 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11591 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11592 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11593 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11594 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11595
11596 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11597 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11598 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11599
11600 .vitem &$host_port$&
11601 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11602 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11603 for an outbound connection.
11604
11605
11606 .vitem &$inode$&
11607 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11608 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11609 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11610 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11611 a unique name for the file.
11612
11613 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11614 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11615 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11616
11617 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11618 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11619 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11620
11621 .vitem &$item$&
11622 .vindex "&$item$&"
11623 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11624 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11625 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11626 empty.
11627
11628 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11629 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11630 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11631 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11632 lookup.
11633
11634 .vitem &$load_average$&
11635 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11636 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11637 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11638 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11639
11640 .vitem &$local_part$&
11641 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11642 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11643 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11644 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11645 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11646
11647 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11648 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11649 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11650 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11651 once.
11652
11653 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11654 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11655 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11656 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11657 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11658 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11659
11660 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11661 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11662 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11663 &$address_pipe$&).
11664
11665 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11666 local part of the recipient address.
11667
11668 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11669 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11670 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11671
11672 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11673 the addresses
11674 .code
11675 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11676 abc\:xyz@test.example
11677 .endd
11678 the value of &$local_part$& is
11679 .code
11680 abc:xyz
11681 .endd
11682 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11683 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11684 have:
11685 .code
11686 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11687 .endd
11688 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11689 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11690 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11691
11692 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11693 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11694 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11695 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11696 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11697 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11698 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11699
11700 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11701 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11702 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11703 variable expands to nothing.
11704
11705 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11706 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11707 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11708 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11709 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11710
11711 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11712 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11713 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11714 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11715 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11716
11717 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11718 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11719 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11720 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11721
11722 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11723 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11724 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11725
11726 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11727 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11728 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11729 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11730 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11731 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11732 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11733 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11734
11735 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11736 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11737 This contains the expanded value of the
11738 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11739 been read.
11740
11741 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11742 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11743 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11744 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11745 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11746 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11747
11748 .vitem &$log_space$&
11749 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11750 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11751 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11752 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11753 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11754 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11755
11756
11757 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11758 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11759 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11760 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11761 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11762 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11763 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11764 and &"yes"& if it was.
11765 .new
11766 Results that are labelled as authoritive answer that match
11767 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11768 as authenticated data.
11769 .wen
11770
11771 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11772 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11773 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11774 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11775 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11776 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11777 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11778 variable is empty.
11779
11780 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11781 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11782 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11783 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11784 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11785
11786 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11787 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11788 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11789 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11790 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11791 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11792 character(s).
11793
11794 .vitem &$message_age$&
11795 .cindex "message" "age of"
11796 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11797 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11798 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11799 delivery attempt.
11800
11801 .vitem &$message_body$&
11802 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11803 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11804 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11805 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11806 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11807 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11808 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11809 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11810 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11811
11812 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11813 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11814 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11815 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11816 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11817
11818 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11819 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11820 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11821 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11822 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11823 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11824 &$message_body$&.
11825
11826 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11827 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11828 .cindex "message body" "size"
11829 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11830 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11831 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11832 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11833 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11834
11835 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11836 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11837 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11838 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11839 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11840 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11841 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11842 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11843
11844 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11845 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11846 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11847 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11848 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11849 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11850
11851 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11852 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11853 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11854 contents of header lines is done.
11855
11856 .vitem &$message_id$&
11857 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11858
11859 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11860 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11861 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11862 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11863 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11864 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11865 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11866 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11867 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11868 from the body is not counted.
11869
11870 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11871 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11872 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11873 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11874 header and the body).
11875
11876 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11877 .code
11878 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11879 condition = \
11880 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11881 .endd
11882 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11883 message has not yet been received.
11884
11885 .vitem &$message_size$&
11886 .cindex "size" "of message"
11887 .cindex "message" "size"
11888 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11889 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11890 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11891 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11892 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11893 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11894 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11895 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11896 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11897
11898 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11899 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11900 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11901 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11902
11903 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11904 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11905 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11906 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11907
11908 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11909 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11910 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11911
11912 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11913 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11914 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11915 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11916 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11917 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11918 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11919 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11920 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11921 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11922
11923 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11924 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11925 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11926
11927 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11928 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11929 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11930 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11931 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11932 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11933 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11934 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11935 the original address.
11936
11937 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11938 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11939 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11940 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11941 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11942
11943 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11944 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11945 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11946
11947 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11948 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11949 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11950 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11951 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11952 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11953 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11954 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11955 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11956
11957 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11958 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11959 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11960 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11961 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11962 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11963 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11964 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11965 user.
11966
11967 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11968 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11969 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11970 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11971
11972 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11973 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11974 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11975 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11976
11977 .vitem &$pid$&
11978 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11979 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11980 This variable contains the current process id.
11981
11982 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11983 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11984 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11985 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11986 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11987 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11988 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11989 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11990 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11991 variable"& error if encountered.
11992
11993 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11994 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11995 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11996 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11997 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11998 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11999 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12000
12001
12002 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12003 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12004 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12005 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12006
12007 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12008 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12009 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12010 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12011
12012 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12013 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12014 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12015 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12016
12017 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12018 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12019 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12020
12021 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12022 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12023 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12024 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12025
12026 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12027 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12028 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12029 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12030 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12031
12032 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12033 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12034 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12035 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12036 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12037 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12038
12039 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12040 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12041 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12042 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12043 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12044
12045 .vitem &$received_count$&
12046 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12047 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12048 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12049 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12050 delivering.
12051
12052 .vitem &$received_for$&
12053 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12054 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12055 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12056 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12057 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12058
12059 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12060 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12061 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12062 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12063 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12064 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12065 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12066 option.
12067
12068 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12069 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12070 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12071 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12072 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12073 time.
12074 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12075
12076 .vitem &$received_port$&
12077 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12078 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12079
12080 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12081 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12082 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12083 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12084 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12085 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12086 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12087 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12088 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12089
12090 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12091 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12092 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12093 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12094 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12095 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12096
12097 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12098 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12099 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12100
12101 .vitem &$received_time$&
12102 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12103 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12104 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12105
12106 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12107 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12108 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12109 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12110 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12111 .display
12112 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12113 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12114 .endd
12115 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12116 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12117 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12118 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12119
12120 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12121 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12122 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12123 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12124
12125 .ilist
12126 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12127 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12128
12129 .next
12130 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12131
12132 .next
12133 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12134 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12135 MAIL).
12136
12137 .next
12138 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12139 .next
12140
12141 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12142 .endlist
12143
12144 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12145 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12146
12147 .vitem &$recipients$&
12148 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12149 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12150 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12151 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12152 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12153 cases:
12154
12155 .olist
12156 In a system filter file.
12157 .next
12158 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12159 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12160 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12161 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12162 .next
12163 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12164 .endlist
12165
12166
12167 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12168 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12169 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12170 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12171 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12172 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12173
12174
12175 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12176 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12177 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12178 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12179
12180
12181 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12182 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12183 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12184 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12185 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12186 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12187 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12188
12189 .vitem &$return_path$&
12190 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12191 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12192 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12193 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12194 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12195 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12196 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12197 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12198 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12199 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12200 envelope sender.
12201
12202 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12203 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12204 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12205
12206 .vitem &$router_name$&
12207 .cindex "router" "name"
12208 .cindex "name" "of router"
12209 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12210 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12211
12212 .vitem &$runrc$&
12213 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12214 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12215 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12216 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12217 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12218 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12219 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12220 another.
12221
12222 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12223 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12224 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12225 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12226 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12227 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12228 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12229 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12230
12231 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12232 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12233 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12234 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12235 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12236 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12237
12238 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12239 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12240 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12241 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12242 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12243 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12244 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12245 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12246
12247 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12248 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12249 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12250
12251 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12252 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12253 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12254
12255 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12256 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12257 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12258 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12259 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12260 this:
12261 .display
12262 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12263 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12264 .endd
12265 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12266 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12267 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12268 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12269
12270 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12271 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12272 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12273 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12274 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12275 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12276 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12277 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12278 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12279 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12280 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12281 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12282 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12283
12284 .new
12285 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12286 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12287 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12288 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12289 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticatied data.
12290 .wen
12291
12292 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12293 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12294 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12295 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12296 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12297 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12298
12299 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12300 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12301 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12302 this variable contains that
12303 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12304
12305 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12306 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12307 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12308 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12309 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12310 &$authenticated_id$&.
12311
12312 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12313 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12314 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12315 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12316 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12317 resolver library states that both
12318 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12319 other times, this variable is false.
12320
12321 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12322 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12323 library, by setting:
12324 .code
12325 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12326 .endd
12327
12328 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12329 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12330
12331 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12332 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12333
12334
12335 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12336 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12337 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12338 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12339 other means, this variable is empty.
12340
12341 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12342 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12343 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12344 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12345 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12346 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12347 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12348
12349 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12350 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12351 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12352 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12353
12354 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12355 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12356 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12357 is set to &"1"&.
12358
12359 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12360 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12361 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12362 following are true:
12363
12364 .ilist
12365 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12366 .next
12367 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12368 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12369 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12370 .next
12371 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12372 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12373 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12374 .next
12375 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12376 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12377 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12378 .next
12379 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12380 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12381 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12382 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12383 .code
12384 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12385 .endd
12386 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12387 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12388 .endlist
12389
12390
12391 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12392 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12393 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12394 number that was used on the remote host.
12395
12396 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12397 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12398 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12399 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12400 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12401 called Exim.
12402
12403 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12404 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12405 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12406 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12407
12408 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12409 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12410 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12411 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12412 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12413 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12414 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12415 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12416 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12417 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12418 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12419 the parentheses.
12420
12421 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12422 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12423 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12424 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12425 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12426
12427 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12428 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12429 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12430 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12431 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12432
12433 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12434 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12435 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12436 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12437 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12438 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12439 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12440
12441 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12442 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12443 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12444 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12445 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12446
12447 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12448 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12449 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12450 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12451 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12452 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12453
12454 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12455 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12456 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12457 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12458 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12459 .code
12460 MAIL FROM:<>
12461 MAIL FROM: <>
12462 .endd
12463 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12464 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12465 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12466 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12467
12468 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12469 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12470 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12471 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12472 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12473 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12474 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12475
12476 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12477 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12478 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12479 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12480 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12481 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12482 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12483 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12484 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12485 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12486 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12487
12488 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12489 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12490 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12491 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12492 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12493 message is junk mail.
12494
12495 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12496 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12497 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12498 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12499
12500
12501 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12502 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12503 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12504
12505 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12506 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12507 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12508 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12509 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12510 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12511
12512 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12513 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12514 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12515 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12516 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12517 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12518 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12519 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12520 .code
12521 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12522 .endd
12523 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12524
12525
12526 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12527 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12528 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12529 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12530 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12531 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12532
12533 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12534 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12535 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12536 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12537 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12538 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12539 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12540 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12541
12542 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12543 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12544 the outbound.
12545
12546 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12547 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12548 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12549 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12550 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12551 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12552
12553 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12554 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12555 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12556 inbound connection when the message was received.
12557 It is only useful as the argument of a
12558 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12559 or a &%def%& condition.
12560
12561 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12562 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12563 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12564 inbound connection when the message was received.
12565 It is only useful as the argument of a
12566 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12567 or a &%def%& condition.
12568 .new
12569 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12570 which is not the leaf.
12571 .wen
12572
12573 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12574 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12575 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12576 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12577 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12578 or a &%def%& condition.
12579
12580 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12581 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12582 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12583 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12584 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12585 or a &%def%& condition.
12586 .new
12587 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12588 which is not the leaf.
12589 .wen
12590
12591 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12592 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12593 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12594 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12595
12596 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12597 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12598 the outbound.
12599
12600 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12601 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12602 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12603 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12604 and &"0"& otherwise.
12605
12606 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12607 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12608 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12609 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12610 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12611 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12612 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12613 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12614 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12615
12616 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12617 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12618 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12619
12620 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12621 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12622 This variable is
12623 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12624 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12625 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12626 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12627
12628 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12629 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12630 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12631 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12632 .code
12633 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12634 1 No response to request
12635 2 Response not verified
12636 3 Verification failed
12637 4 Verification succeeded
12638 .endd
12639
12640 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12641 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12642 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12643 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12644 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12645
12646 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12647 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12648 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12649 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12650 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12651 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12652 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12653 .new
12654 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12655 which is not the leaf.
12656 .wen
12657
12658 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12659 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12660 the outbound.
12661
12662 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12663 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12664 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12665 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12666 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12667 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12668 .new
12669 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12670 which is not the leaf.
12671 .wen
12672
12673 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12674 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12675 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12676 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12677 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12678 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12679 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12680 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12681 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12682 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12683 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12684
12685 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12686 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12687 the outbound.
12688
12689 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12690 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12691 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12692 During outbound
12693 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12694 the transport.
12695
12696 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12697 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12698 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12699 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12700
12701 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12702 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12703 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12704
12705 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12706 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12707 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12708
12709 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12710 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12711 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12712 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12713 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12714 values for those that are behind (west).
12715
12716 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12717 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12718 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12719 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12720
12721 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12722 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12723 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12724 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12725 flag.
12726
12727 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12728 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12729 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12730 -0500.
12731
12732 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12733 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12734 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12735 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12736
12737 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12738 .cindex "transport" "name"
12739 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12740 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12741 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12742
12743 .vitem &$value$&
12744 .vindex "&$value$&"
12745 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12746 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12747 &*reduce*& expansion.
12748
12749 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12750 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12751 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12752 or for cutthrough delivery,
12753 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12754 Otherwise, empty.
12755
12756 .vitem &$version_number$&
12757 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12758 The version number of Exim.
12759
12760 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12761 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12762 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12763 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12764
12765 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12766 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12767 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12768 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12769 .endlist
12770 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12771
12772
12773
12774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12776
12777 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12778 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12779 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12780 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12781 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12782 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12783 the line
12784 .code
12785 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12786 .endd
12787 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12788
12789
12790 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12791 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12792 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12793 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12794 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12795 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12796 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12797 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12798 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12799
12800 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12801 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12802 should usually be something like
12803 .code
12804 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12805 .endd
12806 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12807 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12808 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12809 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12810 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12811 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12812 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12813 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12814 two ways:
12815
12816 .ilist
12817 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12818 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12819 a startup when Exim is entered.
12820 .next
12821 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12822 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12823 .endlist
12824
12825 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12826 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12827
12828
12829 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12830 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12831 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12832 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12833 forms:
12834 .code
12835 ${perl{foo}}
12836 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12837 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12838 .endd
12839 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12840 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12841 with an error message of the form
12842 .code
12843 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12844 .endd
12845 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12846 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12847 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12848 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12849 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12850 that was passed to &%die%&.
12851
12852
12853 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12854 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12855 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12856 the Perl code
12857 .code
12858 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12859 .endd
12860 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12861 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12862 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12863
12864 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12865 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12866 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12867 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12868
12869 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12870 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12871 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12872 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12873 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12874 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12875 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12876
12877
12878 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12879 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12880 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12881 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12882 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12883 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12884 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12885 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12886 avoided, but the output is lost.
12887
12888 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12889 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12890 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12891 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12892 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12893 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12894 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12895 .code
12896 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12897 .endd
12898 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12899 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12900 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12901 as the first subroutine argument.
12902 .ecindex IIDperl
12903
12904
12905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12907
12908 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12909 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12910 "Starting the daemon"
12911 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12912 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12913 .cindex "network interface"
12914 .cindex "interface" "network"
12915 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12916 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12917 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12918 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12919 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12920 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12921 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12922 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12923 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12924 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12925 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12926
12927 .olist
12928 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12929 and ports to listen on.
12930 .next
12931 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12932 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12933 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12934 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12935 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12936 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12937 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12938 as an error situation.
12939 .next
12940 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12941 for the outgoing connection.
12942 .endlist
12943
12944
12945 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12946 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12947 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12948 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12949 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12950
12951 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12952 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12953 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12954 chapter describes how they operate.
12955
12956 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12957 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12958
12959
12960
12961 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12962 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12963 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12964 following options:
12965
12966 .ilist
12967 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12968 or service names.
12969 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12970 .next
12971 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12972 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12973 .endlist
12974
12975 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12976 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12977 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12978 colons. For example:
12979 .code
12980 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12981 192.168.23.65 ; \
12982 ::1 ; \
12983 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12984 .endd
12985 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12986 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12987
12988 .olist
12989 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12990 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12991 .code
12992 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12993 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12994 .endd
12995 .next
12996 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12997 with a colon separator, for example:
12998 .code
12999 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13000 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13001 .endd
13002 .endlist
13003
13004 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13005 default setting contains just one port:
13006 .code
13007 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13008 .endd
13009 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13010 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13011 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13012 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13013 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13014
13015
13016
13017 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13018 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13019 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13020 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13021 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13022 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13023 .code
13024 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13025 .endd
13026 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13027 .code
13028 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13029 .endd
13030 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13031
13032
13033
13034 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13035 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13036 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13037 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13038 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13039 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13040 exim.
13041
13042 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13043 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13044 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13045 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13046 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13047 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13048 .code
13049 -oX 1225
13050 .endd
13051 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13052 whereas
13053 .code
13054 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13055 .endd
13056 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13057 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13058 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13059
13060
13061
13062 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13063 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13064 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13065 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13066 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13067 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13068 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13069 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13070 list of port numbers or service names,
13071 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13072 common use of this option is expected to be
13073 .code
13074 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13075 .endd
13076 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13077 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13078 this way when a daemon is started.
13079
13080 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13081 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13082 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13083 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13084 connections via the daemon.)
13085
13086
13087
13088
13089 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13090 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13091 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13092 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13093 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13094 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13095 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13096 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13097 .code
13098 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13099 .endd
13100 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13101 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13102 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13103 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13104 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13105 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13106 .code
13107 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13108 .endd
13109 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13110 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13111 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13112 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13113 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13114
13115 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13116 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13117 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13118 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13119 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13120 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13121 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13122 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13123 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13124 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13125 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13126 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13127
13128 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13129 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13130 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13131 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13132 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13133
13134
13135
13136 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13137 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13138 .code
13139 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13140 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13141 .endd
13142 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13143 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13144 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13145 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13146
13147 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13148 .code
13149 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13150 .endd
13151 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13152 .code
13153 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13154 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13155 .endd
13156 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13157 IPv4 loopback address only:
13158 .code
13159 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13160 .endd
13161 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13162 .code
13163 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13164 .endd
13165 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13166
13167
13168
13169 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13170 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13171 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13172 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13173 treated as local.
13174
13175 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13176 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13177 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13178 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13179
13180 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13181 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13182 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13183 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13184 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13185 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13186 used for listening. Consider this example:
13187 .code
13188 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13189 192.168.53.235 ; \
13190 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13191
13192 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13193 .endd
13194 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13195 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13196 Exim is routing.
13197
13198 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13199 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13200 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13201 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13202 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13203 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13204 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13205 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13206
13207
13208
13209 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13210 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13211 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13212 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13213 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13214 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13215 details.
13216
13217
13218
13219
13220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13221 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13222
13223 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13224 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13225 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13226 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13227
13228 .ilist
13229 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13230 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13231 .next
13232 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13233 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13234 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13235 .next
13236 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13237 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13238 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13239 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13240 settings.
13241 .endlist
13242
13243 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13244 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13245 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13246 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13247 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13248 listed in more than one group.
13249
13250 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13251 .table2
13252 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13253 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13254 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13255 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13256 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13257 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13258 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13259 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13260 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13261 .endtable
13262
13263
13264 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13265 .table2
13266 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13267 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13268 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13269 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13270 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13271 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13272 .endtable
13273
13274
13275
13276 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13277 .table2
13278 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13279 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13280 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13281 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13282 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13283 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13284 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13285 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13286 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13287 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13288 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13289 .endtable
13290
13291
13292
13293 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13294 .table2
13295 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13296 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13297 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13298 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13299 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13300 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13301 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13302 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13303 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13304 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13305 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13306 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13307 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13308 .endtable
13309
13310
13311
13312 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13313 .table2
13314 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13315 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13316 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13317 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13318 .endtable
13319
13320
13321
13322 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13323 .table2
13324 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13325 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13326 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13327 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13328 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13329 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13330 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13331 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13332 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13333 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13334 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13335 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13336 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13337 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13338 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13339 .endtable
13340
13341
13342
13343 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13344 .table2
13345 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13346 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13347 .endtable
13348
13349
13350
13351 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13352 .table2
13353 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13354 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13355 .endtable
13356
13357
13358
13359 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13360 .table2
13361 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13362 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13363 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13364 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13365 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13366 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13367 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13368 .endtable
13369
13370
13371
13372 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13373 .table2
13374 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13375 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13376 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13377 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13378 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13379 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13380 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13381 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13382 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13383 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13384 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13385 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13386 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13387 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13388 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13389 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13390 connection"
13391 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13392 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13393 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13394 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13395 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13396 .endtable
13397
13398
13399
13400 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13401 .table2
13402 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13403 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13404 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13405 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13406 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13407 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13408 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13409 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13410 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13411 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13412 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13413 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13414 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13415 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13416 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13417 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13418 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13419 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13420 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13421 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13422 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13423 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13424 words""&"
13425 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13426 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13427 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13428 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13429 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13430 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13431 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13432 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13433 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13434 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13435 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13436 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13437 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13438 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13439 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13440 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13441 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13442 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13443 .endtable
13444
13445
13446
13447 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13448 .table2
13449 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13450 item"
13451 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13452 item"
13453 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13454 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13455 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13456 .endtable
13457
13458
13459
13460 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13461 .table2
13462 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13463 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13464 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13465 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13466 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13467 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13468 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13469 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13470 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13471 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13472 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13473 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13474 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13475 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13476 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13477 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13478 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13479 .endtable
13480
13481
13482
13483 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13484 .table2
13485 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13486 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13487 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13488 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13489 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13490 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13491 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13492 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13493 .endtable
13494
13495
13496
13497 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13498 .table2
13499 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13500 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13501 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13502 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13503 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13504 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13505 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13506 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13507 .endtable
13508
13509
13510
13511
13512 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13513 .table2
13514 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13515 .endtable
13516
13517
13518
13519
13520
13521 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13522 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13523
13524 .table2
13525 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13526 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13527 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13528 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13529 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13530 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13531 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13532 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13533 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13534 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13535 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13536 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13537 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13538 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13539 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13540 connection"
13541 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13542 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13543 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13544 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13545 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13546 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13547 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13548 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13549 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13550 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13551 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13552 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13553 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13554 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13555 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13556 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13557 .endtable
13558
13559
13560
13561 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13562 .table2
13563 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13564 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13565 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13566 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13567 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13568 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13569 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13570 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13571 .endtable
13572
13573
13574
13575 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13576 .table2
13577 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13578 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13579 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13580 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13581 words""&"
13582 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13583 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13584 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13585 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13586 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13587 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13588 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13589 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13590 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13591 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13592 .endtable
13593
13594
13595
13596 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13597 .table2
13598 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13599 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13600 directory"
13601 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13602 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13603 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13604 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13605 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13606 .endtable
13607
13608
13609
13610 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13611 .table2
13612 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13613 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13614 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13615 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13616 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13617 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13618 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13619 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13620 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13621 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13622 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13623 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13624 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13625 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13626 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13627 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13628 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13629 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13630 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13631 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13632 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13633 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13634 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13635 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13636 .endtable
13637
13638
13639
13640 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13641 .table2
13642 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13643 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13644 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13645 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13646 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13647 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13648 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13649 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13650 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13651 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13652 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13653 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13654 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13655 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13656 .endtable
13657
13658
13659
13660 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13661 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13662 &dagger;.
13663
13664 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13665 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13666 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13667 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13668 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13669 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13670 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13671 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13672 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13673
13674 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13675 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13676 It now defaults to true.
13677 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13678 .display
13679 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13680 .endd
13681
13682 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13683 .code
13684 log_selector = +8bitmime
13685 .endd
13686
13687 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13688 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13689 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13690 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13691 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13692 further details.
13693
13694 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13695 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13696 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13697 SMTP messages.
13698
13699 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13700 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13701 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13702 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13703 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13704
13705 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13706 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13707 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13708 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13709 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13710
13711 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13712 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13713 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13714 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13715
13716 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13717 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13718 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13719 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13720 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13721
13722 .new
13723 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13724 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13725 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13726 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13727 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13728 .wen
13729 This option defines the ACL that,
13730 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13731 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13732 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13733 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13734
13735 .new
13736 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13737 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13738 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13739 of a received message.
13740 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13741 .wen
13742
13743 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13744 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13745 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13746 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13747
13748 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13749 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13750 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13751 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13752
13753 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13754 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13755 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13756 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13757 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13758
13759
13760 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13761 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13762 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13763 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13764
13765 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13766 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13767 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13768 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13769 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13770
13771 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13772 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13773 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13774 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13775 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13776
13777 .new
13778 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13779 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13780 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13781 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13782 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13783 .wen
13784
13785 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13786 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13787 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13788 further details.
13789
13790 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13791 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13792 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13793 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13794
13795 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13796 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13797 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13798 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13799
13800 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13801 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13802 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13803 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13804
13805 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13806 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13807 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13808 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13809
13810 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13811 .cindex "admin user"
13812 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13813 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13814 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13815 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13816 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13817 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13818 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13819
13820 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13821 .cindex "domain literal"
13822 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13823 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13824 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13825 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13826
13827 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13828 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13829 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13830 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13831 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13832 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13833 the local host's IP addresses.
13834
13835
13836 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13837 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13838 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13839 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13840 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13841 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13842 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13843 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13844 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13845
13846 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13847 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13848 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13849 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13850 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13851 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13852 experiment if they wish.
13853
13854 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13855 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13856 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13857 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13858 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13859 suitable setting is:
13860 .code
13861 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13862 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13863 .endd
13864 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13865 .code
13866 dns_check_names_pattern =
13867 .endd
13868 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13869
13870
13871 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13872 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13873 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13874 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13875 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13876 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13877 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13878 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13879 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13880 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13881 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13882
13883 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13884 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13885 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13886 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13887 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13888 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13889
13890 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13891 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13892 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13893 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13894 .code
13895 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13896 .endd
13897 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13898 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13899 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13900 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13901
13902
13903 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13904 .cindex "thawing messages"
13905 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13906 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13907 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13908 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13909 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13910 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13911
13912 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13913 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13914 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13915
13916
13917 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13918 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13919 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13920 .code
13921 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13922 .endd
13923 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13924 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13925
13926
13927 .option bi_command main string unset
13928 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13929 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13930 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13931 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13932 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13933
13934
13935 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13936 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13937 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13938 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13939 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13940 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13941
13942
13943 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13944 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13945 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13946 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13947
13948 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13949 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13950 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13951 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13952 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13953 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13954 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13955 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13956 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13957 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13958
13959 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13960 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13961 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13962 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13963
13964
13965 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13966 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13967 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13968 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13969 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13970 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13971 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13972 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13973 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13974
13975 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13976 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13977 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13978 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13979 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13980 messages.
13981
13982 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13983 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13984 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13985 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13986 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13987 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13988 connection. A typical setting might be:
13989 .code
13990 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13991 .endd
13992 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13993 .code
13994 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13995 .endd
13996 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13997 address.
13998
13999 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14000 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14001 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14002 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14003 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14004 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14005
14006
14007 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14008 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14009 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14010 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14011
14012
14013 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14014 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14015 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14016 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14017
14018
14019 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14020 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14021 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14022 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14023
14024
14025 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14026 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14027 callout verification. The default value is
14028 .code
14029 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14030 .endd
14031 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14032
14033
14034 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14035 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14036
14037
14038 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14039 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14040
14041 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14042 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14043 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14044 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14045 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14046 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14047 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14048 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14049 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14050 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14051
14052
14053 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14054 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14055
14056
14057 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14058 .cindex "checking disk space"
14059 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14060 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14061 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14062 message is accepted.
14063
14064 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14065 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14066 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14067 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14068 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14069 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14070 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14071 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14072
14073
14074 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14075 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14076 .code
14077 check_spool_space = 10M
14078 check_spool_inodes = 100
14079 .endd
14080 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14081 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14082 transit.
14083
14084 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14085 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14086 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14087
14088 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14089 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14090 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14091 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14092 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14093 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14094
14095 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14096 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14097
14098 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14099 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14100 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14101
14102 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14103 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14104 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14105 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14106 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14107 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14108
14109 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14110 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14111 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14112 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14113 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14114 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14115 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14116
14117 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14118 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14119
14120 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14121 .cindex "warning of delay"
14122 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14123 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14124 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14125 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14126 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14127 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14128 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14129 with
14130 .code
14131 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14132 .endd
14133 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14134 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14135 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14136 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14137 .code
14138 delay_warning = 6h
14139 .endd
14140 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14141 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14142 .code
14143 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14144 .endd
14145 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14146 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14147 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14148
14149 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14150 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14151 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14152 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14153 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14154 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14155 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14156 not sent. The default is:
14157 .code
14158 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14159 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14160 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14161 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14162 } {no}{yes}}
14163 .endd
14164 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14165 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14166 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14167 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14168
14169 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14170 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14171 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14172 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14173 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14174 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14175 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14176 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14177
14178 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14179 .cindex "load average"
14180 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14181 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14182 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14183 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14184 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14185
14186
14187 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14188 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14189 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14190 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14191 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14192 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14193 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14194 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14195
14196 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14197 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14198 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14199 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14200 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14201 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14202 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14203 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14204
14205 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14206 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14207 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14208 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14209
14210
14211 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14212 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14213 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14214 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14215 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14216 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14217 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14218
14219
14220 .new
14221 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14222 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14223 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14224 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14225 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14226 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14227 .wen
14228
14229
14230 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14231 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14232 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14233 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14234 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14235 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14236 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14237 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14238 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14239 by a setting such as this:
14240 .code
14241 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14242 .endd
14243 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14244 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14245 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14246 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14247 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14248 options are applied after this global option.
14249
14250 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14251 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14252 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14253 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14254 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14255 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14256 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14257 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14258 value of this option. The default pattern is
14259 .code
14260 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14261 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14262 .endd
14263 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14264 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14265 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14266 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14267 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14268 empty string.
14269
14270 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14271 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14272 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14273
14274 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14275 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14276 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14277 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14278
14279
14280 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14281 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14282 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14283 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14284 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14285 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14286
14287 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14288
14289
14290 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14291 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14292 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14293 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14294 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14295 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14296 domain matches this list.
14297
14298 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14299 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14300 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14301
14302
14303 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14304 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14305 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14306 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14307 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14308 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14309 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14310 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14311 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14312 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14313 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14314 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14315 to set in them.
14316 .new
14317 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14318 .wen
14319
14320
14321 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14322 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14323
14324
14325 .new
14326 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14327 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14328 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14329 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14330 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14331 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14332 match with this expanded domain list.
14333
14334 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14335 authoritive for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14336 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14337 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14338 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14339 a resolver that is an authoritive server for some zones.
14340
14341 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14342 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14343 zones that your resolver is authoritive for).
14344
14345 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14346 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14347 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14348 authoritive but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14349 record in the authoritive section is used instead.
14350 .wen
14351
14352 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14353 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14354 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14355 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14356 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14357 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14358 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14359 on.
14360
14361 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14362
14363
14364 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14365 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14366 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14367 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14368
14369 .new
14370 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14371 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14372 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14373 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14374 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14375 and accepted from, these hosts.
14376 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14377 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14378 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14379 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14380 are sent.
14381 .wen
14382
14383 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14384 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14385 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14386 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14387 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14388 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14389 .code
14390 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14391 .endd
14392 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14393 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14394
14395 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14396 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14397 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14398 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14399 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14400 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14401 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14402 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14403 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14404
14405
14406 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14407 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14408 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14409 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14410 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14411 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14412 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14413 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14414 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14415
14416 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14417 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14418 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14419 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14420 are examined. For example:
14421 .code
14422 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14423 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14424 postmaster@mydomain.example
14425 .endd
14426 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14427 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14428 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14429 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14430 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14431 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14432 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14433
14434
14435 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14436 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14437 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14438 .display
14439 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14440 .endd
14441 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14442 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14443 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14444 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14445 overrides the default.
14446
14447 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14448 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14449 and warning messages. For example:
14450 .code
14451 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14452 .endd
14453 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14454 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14455 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14456 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14457 not used.
14458
14459
14460 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14461 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14462 .cindex "Exim group"
14463 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14464 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14465 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14466 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14467 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14468 security issues.
14469
14470
14471 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14472 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14473 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14474 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14475 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14476 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14477 other place.
14478 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14479 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14480 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14481 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14482
14483
14484 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14485 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14486 .cindex "Exim user"
14487 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14488 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14489 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14490 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14491
14492 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14493 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14494 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14495 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14496
14497
14498 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14499 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14500 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14501 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14502
14503
14504 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14505 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14506
14507 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14508 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14509 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14510 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14511 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14512 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14513 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14514 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14515 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14516 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14517 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14518 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14519 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14520 addresses.
14521
14522
14523 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14524 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14525 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14526 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14527 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14528 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14529 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14530 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14531 retries.
14532
14533 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14534 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14535 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14536 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14537
14538
14539
14540 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14541 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14542 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14543 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14544 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14545 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14546 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14547 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14548 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14549 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14550 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14551 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14552 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14553 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14554 logging that you require.
14555
14556
14557 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14558 .cindex "HP-UX"
14559 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14560 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14561 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14562 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14563 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14564 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14565 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14566 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14567
14568 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14569 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14570 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14571 user's name.
14572
14573 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14574 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14575 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14576 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14577 .code
14578 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14579 gecos_name = $1
14580 .endd
14581
14582 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14583 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14584
14585
14586 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14587 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14588 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14589 implementations of TLS.
14590
14591
14592 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14593 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14594 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14595
14596 See
14597 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14598 for documentation.
14599
14600
14601
14602 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14603 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14604 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14605 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14606 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14607 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14608
14609
14610
14611 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14612 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14613 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14614 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14615 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14616 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14617 sections are rejected.
14618
14619
14620 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14621 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14622 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14623 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14624 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14625 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14626 zero means &"no limit"&.
14627
14628
14629
14630
14631 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14632 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14633 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14634 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14635 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14636 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14637 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14638 if you want to do semantic checking.
14639 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14640 set.
14641
14642
14643 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14644 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14645 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14646 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14647 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14648 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14649 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14650 .code
14651 helo_allow_chars = _
14652 .endd
14653 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14654
14655
14656 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14657 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14658 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14659 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14660 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14661 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14662 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14663 do.
14664
14665
14666 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14667 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14668 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14669 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14670 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14671 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14672 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14673 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14674 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14675 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14676 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14677 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14678
14679 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14680 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14681 EHLO command either:
14682
14683 .ilist
14684 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14685 .next
14686 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14687 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14688 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14689 calling host address, or
14690 .next
14691 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14692 .endlist
14693
14694 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14695 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14696 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14697
14698 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14699 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14700 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14701
14702 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14703 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14704 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14705 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14706 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14707 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14708 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14709 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14710 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14711 error.
14712
14713 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14714 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14715 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14716 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14717 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14718 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14719 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14720 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14721 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14722
14723 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14724 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14725 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14726 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14727 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14728
14729 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14730 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14731 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14732 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14733
14734
14735 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14736 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14737 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14738 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14739 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14740 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14741 default configuration file contains
14742 .code
14743 host_lookup = *
14744 .endd
14745 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14746 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14747
14748 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14749 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14750 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14751
14752 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14753 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14754 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14755 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14756 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14757 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14758
14759
14760 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14761 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14762 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14763 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14764 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14765 if you want.
14766
14767 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14768 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14769 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14770 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14771
14772
14773
14774 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14775 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14776 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14777 as soon as the connection is made.
14778 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14779 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14780 connections immediately.
14781
14782 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14783 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14784 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14785 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14786 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14787
14788
14789 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14790 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14791 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14792 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14793 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14794 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14795 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14796 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14797 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14798 .code
14799 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14800 .endd
14801 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14802
14803
14804
14805 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14806 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14807 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14808 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14809 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14810 records
14811 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14812 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14813
14814 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14815 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14816 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14817 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14818 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14819 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14820 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14821
14822
14823 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14824 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14825 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14826 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14827 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14828
14829
14830
14831 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14832 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14833 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14834 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14835 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14836 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14837
14838 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14839 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14840 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14841 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14842 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14843 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14844 for frozen messages. For example,
14845 .code
14846 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14847 .endd
14848 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14849 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14850 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14851 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14852 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14853 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14854
14855
14856 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14857 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14858 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14859 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14860 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14861 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14862 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14863 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14864 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14865 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14866
14867
14868 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14869 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14870
14871
14872 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14873 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14874 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14875 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14876 logged.
14877
14878
14879 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14880 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14881 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14882 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14883 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14884 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14885 and constrained to be a directory.
14886
14887
14888 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14889 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14890 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14891 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14892 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14893 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14894 and constrained to be a file.
14895
14896
14897 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14898 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14899 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14900 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14901 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14902
14903
14904 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14905 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14906 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14907 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14908 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14909 identity to be proven.
14910
14911
14912 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14913 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14914 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14915 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14916 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14917
14918
14919 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14920 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14921 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14922 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14923 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14924 with LDAP support.
14925
14926
14927 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14928 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14929 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14930 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14931 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14932 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14933 to hard/demand.
14934
14935
14936 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14937 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14938 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14939 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14940 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14941 of SSL-on-connect.
14942 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14943 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14944
14945
14946 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14947 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14948 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14949 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14950 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14951 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14952 has been built with LDAP support.
14953
14954
14955
14956 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14957 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14958 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14959 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14960 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14961 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14962 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14963
14964 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14965 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14966 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14967
14968 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14969 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14970 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14971 and the default qualify domain.
14972
14973 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14974 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14975 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14976 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14977
14978 .cindex "envelope sender"
14979 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14980 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14981 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14982
14983 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14984 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14985 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14986
14987
14988
14989
14990 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14991 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14992 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14993 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14994 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14995 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14996 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14997 example, if
14998 .code
14999 local_from_prefix = *-
15000 .endd
15001 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15002 .code
15003 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15004 .endd
15005 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15006 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15007 qualify domain.
15008
15009
15010 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15011 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15012
15013
15014 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15015 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15016 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15017 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15018 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15019 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15020 &%local_interfaces%& is
15021 .code
15022 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15023 .endd
15024 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15025 .code
15026 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15027 .endd
15028
15029 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15030 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15031 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15032 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15033 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15034 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15035 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15036 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15037
15038
15039
15040 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15041 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15042 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15043 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15044 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15045 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15046 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15047 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15048
15049
15050
15051
15052 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15053 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15054 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15055 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15056 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15057 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15058 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15059 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15060 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15061 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15062 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15063 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15064 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15065 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15066 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15067
15068
15069
15070 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15071 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15072 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15073 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15074 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15075 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15076 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15077 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15078 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15079 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15080 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15081 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15082 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15083 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15084 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15085
15086
15087 .option log_selector main string unset
15088 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15089 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15090 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15091 minus characters. For example:
15092 .code
15093 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15094 .endd
15095 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15096 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15097
15098
15099 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15100 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15101 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15102 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15103 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15104 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15105 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15106 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15107 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15108 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15109 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15110 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15111 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15112
15113
15114 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15115 .cindex "too many open files"
15116 .cindex "open files, too many"
15117 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15118 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15119 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15120 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15121 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15122 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15123 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15124 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15125 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15126 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15127 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15128 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15129
15130
15131 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15132 .cindex "length of login name"
15133 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15134 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15135 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15136 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15137 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15138 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15139
15140
15141 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15142 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15143 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15144 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15145 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15146 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15147 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15148 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15149
15150
15151 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15152 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15153 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15154 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15155 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15156 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15157 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15158
15159
15160 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15161 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15162 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15163 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15164 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15165 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15166 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15167 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15168 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15169 empty string, the option is ignored.
15170
15171
15172 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15173 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15174 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15175 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15176 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15177 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15178 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15179 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15180 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15181 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15182 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15183 colons will become hyphens.
15184
15185
15186 .option message_logs main boolean true
15187 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15188 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15189 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15190 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15191 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15192 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15193 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15194 which is not affected by this option.
15195
15196
15197 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15198 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15199 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15200 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15201 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15202 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15203 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15204 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15205 optionally followed by K or M.
15206
15207 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15208 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15209 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15210 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15211 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15212
15213 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15214 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15215 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15216 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15217 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15218 message that an individual transport can process.
15219
15220 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15221 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15222 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15223 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15224 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
15225 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15226 some problems may result.
15227
15228 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15229 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15230 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15231
15232
15233 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15234 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15235 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15236 .code
15237 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15238 .endd
15239 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15240 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15241 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15242 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15243 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15244
15245
15246 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15247 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15248 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15249 contains a full description of this facility.
15250
15251
15252
15253 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15254 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15255 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15256 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15257 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15258
15259
15260 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15261 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15262 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15263 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15264 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15265 safety precaution.
15266
15267 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15268 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15269 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15270 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15271 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15272
15273 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15274 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15275 example is
15276 .code
15277 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15278 .endd
15279 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15280 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15281 transport driver.
15282
15283
15284 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15285 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15286 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15287 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15288 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15289
15290 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15291 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15292 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15293 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15294 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15295 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15296 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15297
15298 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15299 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15300 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15301 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15302 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15303
15304 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15305
15306 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15307 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15308 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15309 some now infamous attacks.
15310
15311 Examples:
15312 .code
15313 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15314 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15315 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15316
15317 # Disable older protocol versions:
15318 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15319 .endd
15320
15321 Possible options may include:
15322 .ilist
15323 &`all`&
15324 .next
15325 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15326 .next
15327 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15328 .next
15329 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15330 .next
15331 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15332 .next
15333 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15334 .next
15335 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15336 .next
15337 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15338 .next
15339 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15340 .next
15341 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15342 .next
15343 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15344 .next
15345 &`no_compression`&
15346 .next
15347 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15348 .next
15349 &`no_sslv2`&
15350 .next
15351 &`no_sslv3`&
15352 .next
15353 &`no_ticket`&
15354 .next
15355 &`no_tlsv1`&
15356 .next
15357 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15358 .next
15359 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15360 .next
15361 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15362 .next
15363 &`single_dh_use`&
15364 .next
15365 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15366 .next
15367 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15368 .next
15369 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15370 .next
15371 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15372 .next
15373 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15374 .next
15375 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15376 .endlist
15377
15378 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15379 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15380 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15381 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15382 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15383 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15384
15385
15386 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15387 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15388 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15389 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15390 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15391
15392
15393 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15394 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15395 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15396 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15397 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15398 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15399 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15400 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15401 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15402 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15403 an ACL.
15404
15405 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15406 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15407 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15408 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15409 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15410 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15411 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15412
15413
15414 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15415 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15416 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15417
15418
15419 .option perl_startup main string unset
15420 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15421 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15422
15423
15424 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15425 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15426 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15427 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15428 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15429 PostgreSQL support.
15430
15431
15432 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15433 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15434 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15435 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15436 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15437 to the host name:
15438 .code
15439 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15440 .endd
15441 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15442 spool directory.
15443 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15444 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15445 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15446
15447
15448 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15449 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15450 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15451 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15452 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15453 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15454 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15455 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15456 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15457
15458
15459 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15460 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15461 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15462 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15463 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15464 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15465 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15466 is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15467
15468 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15469 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15470 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15471 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15472 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15473 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15474 volume of mail. Use with care!
15475
15476
15477 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15478 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15479 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15480 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15481 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15482 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15483 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15484 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15485 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15486 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15487
15488 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15489 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15490 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15491 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15492 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15493 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15494
15495
15496 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15497 .cindex "printing characters"
15498 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15499 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15500 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15501 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15502 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15503 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15504 characters.
15505
15506 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15507 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15508 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15509 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15510 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15511 standards.
15512
15513
15514 .option process_log_path main string unset
15515 .cindex "process log path"
15516 .cindex "log" "process log"
15517 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15518 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15519 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15520 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15521 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15522 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15523 different spool directories.
15524
15525
15526 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15527 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15528 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15529 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15530 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15531 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15532 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15533
15534
15535 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15536 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15537 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15538 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15539 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15540 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15541 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15542 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15543 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15544
15545 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15546 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15547 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15548 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15549 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15550 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15551 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15552
15553
15554 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15555 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15556 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15557
15558
15559
15560 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15561 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15562 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15563 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15564 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15565 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15566 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15567 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15568
15569
15570 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15571 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15572 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15573 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15574 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15575
15576
15577 .option queue_only main boolean false
15578 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15579 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15580 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15581 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15582 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15583 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15584
15585 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15586 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15587 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15588 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15589
15590
15591 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15592 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15593 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15594 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15595 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15596 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15597 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15598 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15599 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15600 .code
15601 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15602 .endd
15603 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15604 &_/some/file_& exists.
15605
15606
15607 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15608 .cindex "load average"
15609 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15610 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15611 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15612 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15613 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15614 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15615 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15616 false.
15617
15618 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15619 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15620 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15621 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15622
15623
15624 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15625 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15626 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15627 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15628 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15629 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15630 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15631 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15632 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15633 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15634 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15635 re-evaluated for each message.
15636
15637
15638 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15639 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15640 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15641 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15642 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15643 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15644
15645
15646 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15647 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15648 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15649 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15650 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15651 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15652 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15653 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15654 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15655 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15656 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15657 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15658 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15659
15660
15661
15662 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15663 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15664 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15665 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15666 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15667 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15668 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15669 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15670 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15671
15672 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15673 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15674 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15675 the daemon's command line.
15676
15677 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15678 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15679 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15680 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15681 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15682 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15683 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15684 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15685 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15686 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15687 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15688 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15689 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15690 &%queue_domains%&.
15691
15692
15693 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15694 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15695 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15696 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15697 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15698 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15699 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15700
15701 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15702 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15703 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15704 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15705 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15706 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15707 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15708 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15709 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15710 header lines. The default setting is:
15711
15712 .code
15713 received_header_text = Received: \
15714 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15715 {${if def:sender_ident \
15716 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15717 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15718 by $primary_hostname \
15719 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15720 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15721 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15722 ${if def:sender_address \
15723 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15724 id $message_exim_id\
15725 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15726 .endd
15727
15728 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15729 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15730 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15731 header lines such as the following:
15732 .code
15733 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15734 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15735 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15736 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15737 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15738 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15739 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15740 .endd
15741 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15742 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15743 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15744 message was accepted.
15745
15746
15747 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15748 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15749 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15750 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15751 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15752 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15753 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15754 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15755
15756
15757 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15758 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15759 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15760 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15761 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15762 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15763 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15764 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15765 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15766 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15767 option was not set.
15768
15769
15770 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15771 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15772 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15773 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15774 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15775 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15776 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15777 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15778 done.
15779
15780 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15781 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15782 RCPT commands in a single message.
15783
15784
15785 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15786 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15787 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15788 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15789 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15790 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15791 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15792
15793
15794 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15795 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15796 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15797 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15798 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15799 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15800 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15801 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15802 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15803 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15804 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15805 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15806 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15807 tagged with its process id.
15808
15809 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15810 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15811 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15812 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15813 is received.
15814
15815 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15816 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15817 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15818 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15819 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15820 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15821 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15822 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15823 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15824 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15825 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15826
15827 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15828 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15829 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15830 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15831
15832
15833 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15834 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15835 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15836 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15837 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15838 .code
15839 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15840 .endd
15841 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15842 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15843
15844
15845 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15846 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15847 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15848 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15849 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15850 past failures.
15851
15852
15853 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15854 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15855 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15856 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15857 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15858 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15859 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15860 the default value.
15861
15862
15863 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15864 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15865 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15866 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15867 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15868 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15869 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15870 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15871 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15872 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15873
15874
15875 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15876 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15877
15878
15879 .new
15880 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15881 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15882 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15883 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15884 an item in the list.
15885 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15886 for the system.
15887 .wen
15888
15889 .new
15890 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15891 .wen
15892 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15893 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15894 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15895 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15896
15897
15898 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15899 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15900 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15901 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15902 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15903 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15904 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15905 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15906 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15907 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15908
15909
15910 .new
15911 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15912 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15913 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15914 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15915 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15916 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15917 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15918 .wen
15919
15920
15921
15922 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15923 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15924 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15925 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15926 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15927 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15928 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15929 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15930 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15931 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15932 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15933
15934
15935
15936 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15937 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15938 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15939 .cindex "inetd"
15940 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15941 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15942 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15943 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15944 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15945 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15946
15947 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15948 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15949 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15950 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15951
15952
15953 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15954 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15955 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15956 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15957 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15958 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15959 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15960 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15961
15962 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15963 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15964 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15965 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15966 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15967 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15968 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15969 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15970
15971
15972 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15973 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15974 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15975 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15976 live with.
15977
15978
15979 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15980 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15981 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15982 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15983 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15984 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15985 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15986 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15987 . the option name to split.
15988
15989 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15990 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15991 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15992 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15993 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15994 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15995 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15996 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15997 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15998 seen).
15999
16000
16001 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16002 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16003 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16004 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16005 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16006 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16007 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16008 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16009 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16010 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16011 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16012
16013 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16014 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16015 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16016 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16017 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16018 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16019
16020
16021
16022 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16023 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16024 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16025 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16026 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16027 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16028 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16029 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16030 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16031 to all messages received in the same connection.
16032
16033 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16034 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16035 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16036 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16037
16038
16039 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16040
16041 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16042 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16043 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16044 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16045 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16046 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16047 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16048 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16049 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16050 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16051 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16052 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16053 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16054
16055
16056 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16057 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16058 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16059 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16060 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16061 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16062 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16063 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16064 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16065 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16066 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16067 individual host.
16068
16069 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16070 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16071 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16072 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16073
16074
16075 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16076 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16077 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16078 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16079 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16080 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16081 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16082 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16083 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16084
16085 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16086 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16087 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16088 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16089
16090 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16091 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16092 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16093 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16094 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16095 For example:
16096 .code
16097 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16098 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16099 .endd
16100
16101 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16102 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16103 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16104 &%helo_data%& value.
16105
16106 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16107 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16108 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16109 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16110 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16111 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16112 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16113 .code
16114 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16115 $version_number $tod_full
16116 .endd
16117 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16118 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16119 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16120 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16121 multiline response).
16122
16123
16124 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16125 .cindex "checking disk space"
16126 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16127 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16128 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16129 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16130 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16131 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16132 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16133
16134
16135 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16136 .cindex "connection backlog"
16137 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16138 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16139 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16140 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16141 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16142 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16143 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16144 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16145 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16146 attacks by SYN flooding.
16147
16148
16149 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16150 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16151 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16152 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16153 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16154 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16155 fewer, but they still exist.
16156
16157 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16158 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16159 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16160 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16161 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16162 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16163 does detect many instances.
16164
16165 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16166 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16167 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16168 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16169
16170
16171
16172 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16173 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16174 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16175 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16176 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16177 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16178 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16179 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16180 example:
16181 .code
16182 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16183 $sender_host_address
16184 .endd
16185 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16186 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16187 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16188 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16189 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16190 the command.
16191
16192
16193 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16194 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16195 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16196 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16197 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16198
16199
16200 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16201 .cindex "load average"
16202 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16203 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16204 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16205 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16206 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16207 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16208
16209
16210
16211 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16212 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16213 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16214 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16215 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16216 .code
16217 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16218 .endd
16219 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16220 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16221 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16222 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16223 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16224
16225 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16226 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16227 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16228 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16229 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16230 not count towards the limit.
16231
16232
16233
16234 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16235 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16236 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16237 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16238 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16239 that subvert web
16240 clients
16241 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16242 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16243
16244
16245
16246 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16247 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16248 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16249 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16250 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16251 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16252 recipients.
16253
16254 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16255 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16256 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16257 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16258
16259 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16260 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16261 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16262 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16263 values:
16264
16265 .ilist
16266 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16267 .next
16268 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16269 fractional parts are allowed here.
16270 .next
16271 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16272 .next
16273 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16274 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16275 .endlist
16276
16277 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16278 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16279 .code
16280 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16281 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16282 .endd
16283 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16284 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16285 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16286 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16287
16288
16289 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16290 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16291
16292
16293 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16294 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16295
16296
16297 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16298 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16299 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16300 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16301 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16302 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16303 the message is abandoned.
16304 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16305 .code
16306 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16307 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16308 .endd
16309 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16310 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16311
16312 .new
16313 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16314 expanded before use and may depend on
16315 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16316 .wen
16317
16318
16319 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16320 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16321 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16322 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16323 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16324 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16325
16326
16327 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16328 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16329 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16330
16331
16332 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16333 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16334 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16335 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16336 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16337 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16338 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16339 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16340 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16341 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16342 .code
16343 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16344 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16345 .endd
16346
16347 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16348 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16349 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16350 The default value is
16351 .code
16352 127.0.0.1 783
16353 .endd
16354 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16355
16356
16357
16358 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16359 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16360 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16361 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16362 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16363 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16364 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16365 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16366 arrival of the message.
16367
16368 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16369 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16370 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16371 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16372 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16373
16374 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16375 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16376 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16377 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16378 automatically deleted.
16379
16380 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16381 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16382 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16383 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16384 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16385 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16386 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16387 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16388 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16389
16390
16391 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16392 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16393 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16394 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16395 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16396 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16397 &$primary_hostname$&.
16398
16399 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16400 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16401 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16402 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16403 as failures in the configuration file.
16404
16405 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16406 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16407
16408 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16409 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16410 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16411 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16412
16413 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16414 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16415 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16416 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16417 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16418 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16419
16420 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16421 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16422 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16423 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16424 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16425 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16426 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16427
16428
16429 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16430 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16431 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16432 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16433 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16434 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16435 domain causes a syntax error.
16436 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16437 syntax checking.
16438
16439
16440 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16441 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16442 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16443 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16444 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16445 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16446 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16447 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16448 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16449 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16450 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16451 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16452
16453
16454 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16455 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16456 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16457 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16458 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16459 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16460 details of Exim's logging.
16461
16462
16463
16464 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16465 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16466 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16467 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16468 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16469
16470
16471
16472 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16473 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16474 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16475 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16476 details of Exim's logging.
16477
16478
16479 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16480 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16481 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16482 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16483 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16484 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16485 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16486 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16487 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16488 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16489 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16490
16491
16492 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16493 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16494 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16495 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16496 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16497 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16498
16499
16500 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16501 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16502 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16503 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16504 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16505
16506 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16507 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16508 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16509 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16510 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16511
16512 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16513 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16514 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16515 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16516 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16517 contains the pipe command.
16518
16519
16520 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16521 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16522 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16523 is used in a system filter.
16524
16525
16526 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16527 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16528 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16529 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16530 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16531 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16532 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16533 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16534 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16535 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16536
16537 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16538 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16539 transport option overrides.
16540
16541
16542 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16543 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16544 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16545 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16546 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16547 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16548 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16549 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16550 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16551 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16552 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16553 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16554 TCP_NODELAY.
16555
16556
16557 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16558 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16559 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16560 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16561 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16562 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16563 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16564 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16565 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16566 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16567
16568 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16569 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16570 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16571
16572
16573 .option timezone main string unset
16574 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16575 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16576 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16577 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16578 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16579 .code
16580 timezone = UTC
16581 .endd
16582 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16583 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16584 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16585 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16586 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16587 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16588
16589
16590 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16591 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16592 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16593 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16594 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16595 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16596 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16597 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16598
16599
16600 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16601 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16602 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16603 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16604 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16605 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16606 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16607
16608 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16609 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16610 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16611 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16612
16613 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16614 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16615 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16616 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16617
16618 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16619 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16620 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16621 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16622 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16623
16624 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16625
16626
16627 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16628 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16629 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16630 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16631 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16632 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16633
16634 The value must be at least 1024.
16635
16636 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16637 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16638 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16639
16640 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16641 number.
16642
16643 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16644 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16645 larger prime than requested.
16646
16647
16648 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16649 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16650 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16651 to be used by Exim.
16652
16653 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16654 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16655 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16656 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16657 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16658 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16659 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16660
16661 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16662 loaded by Exim.
16663
16664 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16665 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16666 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16667 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16668
16669 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16670 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16671 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16672 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16673
16674 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16675 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16676 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16677 "ike23".
16678
16679 The available primes are:
16680 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16681 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16682 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16683
16684 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16685 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16686
16687 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16688 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16689 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16690 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16691 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16692 userbase.
16693
16694 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16695 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16696 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16697 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16698 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16699 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16700 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16701
16702
16703 .new
16704 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16705 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16706 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16707 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16708
16709 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16710 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16711 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16712 which tell the library to choose.
16713
16714 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16715 .wen
16716
16717
16718 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16719 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16720 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16721 This option
16722 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16723 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16724 Certificate Authority.
16725
16726
16727 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16728 .cindex SSMTP
16729 .cindex SMTPS
16730 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16731 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16732 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16733 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16734
16735
16736
16737 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16738 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16739 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16740 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16741 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16742 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16743 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16744
16745 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16746
16747
16748 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16749 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16750 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16751 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16752 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16753 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16754 TLS session.
16755
16756
16757 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16758 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16759 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16760 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16761 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16762 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16763 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16764 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16765 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16766 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16767 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16768
16769
16770 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16771 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16772 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16773 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16774
16775
16776 .new
16777 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16778 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16779 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16780 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16781 word "system"
16782 or the absolute path to
16783 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16784 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16785
16786 The "system" value for the option will use a
16787 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16788 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16789 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16790 must be specified.
16791
16792 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
16793 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16794
16795 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16796 explicitly
16797 either by file or directory
16798 are added to those given by the system default location.
16799 .wen
16800
16801 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16802 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16803 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16804 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16805 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16806 use the explicit directory version.
16807
16808 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16809
16810 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16811 being unset.
16812
16813
16814 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16815 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16816 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16817 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16818 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16819 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16820 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16821 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16822
16823 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16824 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16825 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16826 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16827 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16828 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16829 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16830
16831 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16832 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16833 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16834 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16835 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16836 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16837 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16838 certificate"&.
16839
16840 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16841 certificates.
16842
16843
16844 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16845 .cindex "trusted groups"
16846 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16847 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16848 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16849 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16850 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16851 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16852 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16853 are trusted.
16854
16855 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16856 .cindex "trusted users"
16857 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16858 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16859 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16860 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16861 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16862 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16863 Exim user are trusted.
16864
16865 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16866 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16867 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16868 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16869 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16870 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16871 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16872 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16873 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16874 &%-F%& option.
16875
16876 .option unknown_username main string unset
16877 See &%unknown_login%&.
16878
16879 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16880 .cindex "trusted users"
16881 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16882 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16883 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16884 .cindex "envelope sender"
16885 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16886 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16887 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16888 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16889 is used) is ignored.
16890
16891 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16892 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16893 .code
16894 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16895 .endd
16896 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16897 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16898 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16899 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16900 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16901 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16902 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16903 followed by a hyphen
16904 by a setting like this:
16905 .code
16906 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16907 .endd
16908 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16909 restriction, you can use
16910 .code
16911 untrusted_set_sender = *
16912 .endd
16913 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16914 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16915 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16916 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16917 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16918 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16919 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16920 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16921
16922 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16923 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16924 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16925 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16926 sender address.
16927
16928
16929 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16930 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16931 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16932 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16933 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16934 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16935 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16936 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16937 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16938 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16939 .code
16940 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16941 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16942 .endd
16943 The pattern can be seen by running
16944 .code
16945 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16946 .endd
16947 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16948 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16949 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16950 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16951 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16952 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16953
16954
16955 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16956 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16957
16958
16959 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16960 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16961 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16962 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16963 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16964 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16965 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16966 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16967
16968
16969 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16970 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16971 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16972 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16973 .ecindex IIDconfima
16974 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16975
16976
16977
16978
16979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16980 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16981
16982 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16983 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16984 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16985 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16986 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16987
16988 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16989 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16990 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16991 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16992 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16993
16994
16995
16996 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16997 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16998 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16999 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17000 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17001 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17002 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17003
17004 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17005 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17006 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17007 routers, and the eventual transport.
17008
17009 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17010 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17011 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17012 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17013 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17014
17015 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17016 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17017 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17018 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17019 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17020
17021 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17022 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17023 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17024 .code
17025 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17026 .endd
17027 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17028 .code
17029 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17030 .endd
17031 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17032 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17033
17034 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17035 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17036 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17037 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17038 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17039 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17040 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17041
17042
17043
17044 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17045 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17046 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17047 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17048 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17049 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17050 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17051 routing.
17052
17053
17054
17055 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17056 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17057 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17058 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17059 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17060 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17061 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17062 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17063 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17064 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17065 you could put:
17066 .code
17067 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17068 .endd
17069 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17070 and
17071 .code
17072 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17073 .endd
17074 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17075 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17076 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17077 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17078
17079
17080 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17081 .cindex "case of local parts"
17082 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17083 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17084 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17085 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17086 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17087 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17088 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17089 more details.
17090
17091 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17092 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17093 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17094 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17095 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17096 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17097 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17098 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17099 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17100
17101 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17102 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17103 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17104 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17105
17106
17107
17108 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17109 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17110 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17111 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17112 .vindex "&$home$&"
17113 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17114 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17115 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17116 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17117 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17118 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17119 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17120 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17121 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17122 the router is skipped.
17123
17124 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17125 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17126 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17127 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17128 setting to achieve this. For example:
17129 .code
17130 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17131 .endd
17132 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17133 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17134 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17135
17136
17137
17138 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17139 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17140 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17141 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17142 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17143 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17144 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17145 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17146
17147 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17148 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17149
17150 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17151 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17152
17153 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17154 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17155 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17156 .code
17157 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17158 .endd
17159 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17160 .code
17161 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17162 .endd
17163
17164 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17165 .code
17166 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17167 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17168 condition = foobar
17169 .endd
17170
17171 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17172 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17173 be specified using &%condition%&.
17174
17175 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17176 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17177 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17178 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17179 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17180 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17181 Router rules processing behavior.
17182
17183 This is best illustrated in an example:
17184 .code
17185 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17186 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17187
17188 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17189 true {yes} {no}}
17190
17191 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17192 {yes} {no}}
17193 .endd
17194 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17195 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17196 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17197 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17198 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17199 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17200 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17201 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17202
17203 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17204 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17205 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17206 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17207 string characters.
17208
17209 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17210 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17211 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17212 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17213 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17214
17215
17216 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17217 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17218 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17219 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17220 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17221 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17222 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17223 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17224 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17225 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17226 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17227 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17228 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17229 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17230
17231
17232
17233 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17234 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17235 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17236 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17237 transport option of the same name.
17238
17239 .new
17240 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17241 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17242 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17243 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17244 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17245 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17246 the dnssec request bit set.
17247 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17248
17249 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17250 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17251 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17252 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17253 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17254 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17255 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17256 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17257 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17258 .wen
17259
17260
17261 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17262 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17263 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17264 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17265 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17266 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17267 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17268 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17269
17270
17271
17272 .option driver routers string unset
17273 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17274 to be used.
17275
17276
17277 .new
17278 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17279 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17280 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17281 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17282 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17283 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17284 Not effective on redirect routers.
17285 .wen
17286
17287
17288
17289 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17290 .cindex "envelope sender"
17291 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17292 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17293 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17294 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17295 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17296 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17297 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17298
17299 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17300 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17301 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17302 setting.
17303
17304 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17305 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17306 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17307 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17308
17309 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17310 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17311 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17312 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17313 settings:
17314 .code
17315 errors_to =
17316 errors_to = ""
17317 .endd
17318 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17319 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17320 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17321 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17322 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17323
17324 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17325 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17326 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17327 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17328 setting &%return_path%&.
17329
17330 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17331 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17332 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17333
17334
17335
17336 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17337 .cindex "address" "testing"
17338 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17339 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17340 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17341 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17342 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17343 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17344 on for the system alias file.
17345 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17346 are evaluated.
17347
17348 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17349 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17350 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17351
17352
17353
17354 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17355 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17356 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17357 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17358
17359
17360
17361 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17362 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17363 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17364
17365
17366
17367 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17368 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17369 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17370
17371
17372
17373 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17374 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17375 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17376 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17377 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17378 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17379 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17380 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17381 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17382
17383 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17384 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17385 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17386 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17387 transport for further details.
17388
17389
17390 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17391 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17392 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17393 .cindex "transport" "local"
17394 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17395 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17396 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17397 process.
17398 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17399 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17400 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17401 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17402 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17403
17404
17405
17406 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17407 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17408 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17409 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17410 .new
17411 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17412 .wen
17413 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17414 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17415 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17416 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17417 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17418 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17419 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17420 &"see"& the added header lines.
17421
17422 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17423 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17424 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17425 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17426
17427 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17428 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17429
17430 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17431 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17432
17433 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17434 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17435 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17436 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17437 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17438 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17439 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17440 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17441 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17442 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17443
17444
17445
17446 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17447 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17448 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17449 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17450 .new
17451 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17452 .wen
17453 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17454 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17455 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17456 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17457 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17458 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17459 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17460 &"see"& the original header lines.
17461
17462 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17463 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17464 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17465 errors.
17466
17467 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17468 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17469
17470 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17471 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17472
17473 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17474 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17475 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17476 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17477
17478 .new
17479 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17480 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17481 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17482 .wen
17483
17484
17485
17486 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17487 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17488 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17489 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17490 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17491 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17492 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17493 like
17494 .code
17495 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17496 .endd
17497 by setting
17498 .code
17499 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17500 .endd
17501 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17502 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17503 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17504 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17505 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17506 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17507
17508 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17509 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17510 .code
17511 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17512 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17513 .endd
17514 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17515 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17516
17517 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17518 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17519 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17520 domain that is being routed.
17521
17522 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17523 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17524 checked.
17525
17526 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17527 .cindex "additional groups"
17528 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17529 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17530 .cindex "transport" "local"
17531 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17532 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17533 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17534 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17535 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17536
17537
17538
17539 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17540 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17541 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17542 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17543 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17544 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17545 evaluated.
17546
17547 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17548 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17549 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17550 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17551 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17552 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17553 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17554 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17555 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17556
17557 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17558 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17559 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17560 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17561 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17562 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17563 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17564 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17565 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17566 the relevant transport.
17567
17568 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17569 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17570 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17571 callout.
17572
17573 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17574 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17575 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17576 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17577 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17578 .code
17579 real_localuser:
17580 driver = accept
17581 local_part_prefix = real-
17582 check_local_user
17583 transport = local_delivery
17584 .endd
17585 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17586 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17587 .code
17588 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17589 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17590 .endd
17591
17592 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17593 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17594 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17595 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17596
17597
17598 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17599 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17600
17601
17602
17603 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17604 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17605 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17606 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17607 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17608 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17609 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17610 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17611 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17612 &%username-foo%&.
17613
17614
17615 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17616 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17617
17618
17619
17620 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17621 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17622 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17623 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17624 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17625 are evaluated, and
17626 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17627 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17628 example:
17629 .code
17630 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17631 .endd
17632 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17633 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17634 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17635 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17636 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17637 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17638 each virtual domain:
17639 .code
17640 postmaster:
17641 driver = redirect
17642 local_parts = postmaster
17643 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17644 .endd
17645
17646
17647 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17648 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17649 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17650 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17651 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17652 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17653 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17654 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17655 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17656 redirect addresses.
17657
17658
17659
17660 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17661 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17662 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17663 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17664 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17665 delivery to be deferred.
17666
17667 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17668 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17669 .oindex "&%self%&"
17670 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17671 means of the setting
17672 .code
17673 self = pass
17674 .endd
17675 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17676 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17677 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17678
17679 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17680 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17681 controls what happens next.
17682
17683
17684 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17685 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17686 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17687 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17688 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17689 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17690 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17691 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17692
17693 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17694 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17695 applies to all of them.
17696
17697
17698
17699 .option pass_router routers string unset
17700 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17701 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17702 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17703 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17704 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17705 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17706 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17707 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17708 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17709 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17710
17711
17712
17713 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17714 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17715 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17716 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17717 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17718 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17719
17720 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17721 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17722 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17723 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17724
17725
17726
17727 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17728 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17729 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17730 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17731 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17732 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17733 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17734
17735 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17736 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17737 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17738 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17739
17740 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17741 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17742 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17743 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17744 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17745
17746 .cindex "NFS"
17747 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17748 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17749 unavailable.
17750
17751 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17752 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17753 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17754 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17755 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17756 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17757 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17758 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17759
17760 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17761 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17762 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17763 operates as follows:
17764
17765 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17766 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17767 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17768 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17769 used. For example:
17770 .code
17771 require_files = mail:/some/file
17772 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17773 .endd
17774 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17775 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17776
17777 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17778 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17779 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17780 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17781
17782 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17783 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17784 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17785 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17786 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17787
17788 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17789 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17790 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17791 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17792 check again in that process.
17793
17794 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17795 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17796 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17797 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17798 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17799 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17800 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17801 .code
17802 require_files = +/some/file
17803 .endd
17804 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17805 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17806 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17807
17808
17809
17810 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17811 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17812 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17813 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17814 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17815 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17816 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17817 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17818 latter kind.
17819
17820 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17821 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17822 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17823 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17824 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17825 same name.
17826
17827 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17828 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17829 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17830
17831
17832
17833 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17834 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17835 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17836 .vindex "&$home$&"
17837 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17838 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17839 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17840 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17841 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17842 cause the router to defer.
17843
17844 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17845 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17846 place.
17847 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17848 are evaluated.)
17849 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17850 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17851
17852 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17853 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17854 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17855 of these values that is set:
17856
17857 .ilist
17858 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17859 .next
17860 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17861 .next
17862 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17863 .next
17864 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17865 .endlist
17866
17867 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17868 router, but not for the transport.
17869
17870
17871
17872 .option self routers string freeze
17873 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17874 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17875 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17876 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17877 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17878 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17879 of remote hosts.
17880 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17881 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17882 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17883 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17884 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17885
17886 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17887 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17888 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17889 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17890 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17891 cases:
17892
17893 .vlist
17894 .vitem &%defer%&
17895 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17896
17897 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17898 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17899 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17900 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17901
17902 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17903 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17904 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17905 rewritten.
17906
17907 .vitem &%pass%&
17908 .oindex "&%more%&"
17909 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17910 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17911 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17912 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17913 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17914 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17915 combination
17916 .code
17917 self = pass
17918 no_more
17919 .endd
17920 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17921 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17922 be passed to the next router.
17923
17924 .vitem &%fail%&
17925 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17926
17927 .vitem &%send%&
17928 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17929 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17930 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17931 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17932 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17933 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17934 .endlist
17935
17936
17937
17938 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17939 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17940 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17941 address matches something on the list.
17942 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17943 are evaluated.
17944
17945 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17946 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17947 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17948 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17949 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17950 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17951 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17952 matters.
17953
17954
17955 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17956 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17957 .cindex "packet radio"
17958 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17959 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17960 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17961 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17962 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17963 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17964 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17965 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17966
17967 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17968 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17969 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17970 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17971 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17972 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17973 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17974 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17975 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17976 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17977 .code
17978 translate_ip_address = \
17979 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17980 {$value}fail}}
17981 .endd
17982 The file would contain lines like
17983 .code
17984 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17985 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17986 .endd
17987 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17988 are doing.
17989
17990
17991
17992 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17993 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17994 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17995 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17996 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17997 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17998 delivery is deferred.
17999
18000 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18001 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18002 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18003
18004
18005
18006 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18007 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18008 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18009 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18010 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18011 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18012 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18013 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18014 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18015 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18016 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18017 environment.
18018
18019
18020
18021
18022 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18023 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18024 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18025 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18026 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18027 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18028 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18029 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18030 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18031 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18032
18033 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18034 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18035 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18036 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18037 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18038
18039 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18040 environment.
18041
18042
18043
18044
18045 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18046 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18047 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18048 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18049 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18050 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18051 delivery to be deferred.
18052
18053 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18054 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18055 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18056 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18057 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18058 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18059
18060 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18061 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18062 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18063 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18064 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18065 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18066 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18067 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18068
18069 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18070 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18071 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18072 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18073 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18074 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18075 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18076 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18077 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18078 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18079
18080 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18081 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18082 subsequent routers.
18083
18084
18085 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18086 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18087 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18088 .cindex "transport" "local"
18089 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18090 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18091 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18092 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18093 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18094 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18095 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18096 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18097 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18098 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18099 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18100 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18101
18102
18103
18104 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18105 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18106 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18107
18108
18109 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18110 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18111 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18112 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18113 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18114 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18115 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18116 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18117 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18118 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18119
18120 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18121 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18122 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18123 user or group.
18124
18125
18126 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18127 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18128 addresses,
18129 delivering in cutthrough mode
18130 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18131 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18132 are evaluated.
18133 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18134
18135
18136 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18137 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18138 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18139 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18140 are evaluated.
18141 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18142 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18143 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18144
18145
18146
18147
18148
18149
18150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18152
18153 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18154 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18155 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18156 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18157 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18158 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18159 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18160 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18161 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18162 .code
18163 localusers:
18164 driver = accept
18165 domains = mydomain.example
18166 check_local_user
18167 transport = local_delivery
18168 .endd
18169 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18170 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18171 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18172 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18173
18174
18175
18176
18177
18178
18179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18181
18182 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18183 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18184 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18185 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18186 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18187 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18188
18189 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18190 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18191 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18192 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18193 records.
18194
18195 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18196 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18197 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18198 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18199 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18200 generic option, the router declines.
18201
18202 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18203 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18204 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18205
18206 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18207 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18208 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18209 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18210 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18211 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18212
18213
18214 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18215 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18216 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18217 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18218 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18219 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18220
18221 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18222 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18223 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18224 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18225 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18226 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18227 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18228 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18229 case routing fails.
18230
18231
18232 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18233 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18234 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18235 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18236 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18237
18238 .new
18239 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18240 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18241 .wen
18242
18243 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18244 .ilist
18245 The domain does not exist in DNS
18246 .next
18247 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18248 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18249 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18250 .next
18251 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18252 .next
18253 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18254 .next
18255 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18256 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18257 .next
18258 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18259 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18260 .next
18261 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18262 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18263 .next
18264 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18265 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18266 .endlist
18267
18268
18269
18270
18271 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18272 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18273 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18274
18275 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18276 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18277 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18278 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18279 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18280 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18281 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18282
18283
18284 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18285 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18286 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18287 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18288 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18289 required. For example,
18290 .code
18291 check_srv = smtp
18292 .endd
18293 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18294 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18295 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18296 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18297 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18298 normal way.
18299
18300 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18301 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18302 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18303 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18304 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18305 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18306
18307 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18308 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18309 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18310 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18311 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18312 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18313 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18314 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18315
18316 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18317 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18318
18319
18320
18321
18322 .new
18323 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18324 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18325 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18326 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18327 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18328 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18329 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18330 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18331 also being queued.
18332 .wen
18333
18334
18335 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18336 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18337 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18338 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18339 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18340 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18341 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18342 setting:
18343 .code
18344 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18345 .endd
18346 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18347 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18348 the address record.
18349
18350
18351 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18352 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18353 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18354 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18355
18356
18357
18358
18359 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18360 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18361 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18362 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18363 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18364 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18365 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18366 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18367 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18368 &'resolv.conf'&.
18369
18370
18371
18372 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18373 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18374 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18375 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18376 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18377 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18378 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18379 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18380 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18381 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18382 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18383
18384 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18385 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18386 sense.
18387
18388 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18389 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18390 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18391 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18392 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18393 header rewriting.
18394
18395
18396 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18397 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18398 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18399 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18400 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18401 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18402 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18403 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18404
18405 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18406 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18407 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18408 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18409 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18410 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18411 without processing them independently,
18412 provided the following conditions are met:
18413
18414 .ilist
18415 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18416 &%headers_remove%&.
18417 .next
18418 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18419 the domain.
18420 .endlist
18421
18422
18423
18424
18425 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18426 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18427 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18428 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18429 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18430 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18431 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18432 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18433 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18434 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18435
18436 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18437 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18438 local wildcard.
18439
18440
18441
18442 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18443 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18444 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18445 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18446
18447
18448
18449
18450 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18451 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18452 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18453 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18454 if
18455 .code
18456 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18457 .endd
18458 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18459 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18460 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18461 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18462 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18463 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18464
18465
18466 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18467 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18468 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18469 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18470 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18471
18472 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18473 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18474 such as that implied by
18475 .code
18476 domains = @mx_any
18477 .endd
18478 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18479 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18480 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18481 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18482
18483
18484
18485
18486
18487
18488
18489
18490
18491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18493
18494 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18495 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18496 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18497 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18498 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18499 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18500 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18501 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18502 router handles the address
18503 .code
18504 root@[192.168.1.1]
18505 .endd
18506 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18507 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18508 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18509 .code
18510 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18511 .endd
18512 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18513 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18514
18515 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18516 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18517 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18518 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18519
18520 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18521 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18522 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18523 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18524
18525
18526
18527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18529
18530 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18531 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18532 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18533 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18534 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18535 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18536 must set
18537 .code
18538 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18539 .endd
18540 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18541
18542 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18543 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18544 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18545 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18546 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18547 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18548 must not be specified for it.
18549
18550 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18551 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18552 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18553 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18554 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18555 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18556 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18557
18558
18559 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18560 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18561 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18562 delivery to the address is deferred.
18563
18564
18565 .option port iplookup integer 0
18566 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18567 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18568 call.
18569
18570
18571 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18572 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18573 protocols is to be used.
18574
18575
18576 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18577 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18578 default value is:
18579 .code
18580 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18581 .endd
18582 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18583 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18584
18585
18586 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18587 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18588 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18589 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18590 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18591 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18592 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18593 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18594
18595
18596 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18597 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18598 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18599 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18600 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18601 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18602 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18603 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18604 following could be used:
18605 .code
18606 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18607 reroute = $local_part@$1
18608 .endd
18609
18610 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18611 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18612 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18613 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18614
18615
18616
18617
18618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18620
18621 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18622 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18623 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18624 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18625 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18626 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18627 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18628 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18629 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18630 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18631
18632 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18633 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18634 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18635 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18636 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18637 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18638 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18639
18640 .vindex "&$host$&"
18641 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18642 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18643 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18644 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18645 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18646 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18647 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18648 text string.
18649
18650 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18651 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18652 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18653 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18654 below, following the list of private options.
18655
18656
18657 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18658
18659 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18660 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18661
18662 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18663 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18664
18665 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18666 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18667 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18668 of the following values:
18669 .code
18670 decline
18671 defer
18672 fail
18673 freeze
18674 ignore
18675 pass
18676 .endd
18677 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18678 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18679 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18680 &%pass_router%&),
18681 .oindex "&%more%&"
18682 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18683 router only if &%more%& is true.
18684
18685 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18686 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18687 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18688 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18689
18690 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18691 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18692 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18693
18694
18695 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18696 .cindex "randomized host list"
18697 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18698 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18699 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18700 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18701 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18702 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18703 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18704 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18705
18706 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18707 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18708 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18709 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18710 .code
18711 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18712 .endd
18713 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18714 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18715 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18716 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18717 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18718
18719
18720 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18721 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18722 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18723 example:
18724 .code
18725 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18726 .endd
18727 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18728 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18729 deferred.
18730
18731
18732 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18733 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18734 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18735 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18736
18737
18738 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18739 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18740 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18741 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18742 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18743 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18744 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18745 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18746
18747 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18748 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18749 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18750 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18751 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18752 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18753 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18754 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18755
18756
18757
18758
18759 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18760 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18761 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18762 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18763 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18764 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18765 .display
18766 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18767 .endd
18768 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18769 no options:
18770 .code
18771 route_list = \
18772 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18773 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18774 .endd
18775 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18776 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18777 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18778 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18779 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18780 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18781 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18782 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18783 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18784 in a &%route_list%&).
18785
18786 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18787 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18788 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18789 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18790
18791
18792
18793 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18794 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18795 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18796 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18797 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18798 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18799 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18800 like this:
18801 .code
18802 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18803 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18804 .endd
18805 This data can be accessed by setting
18806 .code
18807 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18808 .endd
18809 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18810 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18811 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18812 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18813 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18814
18815
18816
18817
18818 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18819 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18820 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18821 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18822 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18823 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18824 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18825
18826 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18827 variables are set during its expansion:
18828
18829 .ilist
18830 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18831 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18832 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18833 .code
18834 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18835 .endd
18836 .next
18837 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18838 .next
18839 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18840
18841 .next
18842 .vindex "&$value$&"
18843 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18844 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18845 .code
18846 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18847 .endd
18848 .endlist
18849
18850 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18851 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18852
18853
18854
18855 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18856 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18857 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18858 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18859 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18860 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18861
18862 .ilist
18863 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18864 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18865 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18866 .code
18867 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18868 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18869 .endd
18870 .next
18871 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18872 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18873 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18874 number follows. For example:
18875 .code
18876 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18877 .endd
18878 .endlist
18879
18880 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18881 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18882 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18883 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18884 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18885 transport.
18886
18887 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18888 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18889 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18890 records in the DNS. For example:
18891 .code
18892 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18893 .endd
18894 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18895 example:
18896 .code
18897 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18898 .endd
18899 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18900 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18901 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18902 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18903 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18904 happens is controlled by the
18905 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18906 &%self%& option of the router.
18907
18908 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18909 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18910 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18911 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18912 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18913 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18914 defined by MX preferences.
18915
18916 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18917 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18918 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18919
18920 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18921 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18922 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18923 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18924
18925 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18926 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18927 router.
18928
18929 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18930 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18931 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18932
18933 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18934 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18935
18936
18937
18938 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18939 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18940 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18941 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18942 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18943 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18944 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18945
18946 .ilist
18947 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18948 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18949 .next
18950 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18951 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18952 .next
18953 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18954 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18955 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18956 .next
18957 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18958 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18959 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18960 .endlist
18961
18962 For example:
18963 .code
18964 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18965 domain2 host4:host5
18966 .endd
18967 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18968 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18969 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18970 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18971 call.
18972
18973 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18974 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18975 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18976 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18977 function called.
18978
18979
18980
18981 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18982 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18983
18984 .vindex "&$host$&"
18985 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18986 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18987
18988
18989
18990 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18991 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18992 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18993
18994 .ilist
18995 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18996 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18997 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18998 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18999 .code
19000 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19001 .endd
19002 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19003 your first router something like this:
19004 .code
19005 smart_route:
19006 driver = manualroute
19007 domains = !+local_domains
19008 transport = remote_smtp
19009 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19010 .endd
19011 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19012 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19013 they are tried in order
19014 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19015 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19016 .code
19017 smart_route:
19018 driver = manualroute
19019 transport = remote_smtp
19020 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19021 .endd
19022 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19023 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19024 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19025 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19026 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19027 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19028 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19029 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19030
19031 .next
19032 .cindex "mail hub example"
19033 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19034 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19035 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19036 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19037 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19038 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19039 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19040 lookup is easier to manage.
19041
19042 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19043 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19044 example:
19045 .code
19046 hub_route:
19047 driver = manualroute
19048 transport = remote_smtp
19049 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19050 .endd
19051 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19052 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19053 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19054 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19055 domain can be used to find the host:
19056 .code
19057 through_firewall:
19058 driver = manualroute
19059 transport = remote_smtp
19060 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19061 .endd
19062 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19063 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19064 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19065 next router.
19066
19067 .next
19068 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19069 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19070 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19071 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19072 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19073 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19074 .code
19075 save_in_file:
19076 driver = manualroute
19077 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19078 route_list = saved.domain.example
19079 .endd
19080 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19081 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19082 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19083 .code
19084 save_in_file:
19085 driver = manualroute
19086 route_list = \
19087 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19088 *.saved.domain2.example \
19089 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19090 batch_pipe
19091 .endd
19092 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19093 .vindex "&$host$&"
19094 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19095 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19096 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19097 the address if the lookup fails.
19098
19099 .next
19100 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19101 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19102 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19103 one way it can be done:
19104 .code
19105 # Transport
19106 uucp:
19107 driver = pipe
19108 user = nobody
19109 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19110 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19111 return_fail_output = true
19112
19113 # Router
19114 uucphost:
19115 transport = uucp
19116 driver = manualroute
19117 route_data = \
19118 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19119 .endd
19120 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19121 .code
19122 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19123 .endd
19124 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19125 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19126 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19127 .endlist
19128 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19129 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19130
19131
19132
19133
19134
19135
19136
19137
19138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19140
19141 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19142 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19143 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19144 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19145 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19146 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19147 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19148 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19149 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19150 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19151 options:
19152 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19153
19154 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19155 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19156 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19157 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19158 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19159
19160
19161 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19162 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19163 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19164 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19165 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19166 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19167
19168
19169 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19170 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19171 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19172 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19173 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19174 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19175 not set, a value for the gid also.
19176
19177 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19178 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19179 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19180 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19181 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19182 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19183 gid.
19184
19185
19186 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19187 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19188 before running the command.
19189
19190
19191 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19192 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19193 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19194 timeout.
19195
19196
19197 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19198 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19199 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19200 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19201 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19202
19203 .ilist
19204 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19205 below).
19206 .next
19207 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19208 &%no_more%& is set.
19209 .next
19210 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19211 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19212 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19213 included in the SMTP response.
19214 .next
19215 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19216 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19217 included in any SMTP response.
19218 .next
19219 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19220 .next
19221 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19222 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19223 .next
19224 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19225 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19226 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19227 .endlist
19228
19229 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19230 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19231 the page):
19232 .code
19233 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19234 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19235 .endd
19236 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19237 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19238 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19239 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19240
19241 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19242 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19243 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19244 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19245 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19246
19247 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19248 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19249 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19250 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19251 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19252
19253 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19254 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19255 variable. For example, this return line
19256 .code
19257 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19258 .endd
19259 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19260 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19261 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19262 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19263
19264
19265
19266
19267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19269
19270 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19271 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19272 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19273 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19274 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19275 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19276 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19277 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19278 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19279 redirected in several different ways:
19280
19281 .ilist
19282 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19283 independently.
19284 .next
19285 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19286 .next
19287 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19288 .next
19289 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19290 .next
19291 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19292 .next
19293 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19294 .next
19295 It can be discarded.
19296 .endlist
19297
19298 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19299 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19300 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19301 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19302
19303 .new
19304 If success DSNs have been requested
19305 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19306 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19307 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19308 .wen
19309
19310
19311
19312 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19313 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19314 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19315 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19316 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19317 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19318 .code
19319 system_aliases:
19320 driver = redirect
19321 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19322 .endd
19323 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19324 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19325 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19326 cause delivery to be deferred.
19327
19328 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19329 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19330 .code
19331 userforward:
19332 driver = redirect
19333 check_local_user
19334 file = $home/.forward
19335 no_verify
19336 .endd
19337 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19338 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19339 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19340 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19341 comments.
19342
19343
19344
19345 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19346 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19347 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19348 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19349
19350 .ilist
19351 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19352 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19353 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19354 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19355 .next
19356 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19357 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19358 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19359 saves some resources.
19360 .endlist
19361
19362
19363
19364
19365
19366
19367 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19368 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19369 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19370 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19371 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19372
19373 .ilist
19374 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19375 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19376 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19377 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19378 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19379 document is intended for use by end users.
19380 .next
19381 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19382 described in the next section.
19383 .endlist
19384
19385 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19386 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19387 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19388 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19389 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19390
19391
19392
19393 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19394 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19395 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19396 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19397 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19398 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19399 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19400 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19401 commas or newlines.
19402 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19403 quotes.
19404
19405 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19406 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19407 next newline character is ignored.
19408
19409 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19410 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19411 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19412 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19413 removed.
19414
19415 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19416 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19417 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19418 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19419 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19420 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19421 setting:
19422 .code
19423 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19424 .endd
19425
19426
19427 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19428 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19429 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19430 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19431 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19432 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19433 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19434 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19435 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19436 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19437 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19438
19439 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19440 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19441 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19442 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19443 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19444 .code
19445 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19446 .endd
19447 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19448 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19449 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19450 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19451 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19452 synonymously.
19453
19454 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19455 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19456 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19457 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19458 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19459
19460 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19461 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19462 contains:
19463 .code
19464 Sam.Reman: spqr
19465 .endd
19466 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19467 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19468 this forward file:
19469 .code
19470 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19471 .endd
19472 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19473 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19474 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19475 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19476 should really contain
19477 .code
19478 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19479 .endd
19480 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19481 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19482 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19483
19484
19485
19486 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19487 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19488 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19489
19490 .ilist
19491 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19492 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19493 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19494 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19495 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19496 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19497 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19498
19499 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19500 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19501 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19502 in double quotes, for example:
19503 .code
19504 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19505 .endd
19506 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19507 quote just the command. An item such as
19508 .code
19509 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19510 .endd
19511 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19512
19513 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19514 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19515 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19516 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19517 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19518 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19519 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19520 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19521 an &%accept%& router.
19522
19523 .next
19524 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19525 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19526 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19527 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19528 .code
19529 /home/world/minbari
19530 .endd
19531 is treated as a file name, but
19532 .code
19533 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19534 .endd
19535 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19536 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19537 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19538 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19539
19540 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19541 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19542
19543 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19544 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19545 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19546 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19547
19548 .next
19549 .cindex "included address list"
19550 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19551 If an item is of the form
19552 .code
19553 :include:<path name>
19554 .endd
19555 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19556 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19557 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19558 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19559 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19560 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19561 .code
19562 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19563 .endd
19564 It must be given as
19565 .code
19566 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19567 .endd
19568 .next
19569 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19570 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19571 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19572 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19573 .cindex "black hole"
19574 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19575 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19576 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19577 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19578
19579 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19580 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19581 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19582 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19583 &_/dev/null_&.
19584
19585 .next
19586 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19587 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19588 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19589 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19590 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19591 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19592 redirection items of the form
19593 .code
19594 :defer:
19595 :fail:
19596 .endd
19597 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19598 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19599 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19600 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19601 .code
19602 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19603 .endd
19604 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19605 of a
19606 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19607 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19608 default.
19609 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19610 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19611 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19612
19613 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19614 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19615 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19616 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19617 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19618 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19619 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19620 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19621 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19622 ignored.
19623
19624 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19625 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19626 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19627 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19628
19629 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19630 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19631 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19632 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19633 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19634
19635 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19636 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19637 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19638 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19639 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19640 rules still apply.
19641
19642 .next
19643 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19644 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19645 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19646 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19647 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19648 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19649 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19650 .endlist
19651
19652
19653 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19654 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19655 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19656 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19657 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19658 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19659 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19660 aliasing scheme of the type
19661 .code
19662 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19663 localpart1: pipe
19664 localpart2: pipe
19665 .endd
19666 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19667 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19668 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19669 such as
19670 .code
19671 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19672 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19673 .endd
19674 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19675 the pipes are distinct.
19676
19677
19678
19679 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19680 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19681 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19682 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19683 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19684 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19685 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19686 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19687 can be used to avoid this.
19688
19689
19690 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19691 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19692 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19693 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19694 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19695 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19696 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19697
19698
19699
19700 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19701
19702 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19703 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19704
19705
19706 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19707 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19708 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19709
19710
19711 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19712 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19713 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19714 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19715
19716
19717 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19718 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19719 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19720 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19721 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19722 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19723 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19724
19725 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19726 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19727
19728
19729 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19730 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19731 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19732 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19733 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19734
19735
19736
19737 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19738 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19739 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19740 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19741 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19742 let ordinary users do.
19743
19744
19745
19746 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19747 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19748 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19749 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19750 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19751 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19752
19753 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19754 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19755 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19756 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19757 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19758 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19759 .code
19760 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19761 .endd
19762 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19763 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19764 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19765 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19766 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19767 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19768 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19769 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19770
19771
19772 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19773 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19774 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19775 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19776 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19777 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19778 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19779 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19780
19781
19782
19783 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19784 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19785 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19786 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19787 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19788 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19789
19790
19791 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19792 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19793 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19794 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19795 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19796 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19797
19798 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19799 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19800 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19801 .code
19802 data = #Exim filter\n\
19803 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19804 .endd
19805 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19806 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19807 choice into a newline.
19808
19809
19810 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19811 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19812 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19813 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19814 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19815
19816
19817 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19818 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19819 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19820 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19821 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19822 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19823 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19824 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19825
19826 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19827 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19828 runs a check on the containing directory,
19829 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19830 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19831 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19832 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19833 not, the router declines.
19834
19835
19836 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19837 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19838 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19839 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19840 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19841 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19842 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19843
19844
19845 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19846 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19847 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19848 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19849 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19850
19851
19852 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19853 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19854 redirection list.
19855
19856
19857 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19858 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19859 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19860
19861
19862
19863
19864 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19865 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19866 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19867 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19868 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19869 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19870 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19871 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19872 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19873
19874
19875 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19876 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19877 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19878 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19879 functions.
19880
19881 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19882 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19883 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19884 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19885
19886 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19887 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19888 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19889 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19890 &_.forward_& files).
19891
19892
19893 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19894 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19895 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19896
19897
19898 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19899 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19900 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19901 of the embedded Perl support.
19902
19903
19904 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19905 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19906 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19907
19908
19909 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19910 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19911 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19912
19913
19914 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19915 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19916 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19917 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19918 &%one_time%& is set.
19919
19920
19921 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19922 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19923 to make use of &%run%& items.
19924
19925
19926 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19927 If this option is true, items of the form
19928 .code
19929 :include:<path name>
19930 .endd
19931 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19932
19933
19934 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19935 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19936 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19937 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19938 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19939
19940
19941 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19942 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19943 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19944
19945
19946 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19947 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19948 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19949 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19950 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19951
19952
19953
19954
19955 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19956 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19957 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19958 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19959 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19960 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19961 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19962
19963
19964 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19965 .cindex "EACCES"
19966 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19967 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19968 file did not exist.
19969
19970
19971 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19972 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19973 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19974 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19975 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19976
19977 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19978 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19979 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19980 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19981 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19982 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19983 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19984 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19985
19986
19987
19988 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19989 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19990 redirection list must start with this directory.
19991
19992
19993 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19994 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19995 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19996
19997
19998 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19999 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20000 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20001 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20002 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20003 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20004 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20005 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20006 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20007 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20008 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20009 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20010 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20011 before they subscribed.
20012
20013 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20014 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20015 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20016 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20017 attempt.
20018
20019 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20020 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20021 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20022 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20023
20024 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20025 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20026 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20027
20028 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20029 &%one_time%&.
20030
20031 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20032 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20033 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20034 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20035 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20036 expansion.
20037
20038
20039 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20040 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20041 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20042 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20043 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20044 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20045 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20046 See &%check_owner%& above.
20047
20048
20049 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20050 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20051 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20052 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20053
20054
20055 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20056 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20057 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20058 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20059 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20060 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20061 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20062
20063
20064 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20065 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20066 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20067 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20068 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20069 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20070 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20071 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20072
20073 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20074 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20075 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20076 addresses.
20077
20078 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20079 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20080 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20081 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20082 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20083 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20084 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20085 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20086 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20087 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20088
20089
20090 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20091 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20092 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20093 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20094 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20095 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20096
20097
20098 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20099 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20100 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20101 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20102 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20103 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20104
20105
20106 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20107 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20108 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20109 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20110 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20111
20112
20113 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20114 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20115 :subaddress part of an address.
20116
20117 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20118 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20119 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20120 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20121
20122
20123 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20124 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20125 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20126 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20127 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20128 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20129 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20130
20131
20132
20133 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20134 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20135 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20136 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20137 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20138 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20139 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20140 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20141 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20142 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20143 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20144 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20145 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20146 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20147 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20148 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20149
20150 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20151 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20152 the following routers.
20153
20154 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20155 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20156 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20157 so it is passed to the following routers.
20158
20159 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20160 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20161 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20162 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20163
20164 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20165 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20166 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20167 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20168 .code
20169 userforward:
20170 driver = redirect
20171 allow_filter
20172 check_local_user
20173 file = $home/.forward
20174 file_transport = address_file
20175 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20176 reply_transport = address_reply
20177 no_verify
20178 skip_syntax_errors
20179 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20180 syntax_errors_text = \
20181 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20182 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20183 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20184 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20185 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20186 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20187 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20188 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20189 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20190 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20191 .endd
20192 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20193 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20194 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20195 .code
20196 real_localuser:
20197 driver = accept
20198 check_local_user
20199 local_part_prefix = real-
20200 transport = local_delivery
20201 .endd
20202 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20203 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20204 .code
20205 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20206 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20207 .endd
20208
20209
20210 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20211 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20212
20213
20214 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20215 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20216 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20217 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20218
20219
20220
20221
20222
20223
20224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20225 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20226
20227 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20228 "Environment for local transports"
20229 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20230 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20231 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20232 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20233 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20234 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20235 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20236
20237 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20238 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20239 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20240 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20241
20242 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20243 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20244 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20245 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20246 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20247
20248
20249
20250 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20251 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20252 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20253 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20254 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20255 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20256 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20257 time.
20258
20259 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20260 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20261 .code
20262 my_transport:
20263 driver = pipe
20264 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20265 .endd
20266 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20267 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20268 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20269 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20270
20271
20272
20273
20274 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20275 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20276 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20277 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20278 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20279 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20280 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20281 group (set by the transport). For example:
20282 .code
20283 # Routers ...
20284 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20285 local_users:
20286 driver = accept
20287 check_local_user
20288 transport = group_delivery
20289
20290 # Transports ...
20291 # This transport overrides the group
20292 group_delivery:
20293 driver = appendfile
20294 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20295 group = mail
20296 .endd
20297 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20298 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20299 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20300 set.
20301
20302 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20303 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20304 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20305 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20306 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20307 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20308
20309 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20310 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20311 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20312 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20313 original gid is also used.
20314
20315 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20316 following that is set is used:
20317
20318 .ilist
20319 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20320 .next
20321 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20322 .next
20323 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20324 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20325 .next
20326 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20327 .next
20328 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20329 the uid is the creator's uid;
20330 .next
20331 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20332 .endlist
20333
20334 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20335 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20336 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20337 The first of the following that is set is used:
20338
20339 .ilist
20340 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20341 .next
20342 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20343 .next
20344 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20345 .next
20346 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20347 .next
20348 The Exim uid.
20349 .endlist
20350
20351 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20352 &%never_users%& list.
20353
20354
20355
20356
20357
20358 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20359 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20360 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20361 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20362 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20363 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20364 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20365 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20366 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20367 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20368
20369 .ilist
20370 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20371 .next
20372 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20373 .next
20374 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20375 .next
20376 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20377 .endlist
20378
20379 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20380
20381 .ilist
20382 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20383 .next
20384 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20385 .endlist
20386
20387
20388 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20389 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20390 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20391
20392
20393
20394 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20395 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20396 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20397 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20398 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20399 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20400 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20401 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20402 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20403 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20404 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20405 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20406 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20407 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20408
20409
20410
20411
20412
20413
20414
20415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20417
20418 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20419 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20420 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20421 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20422 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20423
20424
20425 .option body_only transports boolean false
20426 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20427 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20428 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20429 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20430 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20431 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20432 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20433 automatically suppress them.
20434
20435
20436 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20437 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20438 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20439 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20440 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20441 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20442
20443
20444 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20445 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20446 deliveries by the transport or for any
20447 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20448 what you are doing.
20449
20450
20451 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20452 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20453 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20454 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20455 transport is run.
20456 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20457 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20458 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20459 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20460 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20461 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20462 one.
20463 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20464 transport and the router that called it.
20465
20466 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20467 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20468 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20469 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20470 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20471 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20472 safely be resent to other recipients.
20473
20474
20475 .option driver transports string unset
20476 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20477 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20478
20479
20480 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20481 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20482 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20483 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20484 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20485 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20486 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20487 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20488 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20489 resent to other recipients.
20490
20491
20492 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20493 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20494 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20495 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20496 &%user%& (see below).
20497
20498
20499 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20500 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20501 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20502 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20503 .new
20504 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20505 .wen
20506 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20507 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20508 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20509 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20510 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20511 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20512
20513 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20514 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20515
20516
20517 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20518 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20519 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20520 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20521 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20522 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20523 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20524 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20525
20526
20527 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20528 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20529 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20530 This option specifies a list of header names,
20531 .new
20532 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20533 .wen
20534 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20535 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20536 routers.
20537 Each list item is separately expanded.
20538 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20539 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20540 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20541
20542 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20543 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20544
20545 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20546 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20547 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20548
20549
20550
20551 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20552 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20553 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20554 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20555 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20556 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20557 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20558 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20559 example,
20560 .code
20561 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20562 x@y w@z
20563 .endd
20564 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20565 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20566 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20567 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20568 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20569 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20570 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20571 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20572 change envelope recipients at this time.
20573
20574
20575 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20576 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20577 .vindex "&$home$&"
20578 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20579 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20580 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20581 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20582 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20583 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20584 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20585 deferred.
20586
20587
20588 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20589 .cindex "additional groups"
20590 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20591 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20592 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20593 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20594 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20595
20596
20597 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20598 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20599 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20600 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20601 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20602 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20603 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20604 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20605 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20606 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20607 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20608 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20609 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20610 delivered.
20611
20612
20613
20614 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20615 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20616 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20617 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20618 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20619 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20620 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20621 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20622 that contains
20623 .code
20624 local_part_prefix = *-
20625 .endd
20626 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20627 is delivered with
20628 .code
20629 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20630 .endd
20631 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20632 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20633 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20634 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20635 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20636
20637
20638 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20639 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20640 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20641 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20642 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20643 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20644 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20645 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20646 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20647
20648 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20649 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20650 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20651 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20652
20653 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20654 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20655 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20656
20657
20658 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20659 .cindex "envelope sender"
20660 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20661 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20662 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20663 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20664 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20665 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20666 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20667 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20668 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20669
20670 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20671 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20672
20673 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20674 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20675 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20676 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20677 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20678 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20679 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20680
20681 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20682 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20683 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20684 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20685 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20686
20687
20688
20689 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20690 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20691 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20692 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20693 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20694 have easy access to it.
20695
20696 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20697 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20698 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20699 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20700 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20701 recipients.
20702
20703
20704 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20705 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20706
20707
20708 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20709 .cindex "shadow transport"
20710 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20711 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20712 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20713
20714 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20715 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20716 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20717 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20718 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20719 cause a log line to be written.
20720
20721 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20722 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20723 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20724 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20725 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20726 of the form
20727 .code
20728 ST=<shadow transport name>
20729 .endd
20730 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20731 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20732 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20733 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20734 headers that some sites insist on.
20735
20736
20737 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20738 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20739 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20740 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20741 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20742 individual users or via a system filter.
20743
20744 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20745 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20746 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20747 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20748 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20749
20750 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20751 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20752 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20753 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20754 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20755 &(pipe)& transports.
20756
20757 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20758 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20759 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20760 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20761 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20762
20763 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20764 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20765 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20766 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20767
20768 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20769 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20770 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20771 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20772 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20773 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20774
20775 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20776 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20777 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20778 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20779 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20780 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20781 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20782 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20783
20784 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20785 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20786 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20787 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20788 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20789 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20790 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20791 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20792 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20793 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20794
20795 .vindex "&$host$&"
20796 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20797 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20798 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20799 which the message is being sent. For example:
20800 .code
20801 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20802 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20803 .endd
20804
20805 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20806 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20807 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20808 .ilist
20809 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20810 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20811 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20812 example:
20813 .code
20814 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20815 .endd
20816 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20817 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20818 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20819 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20820 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20821 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20822 .next
20823 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20824 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20825 arguments. Consider this example:
20826 .code
20827 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20828 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20829 .endd
20830 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20831 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20832 .code
20833 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20834 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20835 .endd
20836 .endlist
20837
20838 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20839 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20840 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20841 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20842 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20843 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20844 bounced from a transport filter.
20845
20846 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20847 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20848 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20849
20850
20851 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20852 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20853 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20854 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20855 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20856 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20857 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20858 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20859 becomes a temporary error.
20860
20861
20862 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20863 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20864 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20865 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20866 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20867 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20868 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20869 option is not set.
20870
20871 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20872 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20873 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20874
20875 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20876 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20877 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20878 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20879 retry data.
20880 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20881 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20882 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20883
20884
20885
20886
20887
20888
20889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20891
20892 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20893 "Address batching"
20894 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20895 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20896 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20897 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20898 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20899 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20900 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20901
20902 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20903 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20904 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20905 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20906 local transport, for example:
20907
20908 .ilist
20909 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20910 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20911 recipients saves space.
20912 .next
20913 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20914 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20915 .next
20916 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20917 to a scanner program or
20918 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20919 acceptable.
20920 .endlist
20921
20922 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20923 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20924 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20925
20926 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20927 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20928 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20929 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20930 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20931 to certain conditions:
20932
20933 .ilist
20934 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20935 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20936 batching is possible.
20937 .next
20938 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20939 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20940 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20941 .next
20942 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20943 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20944 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20945 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20946 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20947 from taking place.
20948 .next
20949 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20950 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20951 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20952 be the same.
20953 .endlist
20954
20955 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20956 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20957 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20958 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20959 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20960 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20961 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20962 .code
20963 check_string = "."
20964 escape_string = ".."
20965 .endd
20966 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20967 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20968 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20969
20970 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20971 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20972 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20973 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20974 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20975 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20976
20977 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20978 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20979 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20980 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20981 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20982 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20983 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20984 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20985 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20986
20987
20988
20989
20990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20992
20993 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20994 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20995 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20996 .cindex "directory creation"
20997 .cindex "creating directories"
20998 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20999 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21000 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21001 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21002 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21003 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21004 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21005 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21006 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21007 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21008
21009 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21010 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21011 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21012 included.
21013
21014 .cindex "quota" "system"
21015 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21016 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21017 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21018
21019 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21020 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21021 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21022 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21023
21024 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21025 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21026 private options.
21027
21028 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21029 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21030 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21031 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21032 option).
21033
21034
21035
21036 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21037 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21038 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21039 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21040 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21041
21042 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21043 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21044 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21045 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21046 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21047 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21048 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21049 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21050 operation. There are two cases:
21051
21052 .ilist
21053 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21054 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21055 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21056 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21057 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21058 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21059 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21060 .next
21061 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21062 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21063 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21064 .endlist
21065
21066
21067 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21068 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21069 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21070 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21071 form:
21072 .code
21073 save folder23
21074 .endd
21075 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21076 .code
21077 require "fileinto";
21078 fileinto "folder23";
21079 .endd
21080 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21081 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21082 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21083 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21084 way of handling this requirement:
21085 .code
21086 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21087 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21088 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21089 {$address_file} \
21090 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21091 }} \
21092 }
21093 .endd
21094 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21095 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21096 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21097
21098 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21099 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21100 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21101 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21102 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21103 path to the transport.
21104
21105 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21106 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21107
21108
21109
21110
21111 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21112 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21113
21114
21115
21116 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21117 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21118 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21119 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21120 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21121 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21122 delivery is deferred.
21123
21124
21125 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21126 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21127 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21128 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21129 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21130 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21131 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21132 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21133
21134
21135 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21136 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21137 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21138 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21139 file.
21140
21141
21142 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21143 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21144
21145
21146 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21147 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21148 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21149 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21150 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21151
21152
21153 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21154 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21155 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21156 process is running.
21157
21158
21159 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21160 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21161 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21162 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21163 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21164 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21165 contains is significant.
21166
21167 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21168 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21169 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21170 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21171 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21172
21173 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21174 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21175 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21176 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21177 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21178 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21179 .code
21180 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21181 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21182 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21183 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21184 .endd
21185 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21186 .cindex "directory creation"
21187 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21188 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21189 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21190
21191 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21192 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21193 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21194 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21195 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21196
21197
21198
21199 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21200 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21201 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21202 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21203 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21204 beneath.
21205
21206 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21207 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21208 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21209 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21210 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21211 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21212 &%file_must_exist%&.
21213
21214
21215 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21216 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21217 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21218 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21219
21220 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21221 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21222 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21223 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21224 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21225
21226
21227 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21228 .cindex "base62"
21229 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21230 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21231 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21232 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21233 .code
21234 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21235 .endd
21236 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21237 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21238 option.
21239
21240
21241 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21242 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21243 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21244
21245
21246 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21247 See &%check_string%& above.
21248
21249
21250 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21251 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21252 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21253 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21254 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21255 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21256 &%file%&.
21257
21258 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21259 .cindex "locking files"
21260 .cindex "lock files"
21261 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21262 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21263
21264 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21265 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21266 examples:
21267 .code
21268 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21269 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21270 file = $home/inbox
21271 .endd
21272 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21273 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21274 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21275 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21276 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21277 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21278
21279
21280
21281 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21282 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21283 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21284 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21285 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21286 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21287 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21288 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21289 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21290 this added to it:
21291 .code
21292 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21293 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21294 .endd
21295 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21296 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21297 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21298 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21299 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21300 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21301 delivery is deferred.
21302
21303
21304 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21305 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21306 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21307 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21308
21309
21310 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21311 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21312 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21313 .cindex "locking files"
21314 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21315 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21316 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21317 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21318 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21319 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21320 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21321 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21322
21323 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21324 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21325 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21326 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21327
21328 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21329 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21330 retries is
21331 .code
21332 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21333 .endd
21334 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21335 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21336 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21337
21338 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21339 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21340 .code
21341 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21342 .endd
21343
21344 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21345 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21346 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21347 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21348
21349
21350 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21351 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21352 for details of locking.
21353
21354
21355 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21356 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21357 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21358
21359
21360 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21361 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21362 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21363
21364
21365 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21366 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21367 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21368 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21369 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21370
21371
21372 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21373 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21374 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21375 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21376 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21377 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21378 external source that maintains the data.
21379
21380
21381 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21382 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21383 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21384 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21385 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21386 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21387 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21388 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21389
21390
21391
21392 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21393 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21394 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21395 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21396 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21397 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21398 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21399 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21400 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21401 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21402
21403
21404 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21405 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21406 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21407 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21408 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21409 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21410 calculation. The default value is:
21411 .code
21412 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21413 .endd
21414 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21415 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21416 &_Trash_&
21417 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21418 .code
21419 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21420 .endd
21421 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21422 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21423 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21424 directly into that directory.
21425
21426
21427 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21428 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21429 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21430
21431
21432 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21433 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21434 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21435
21436
21437 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21438 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21439 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21440 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21441 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21442 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21443 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21444 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21445
21446 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21447 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21448 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21449 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21450 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21451 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21452 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21453 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21454 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21455 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21456
21457
21458 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21459 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21460 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21461 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21462 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21463 below for further details.
21464
21465
21466 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21467 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21468 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21469
21470
21471 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21472 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21473 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21474
21475
21476 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21477 .cindex "locking files"
21478 .cindex "file" "locking"
21479 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21480 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21481 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21482 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21483 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21484 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21485 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21486
21487 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21488 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21489 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21490 combination:
21491 .code
21492 mbx_format = true
21493 message_prefix =
21494 message_suffix =
21495 .endd
21496 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21497 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21498 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21499 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21500 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21501 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21502 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21503 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21504
21505 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21506 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21507 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21508 append messages to it.
21509
21510
21511 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21512 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21513 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21514 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21515 in which case it is:
21516 .code
21517 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21518 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21519 .endd
21520 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21521 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21522
21523 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21524 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21525 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21526 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21527 setting
21528 .code
21529 message_suffix =
21530 .endd
21531 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21532 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21533
21534 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21535 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21536 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21537 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21538 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21539 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21540 value, and this option is ignored.
21541
21542
21543 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21544 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21545 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21546 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21547 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21548
21549
21550 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21551 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21552 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21553 on users about incoming mail.
21554
21555
21556 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21557 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21558 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21559 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21560 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21561 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21562 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21563 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21564 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21565
21566 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21567 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21568 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21569
21570 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21571 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21572 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21573 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21574 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21575 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21576
21577 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21578 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21579 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21580 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21581 be handled.
21582
21583 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21584
21585 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21586 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21587 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21588 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21589 system quota failures.
21590
21591 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21592 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21593 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21594 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21595 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21596 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21597 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21598 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21599 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21600 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21601
21602
21603 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21604 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21605 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21606 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21607 delivery directory.
21608
21609
21610 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21611 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21612 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21613 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21614 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21615 &"no quota"&.
21616
21617
21618 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21619 See &%quota%& above.
21620
21621
21622 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21623 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21624 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21625 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21626 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21627 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21628 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21629
21630 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21631 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21632 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21633 the file length to the file name. For example:
21634 .code
21635 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21636 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21637 .endd
21638 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21639 number of lines in the message.
21640
21641 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21642 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21643 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21644
21645 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21646
21647
21648 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21649 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21650 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21651 .code
21652 quota_warn_message = "\
21653 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21654 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21655 This message is automatically created \
21656 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21657 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21658 a warning threshold that is\n\
21659 set by the system administrator.\n"
21660 .endd
21661
21662
21663 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21664 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21665 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21666 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21667 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21668 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21669 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21670 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21671 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21672 sign. For example:
21673 .code
21674 quota = 10M
21675 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21676 .endd
21677 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21678 percent sign is ignored.
21679
21680 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21681 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21682 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21683 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21684 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21685 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21686 .code
21687 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21688 .endd
21689 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21690 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21691 option.
21692
21693 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21694 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21695 percentage.
21696
21697
21698 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21699 .cindex "envelope sender"
21700 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21701 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21702 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21703 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21704 for details of batch SMTP.
21705
21706
21707 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21708 .cindex "carriage return"
21709 .cindex "linefeed"
21710 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21711 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21712 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21713 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21714
21715 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21716 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21717 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21718 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21719 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21720 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21721
21722
21723 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21724 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21725 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21726 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21727 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21728 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21729
21730
21731 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21732 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21733 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21734 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21735 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21736
21737 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21738 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21739 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21740 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21741
21742 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21743 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21744 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21745 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21746 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21747 error.
21748
21749 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21750 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21751
21752
21753 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21754 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21755 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21756 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21757 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21758 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21759 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21760
21761 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21762 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21763 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21764 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21765 file corruption.
21766
21767 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21768 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21769 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21770
21771
21772 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21773 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21774 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21775 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21776 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21777 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21778 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21779 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21780 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21781
21782 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21783 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21784 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21785 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21786
21787
21788
21789
21790 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21791 .cindex "appending to a file"
21792 .cindex "file" "appending"
21793 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21794
21795 .ilist
21796 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21797 return is given.
21798
21799 .next
21800 .cindex "directory creation"
21801 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21802 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21803 &%directory_mode%& option.
21804
21805 .next
21806 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21807 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21808 transport.
21809
21810 .next
21811 .cindex "file" "locking"
21812 .cindex "locking files"
21813 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21814 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21815 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21816
21817 .olist
21818 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21819 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21820 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21821 .next
21822 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21823 .next
21824 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21825 Unlink the hitching post name.
21826 .next
21827 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21828 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21829 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21830 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21831 .next
21832 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21833 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21834 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21835 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21836 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21837 it before trying again.
21838 .endlist olist
21839
21840 .next
21841 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21842 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21843 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21844
21845 .next
21846 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21847 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21848 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21849 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21850 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21851 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21852 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21853 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21854 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21855 checked.
21856
21857 .next
21858 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21859 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21860 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21861 delivery is deferred.
21862
21863 .next
21864 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21865 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21866 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21867 permissions.
21868
21869 .next
21870 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21871 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21872 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21873
21874 .next
21875 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21876 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21877 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21878
21879 .next
21880 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21881 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21882 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21883 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21884 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21885 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21886 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21887 that prevents link following.
21888
21889 .next
21890 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21891 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21892 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21893 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21894 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21895
21896 .next
21897 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21898
21899 .next
21900 .cindex "file" "locking"
21901 .cindex "locking files"
21902 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21903 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21904 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21905 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21906 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21907 .code
21908 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21909 .endd
21910 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21911 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21912 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21913
21914 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21915 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21916 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21917
21918 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21919 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21920 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21921 delivery is deferred.
21922
21923 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21924 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21925 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21926 immediately. It retries up to
21927 .code
21928 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21929 .endd
21930 times (rounded up).
21931 .endlist
21932
21933 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21934 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21935
21936
21937 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21938 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21939 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21940 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21941 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21942 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21943 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21944 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21945 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21946 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21947
21948 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21949 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21950 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21951 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21952 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21953 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21954 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21955
21956 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21957 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21958 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21959 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21960
21961
21962 .cindex "maildir format"
21963 .cindex "mailstore format"
21964 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21965 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21966 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21967 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21968 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21969
21970 .cindex "directory creation"
21971 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21972 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21973 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21974 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21975 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21976 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21977 deferred.
21978
21979
21980
21981 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21982 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21983 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21984 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21985 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21986 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21987 &_new_& subdirectory.
21988
21989 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21990 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21991 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21992 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21993 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21994 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21995 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21996
21997 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21998 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21999 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22000 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22001 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22002 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22003 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22004 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22005
22006 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22007 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22008 folders. Consider this example:
22009 .code
22010 maildir_format = true
22011 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22012 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22013 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22014 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22015 .endd
22016 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22017 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22018 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22019 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22020 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22021 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22022
22023 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22024 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22025 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22026 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22027 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22028
22029 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22030 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22031 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22032
22033 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22034 .cindex "maildir++"
22035 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22036 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22037 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22038 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22039 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22040 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22041 amount of space used.
22042
22043 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22044 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22045 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22046 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22047 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22048 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22049
22050
22051
22052
22053 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22054 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22055 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22056 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22057 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22058 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22059
22060
22061 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22062 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22063 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22064 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22065 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22066 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22067 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22068 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22069 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22070 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22071 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22072 backwards compatibility).
22073
22074 For one common implementation, you might set:
22075 .code
22076 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22077 .endd
22078 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22079
22080 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22081 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22082 &[stat()]& each message file.
22083
22084
22085 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22086 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22087 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22088 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22089 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22090 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22091 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22092 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22093 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22094
22095 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22096 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22097 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22098 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22099 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22100 need to know the quota.
22101
22102 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22103 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22104
22105 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22106 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22107 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22108 details.
22109
22110
22111 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22112 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22113 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22114 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22115 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22116 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22117 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22118 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22119
22120 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22121 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22122 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22123 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22124 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22125 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22126
22127 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22128 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22129 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22130 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22131 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22132 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22133
22134 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22135 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22136 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22137 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22138
22139
22140 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22141 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22142 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22143 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22144 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22145 .code
22146 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22147 .endd
22148 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22149 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22150 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22151 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22152 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22153
22154
22155
22156
22157
22158
22159 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22160 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22161
22162 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22163 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22164 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22165 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22166 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22167 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22168 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22169 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22170
22171 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22172 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22173 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22174 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22175 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22176
22177
22178 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22179 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22180 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22181 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22182 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22183
22184 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22185 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22186 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22187 transport is run as a consequence of a
22188 &%mail%&
22189 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22190 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22191 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22192 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22193 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22194 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22195
22196 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22197 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22198 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22199 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22200
22201 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22202 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22203 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22204 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22205 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22206 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22207 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22208
22209 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22210 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22211 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22212 the transport defers.
22213 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22214 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22215
22216 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22217 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22218 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22219 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22220
22221 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22222 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22223 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22224 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22225 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22226 problems. They are just discarded.
22227
22228
22229
22230 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22231 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22232
22233 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22234 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22235 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22236
22237
22238 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22239 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22240 when the message is specified by the transport.
22241
22242
22243 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22244 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22245 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22246 string comes first.
22247
22248
22249 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22250 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22251 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22252
22253
22254 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22255 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22256 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22257
22258
22259 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22260 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22261 specified by the transport.
22262
22263
22264 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22265 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22266 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22267 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22268
22269
22270 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22271 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22272 the message is specified by the transport.
22273
22274
22275 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22276 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22277 used.
22278
22279
22280 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22281 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22282 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22283 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22284 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22285
22286
22287
22288 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22289 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22290 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22291 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22292
22293 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22294 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22295 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22296 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22297 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22298 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22299 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22300 infinity.
22301
22302 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22303 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22304 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22305 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22306 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22307
22308 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22309 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22310 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22311 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22312 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22313 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22314
22315
22316 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22317 See &%once%& above.
22318
22319
22320 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22321 See &%once%& above.
22322 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22323
22324
22325 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22326 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22327 specified by the transport.
22328
22329
22330 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22331 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22332 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22333 configuration option.
22334
22335
22336 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22337 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22338 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22339 automatic responses. For example:
22340 .code
22341 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22342 .endd
22343 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22344 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22345 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22346 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22347 small.
22348
22349
22350
22351 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22352 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22353 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22354 the text comes first.
22355
22356
22357 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22358 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22359 when the message is specified by the transport.
22360 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22361 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22362
22363
22364
22365
22366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22367 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22368
22369 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22370 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22371 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22372 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22373 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22374 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22375 specified command
22376 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22377 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22378 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22379 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22380 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22381 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22382 .code
22383 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22384 .endd
22385 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22386 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22387 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22388 as follows:
22389
22390 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22391 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22392
22393
22394 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22395 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22396 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22397 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22398 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22399
22400
22401 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22402 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22403 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22404 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22405 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22406 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22407 LMTP protocol.
22408
22409 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22410 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22411 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22412 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22413 in its response to the LHLO command.
22414
22415 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22416 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22417 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22418 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22419
22420
22421 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22422 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22423 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22424 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22425 LMTP transport:
22426 .code
22427 lmtp:
22428 driver = lmtp
22429 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22430 batch_max = 20
22431 user = exim
22432 .endd
22433 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22434 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22435
22436
22437
22438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22440
22441 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22442 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22443 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22444 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22445 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22446 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22447 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22448 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22449 following ways:
22450
22451 .ilist
22452 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22453 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22454 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22455 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22456 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22457 .next
22458 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22459 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22460 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22461 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22462 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22463 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22464 that are routed to the transport.
22465 .next
22466 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22467 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22468 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22469 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22470 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22471 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22472 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22473 .endlist
22474
22475
22476 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22477 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22478 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22479
22480 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22481 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22482 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22483 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22484 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22485 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22486 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22487
22488
22489 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22490 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22491 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22492 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22493 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22494
22495
22496
22497
22498 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22499 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22500 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22501 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22502 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22503 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22504 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22505 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22506 &"local delivery failed"&.
22507
22508 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22509 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22510 will be sent as normal.
22511
22512 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22513 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22514 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22515 apply in this case.
22516
22517 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22518 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22519 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22520 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22521
22522 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22523 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22524 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22525 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22526 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22527 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22528 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22529 &%temp_errors%&.
22530
22531
22532
22533 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22534 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22535 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22536 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22537 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22538 run.
22539
22540 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22541 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22542 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22543 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22544
22545 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22546 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22547 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22548 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22549 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22550 .code
22551 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22552 .endd
22553 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22554 arguments. You have to write
22555 .code
22556 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22557 .endd
22558 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22559 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22560 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22561 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22562 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22563 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22564 example:
22565 .code
22566 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22567 .endd
22568
22569 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22570 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22571 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22572 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22573 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22574 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22575 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22576 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22577 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22578 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22579
22580 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22581 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22582 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22583 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22584 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22585 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22586 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22587 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22588
22589 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22590 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22591 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22592 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22593 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22594 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22595 control what is done with it.
22596
22597 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22598 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22599 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22600 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22601 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22602 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22603 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22604 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22605 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22606 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22607 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22608
22609
22610
22611 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22612 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22613 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22614 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22615 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22616 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22617 environment.
22618 .display
22619 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22620 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22621 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22622 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22623 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22624 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22625 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22626 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22627 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22628 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22629 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22630 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22631 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22632 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22633 &`USER `& see below
22634 .endd
22635 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22636 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22637 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22638 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22639 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22640 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22641 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22642
22643 .cindex "HOST"
22644 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22645 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22646 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22647 the router.
22648
22649 .cindex "HOME"
22650 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22651 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22652 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22653 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22654
22655
22656 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22657 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22658
22659
22660
22661 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22662 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22663 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22664 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22665 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22666 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22667 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22668 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22669 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22670 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22671 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22672 example, if
22673 .code
22674 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22675 .endd
22676 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22677 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22678 &%use_shell%& is set.
22679
22680
22681 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22682 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22683
22684
22685 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22686 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22687 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22688
22689
22690 .option check_string pipe string unset
22691 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22692 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22693 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22694 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22695 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22696 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22697 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22698 ignored.
22699
22700
22701 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22702 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22703 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22704 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22705 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22706 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22707 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22708
22709
22710 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22711 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22712 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22713 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22714 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22715 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22716 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22717
22718
22719 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22720 See &%check_string%& above.
22721
22722
22723 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22724 .cindex "exec failure"
22725 .cindex "failure of exec"
22726 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22727 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22728 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22729 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22730 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22731
22732
22733 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22734 .cindex "signal exit"
22735 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22736 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22737 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22738 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22739
22740
22741 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22742 .cindex "force command"
22743 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22744 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22745 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22746 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22747 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22748 command. For example:
22749 .code
22750 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22751 force_command
22752 .endd
22753
22754 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22755 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22756 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22757
22758 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22759 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22760 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22761 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22762 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22763 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22764
22765 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22766 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22767
22768 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22769 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22770 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22771 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22772 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22773
22774
22775 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22776 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22777 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22778 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22779 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22780 Only one of them may be set.
22781
22782
22783
22784 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22785 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22786 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22787 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22788
22789
22790
22791 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22792 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22793 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22794 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22795 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22796 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22797 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22798 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22799
22800
22801 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22802 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22803 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22804 .code
22805 message_prefix = \
22806 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22807 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22808 .endd
22809 .cindex "Cyrus"
22810 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22811 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22812 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22813 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22814 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22815 setting
22816 .code
22817 message_prefix =
22818 .endd
22819 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22820 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22821
22822
22823 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22824 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22825 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22826 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22827 .code
22828 message_suffix =
22829 .endd
22830 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22831 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22832
22833
22834 .option path pipe string "see below"
22835 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22836 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22837 .code
22838 /bin:/usr/bin
22839 .endd
22840 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22841 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22842 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22843
22844
22845 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22846 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22847 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22848 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22849 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22850 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22851 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22852 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22853 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22854
22855
22856 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22857 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22858 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22859 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22860 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22861 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22862 accept the message is used.
22863
22864
22865 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22866 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22867 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22868 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22869 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22870 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22871
22872
22873 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22874 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22875 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22876 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22877 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22878 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22879 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22880
22881
22882
22883 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22884 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22885 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22886 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22887 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22888 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22889 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22890 of them may be set.
22891
22892
22893
22894 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22895 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22896 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22897 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22898 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22899 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22900 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22901 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22902 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22903 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22904 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22905 and 73, respectively.
22906
22907
22908 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22909 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22910 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22911 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22912 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22913 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22914 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22915
22916 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22917 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22918 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22919 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22920 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22921 delivery to be deferred.
22922
22923 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22924 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22925
22926
22927 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22928 .cindex "envelope sender"
22929 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22930 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22931 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22932 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22933 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22934
22935 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22936 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22937 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22938 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22939 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22940 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22941 class database.
22942
22943
22944 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22945 .cindex "carriage return"
22946 .cindex "linefeed"
22947 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22948 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22949 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22950 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22951
22952 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22953 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22954 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22955 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22956 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22957
22958
22959 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22960 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22961 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22962 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22963 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22964 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22965 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22966 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22967 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22968 its &%-c%& option.
22969
22970
22971
22972 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22973 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22974 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22975 .cindex "external local delivery"
22976 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22977 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22978 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22979 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22980 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22981 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22982 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22983 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22984 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22985 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22986 .code
22987 # transport
22988 procmail_pipe:
22989 driver = pipe
22990 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22991 return_path_add
22992 delivery_date_add
22993 envelope_to_add
22994 check_string = "From "
22995 escape_string = ">From "
22996 umask = 077
22997 user = $local_part
22998 group = mail
22999
23000 # router
23001 procmail:
23002 driver = accept
23003 check_local_user
23004 transport = procmail_pipe
23005 .endd
23006 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23007 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23008 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23009 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23010 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23011 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23012
23013 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23014 .code
23015 IFS=" "
23016 .endd
23017 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23018 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23019
23020 .cindex "Cyrus"
23021 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23022 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23023 .code
23024 # transport
23025 local_delivery_cyrus:
23026 driver = pipe
23027 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23028 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23029 user = cyrus
23030 group = mail
23031 return_output
23032 log_output
23033 message_prefix =
23034 message_suffix =
23035
23036 # router
23037 local_user_cyrus:
23038 driver = accept
23039 check_local_user
23040 local_part_suffix = .*
23041 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23042 .endd
23043 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23044 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23045 sender.
23046 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23047 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23048
23049
23050 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23052
23053 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23054 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23055 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23056 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23057 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23058 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23059 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23060 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23061
23062
23063 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23064 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23065 two ways:
23066
23067 .ilist
23068 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23069 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23070 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23071 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23072 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23073 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23074 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23075 .next
23076 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23077 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23078 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23079 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23080 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23081 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23082 process.
23083 .endlist
23084
23085
23086 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23087 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23088 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23089
23090
23091
23092 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23093 .vindex "&$host$&"
23094 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23095 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23096 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23097 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23098 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23099 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23100 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23101 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23102
23103
23104 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23105 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23106 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23107 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23108 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23109 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23110 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23111 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23112 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23113 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23114 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23115 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23116 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23117 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23118
23119 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23120 and will be removed in a future release.
23121
23122
23123 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23124 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23125 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23126
23127
23128 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23129 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23130 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23131 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23132 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23133 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23134 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23135 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23136
23137 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23138 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23139 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23140 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23141 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23142 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23143 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23144 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23145 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23146
23147
23148 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23149 .cindex "Cyrus"
23150 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23151 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23152 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23153 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23154 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23155 ignored.
23156
23157 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23158 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23159 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23160 particular connection.
23161
23162 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23163 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23164 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23165 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23166
23167 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23168 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23169 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23170 .code
23171 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23172 .endd
23173 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23174 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23175
23176 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23177 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23178 value.
23179
23180
23181 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23182 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23183 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23184 authenticated as a client.
23185
23186
23187 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23188 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23189 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23190 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23191
23192
23193 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23194 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23195 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23196 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23197 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23198 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23199 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23200
23201
23202 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23203 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23204 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23205 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23206 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23207 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23208 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23209 option.
23210
23211
23212 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23213 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23214 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23215 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23216
23217
23218 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23219 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23220 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23221 cutoff times.
23222
23223 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23224 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23225 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23226 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23227 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23228 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23229
23230 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23231 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23232 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23233 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23234 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23235 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23236 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23237 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23238 to them.
23239
23240
23241 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23242 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23243 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23244 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23245 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23246
23247
23248 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23249 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23250 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23251 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23252 details.
23253
23254
23255 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23256 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23257 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23258 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23259 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23260 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23261 the dnssec request bit set.
23262 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23263
23264
23265
23266 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23267 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23268 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23269 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23270 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23271 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23272 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23273 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23274 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23275
23276
23277
23278 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23279 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23280 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23281 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23282 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23283 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23284 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23285
23286 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23287 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23288 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23289 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23290 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23291
23292
23293 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23294 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23295 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23296 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23297 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23298 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23299 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23300 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23301
23302 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23303 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23304 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23305 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23306 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23307 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23308
23309 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23310 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23311 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23312 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23313 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23314
23315 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23316 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23317 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23318 copy of the message is sent.
23319
23320 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23321 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23322 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23323 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23324 fails"& facility.
23325
23326
23327 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23328 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23329 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23330 zero.
23331
23332 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23333 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23334 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23335 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23336 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23337 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23338
23339 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23340 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23341 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23342 implementations of TLS.
23343
23344 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23345 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23346 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23347 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23348 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23349 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23350 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23351 option is:
23352 .code
23353 $primary_hostname
23354 .endd
23355 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23356 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23357 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23358 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23359 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23360 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23361 interface address, you could use this:
23362 .code
23363 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23364 {$primary_hostname}}
23365 .endd
23366 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23367 callouts.
23368
23369 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23370 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23371 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23372 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23373 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23374 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23375
23376 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23377 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23378 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23379 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23380
23381 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23382 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23383 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23384 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23385 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23386 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23387 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23388
23389 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23390 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23391 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23392 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23393 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23394 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23395 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23396 address are used.
23397
23398 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23399 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23400
23401
23402 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23403 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23404 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23405 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23406 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23407 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23408 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23409 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23410 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23411 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23412
23413
23414 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23415 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23416 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23417 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23418
23419
23420 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23421 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23422 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23423 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23424
23425 .new
23426 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23427 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23428 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23429 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23430 to any host that matches this list.
23431 .wen
23432
23433
23434 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23435 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23436 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23437 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23438 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23439 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23440 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23441 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23442
23443
23444 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23445 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23446 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23447 why it exists.
23448
23449
23450
23451 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23452 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23453 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23454 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23455 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23456 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23457 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23458 explanation of when this might be needed.
23459
23460
23461 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23462 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23463 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23464 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23465 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23466
23467
23468 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23469 .cindex "randomized host list"
23470 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23471 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23472 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23473 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23474 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23475 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23476 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23477 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23478
23479 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23480 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23481 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23482 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23483 .code
23484 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23485 .endd
23486 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23487 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23488 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23489
23490 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23491 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23492 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23493 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23494 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23495 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23496 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23497 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23498 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23499
23500
23501 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23502 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23503 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23504 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23505 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23506
23507 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23508 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23509 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23510 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23511 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23512
23513 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23514 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23515 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23516 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23517 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23518 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23519
23520 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23521 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23522 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23523 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23524 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23525 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23526 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23527
23528 .new
23529 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23530 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23531 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23532 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23533 for multi-recipient messages.
23534 The option can usually be left as default.
23535 .wen
23536
23537 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23538 .cindex "bind IP address"
23539 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23540 .vindex "&$host$&"
23541 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23542 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23543 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23544 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23545 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23546 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23547 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23548 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23549 unknown.
23550
23551 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23552 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23553 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23554 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23555 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23556 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23557 .code
23558 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23559 .endd
23560 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23561 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23562 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23563 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23564
23565
23566 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23567 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23568 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23569 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23570 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23571 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23572 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23573 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23574 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23575 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23576 unreachable hosts.
23577
23578
23579 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23580 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23581 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23582 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23583 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23584
23585 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23586 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23587 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23588 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23589 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23590 permits this.
23591
23592
23593 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23594 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23595 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23596 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23597 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23598 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23599 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23600 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23601
23602 .new
23603 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23604 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23605 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23606 .wen
23607
23608 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23609 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23610 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23611 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23612 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23613 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23614 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23615 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23616
23617 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23618 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23619 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23620 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23621 is deferred.
23622
23623
23624
23625 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23626 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23627 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23628 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23629 .vindex "&$port$&"
23630 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23631 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23632 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23633 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23634 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23635
23636 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23637 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23638 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23639 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23640
23641
23642 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23643 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23644 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23645 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23646 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23647 addresses is not affected.
23648
23649 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23650 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23651 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23652 Exim to use only the host name.
23653 .new
23654 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23655 .wen
23656
23657
23658 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23659 .cindex "serializing connections"
23660 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23661 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23662 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23663 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23664 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23665 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23666 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23667
23668 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23669 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23670 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23671 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23672 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23673 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23674
23675 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23676 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23677 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23678 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23679 are used for ETRN serialization.
23680
23681
23682 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23683 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23684 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23685 .cindex "size" "of message"
23686 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23687 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23688 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23689 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23690 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23691 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23692 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23693 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23694
23695 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23696 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23697
23698
23699 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23700 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23701 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23702 .vindex "&$host$&"
23703 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23704 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23705 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23706 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23707 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23708 details of TLS.
23709
23710 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23711 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23712 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23713 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23714 client.
23715
23716
23717 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23718 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23719 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23720 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23721 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23722
23723
23724 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23725 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23726 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23727 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23728 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23729 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23730 will fail.
23731
23732 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23733
23734
23735 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23736 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23737 .vindex "&$host$&"
23738 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23739 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23740 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23741 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23742 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23743 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23744 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23745 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23746
23747
23748 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23749 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23750 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23751 .vindex "&$host$&"
23752 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23753 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23754 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23755 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23756 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23757 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23758 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23759 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23760 ciphers is a preference order.
23761
23762
23763
23764 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23765 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23766 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23767 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23768 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23769 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23770 certificate and private key for the session.
23771
23772 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23773
23774 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23775 TLS extensions.
23776
23777
23778
23779
23780 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23781 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23782 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23783 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23784 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23785 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23786 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23787 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23788 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23789 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23790 in clear.
23791
23792
23793 .new
23794 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23795 .wen
23796 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23797 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23798 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23799 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23800 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23801 Note that unless the host is in this list
23802 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23803 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23804 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23805 certificate verification succeeds.
23806
23807
23808 .new
23809 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23810 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23811 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23812 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23813 while verifying the server certificate,
23814 checks will be included on the host name
23815 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23816 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23817 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23818
23819 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23820 .wen
23821
23822
23823 .new
23824 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23825 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23826 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23827 .vindex "&$host$&"
23828 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23829 The value of this option must be either the
23830 word "system"
23831 or the absolute path to
23832 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23833 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23834
23835 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23836 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23837 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23838 must be specified.
23839
23840 The use of a directory for the option value is not avilable for GnuTLS versions
23841 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23842 .wen
23843
23844 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23845 explicitly
23846 either by file or directory
23847 are added to those given by the system default location.
23848
23849 The values of &$host$& and
23850 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23851 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23852
23853 For back-compatability,
23854 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23855 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23856 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23857
23858
23859 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23860 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23861 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23862 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23863 certificate verification must succeed.
23864 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23865 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23866 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23867
23868
23869
23870
23871 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23872 "SECTvalhosmax"
23873 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23874 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23875 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23876 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23877 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23878
23879
23880 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23881 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23882 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23883 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23884 retrying.
23885
23886 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23887 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23888 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23889
23890 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23891 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23892 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23893 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23894 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23895
23896 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23897 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23898 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23899 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23900 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23901 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23902 see below for an exception).
23903
23904 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23905 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23906 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23907 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23908 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23909
23910 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23911 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23912 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23913 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23914 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23915 reached their retry times.
23916
23917 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23918 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23919 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23920 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23921 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23922 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23923 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23924 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23925 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23926 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23927 reached.
23928
23929 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23930 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23931 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23932 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23933 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23934 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23935
23936 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23937 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23938 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23939 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23940 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23941 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23942
23943
23944
23945
23946
23947 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23948 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23949
23950 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23951 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23952 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23953 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23954 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23955 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23956
23957 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23958 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23959 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23960 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23961 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23962 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23963 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23964
23965 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23966 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23967 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23968 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23969
23970
23971 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23972 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23973 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23974 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23975
23976 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23977 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23978 facility; you do not have to use it.
23979
23980 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23981 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23982 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23983 address to which it applies.
23984
23985 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23986 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23987 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23988 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23989 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23990 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23991 rules.
23992
23993 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23994 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23995 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23996 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23997
23998
23999 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24000 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24001 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24002 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24003 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24004 discouraged.
24005
24006 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24007 illustrated by these examples:
24008
24009 .ilist
24010 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24011 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24012 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24013 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24014 .next
24015 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24016 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24017 .endlist
24018
24019
24020
24021 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24022 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24023 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24024 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24025 message's processing.
24026
24027 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24028 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24029 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24030 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24031 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24032 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24033 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24034 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24035 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24036
24037 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24038 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24039 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24040 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24041 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24042 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24043 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24044 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24045 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24046 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24047
24048 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24049 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24050 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24051 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24052 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24053 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24054
24055 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24056 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24057 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24058
24059 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24060 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24061 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24062 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24063 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24064 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24065 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24066 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24067 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24068
24069 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24070 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24071 transport time.
24072
24073
24074
24075
24076 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24077 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24078 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24079 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24080 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24081 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24082 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24083 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24084 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24085 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24086 .code
24087 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24088 .endd
24089 might produce the output
24090 .code
24091 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24092 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24093 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24094 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24095 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24096 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24097 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24098 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24099 .endd
24100 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24101 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24102 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24103 set for a particular transport.
24104
24105
24106 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24107 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24108 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24109 rules in the form
24110 .display
24111 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24112 .endd
24113 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24114 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24115 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24116 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24117
24118 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24119 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24120 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24121 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24122 ignored.
24123
24124 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24125 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24126 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24127
24128 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24129 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24130 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24131 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24132 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24133 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24134 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24135
24136 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24137 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24138 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24139 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24140 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24141 .code
24142 *@* ${lookup ...
24143 .endd
24144 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24145 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24146
24147
24148 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24149 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24150 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24151 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24152 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24153 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24154 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24155 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24156 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24157
24158 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24159 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24160 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24161
24162 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24163 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24164 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24165 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24166 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24167 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24168 of pattern they are set as follows:
24169
24170 .ilist
24171 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24172 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24173 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24174 pattern
24175 .code
24176 *queen@*.fict.example
24177 .endd
24178 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24179 .code
24180 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24181 $1 = hearts-
24182 $2 = wonderland
24183 .endd
24184 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24185 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24186
24187 .next
24188 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24189 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24190 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24191 rewriting rule of the form
24192 .display
24193 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24194 .endd
24195 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24196 .code
24197 $1 = foo
24198 $2 = bar
24199 $3 = baz.example
24200 .endd
24201 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24202 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24203 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24204 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24205 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24206 .endlist
24207
24208
24209 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24210 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24211 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24212 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24213 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24214 .code
24215 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24216 .endd
24217 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24218 &'From:'& headers.
24219
24220 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24221 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24222 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24223 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24224 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24225 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24226 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24227 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24228 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24229 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24230 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24231 entry written to the panic log.
24232
24233
24234
24235 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24236 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24237
24238 .ilist
24239 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24240 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24241 .next
24242 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24243 .next
24244 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24245 .endlist
24246
24247 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24248 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24249
24250
24251
24252 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24253 "SECID154"
24254 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24255 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24256 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24257 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24258 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24259 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24260 .display
24261 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24262 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24263 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24264 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24265 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24266 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24267 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24268 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24269 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24270 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24271 .endd
24272 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24273 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24274 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24275
24276 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24277 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24278
24279
24280 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24281 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24282 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24283 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24284 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24285 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24286 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24287 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24288 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24289
24290 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24291 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24292 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24293 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24294 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24295 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24296 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24297 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24298
24299
24300 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24301 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24302 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24303 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24304
24305 .ilist
24306 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24307 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24308 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24309 .next
24310 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24311 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24312 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24313 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24314 .next
24315 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24316 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24317 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24318 .next
24319 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24320 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24321 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24322 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24323 .code
24324 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24325 .endd
24326 into
24327 .code
24328 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24329 .endd
24330 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24331 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24332 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24333 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24334 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24335 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24336 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24337 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24338 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24339
24340 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24341 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24342 .endlist
24343
24344
24345 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24346 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24347 .code
24348 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24349 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24350 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24351 .endd
24352 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24353 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24354 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24355 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24356 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24357 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24358 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24359 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24360
24361 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24362 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24363 .code
24364 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24365 .endd
24366 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24367 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24368
24369 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24370 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24371 messages that originate outside the local host:
24372 .code
24373 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24374 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24375 .endd
24376 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24377 space.
24378
24379 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24380 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24381 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24382 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24383 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24384 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24385 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24386 components. For example, the rule
24387 .code
24388 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24389 .endd
24390 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24391 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24392 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24393 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24394 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24395 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24396 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24397 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24398
24399
24400
24401
24402
24403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24405
24406 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24407 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24408 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24409 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24410 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24411 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24412 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24413 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24414 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24415 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24416 address, domain and error.
24417
24418 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24419 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24420 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24421 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24422 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24423 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24424 log selector is set, the message
24425 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24426 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24427 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24428 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24429
24430 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24431 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24432 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24433 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24434 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24435 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24436 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24437 domain are maintained independently.
24438
24439 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24440 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24441 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24442 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24443 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24444 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24445 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24446 the local address is reached.
24447
24448 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24449 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24450 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24451 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24452 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24453
24454 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24455 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24456 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24457 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24458 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24459 messages that it should now be retaining.
24460
24461
24462
24463 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24464 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24465 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24466 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24467 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24468 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24469 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24470 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24471 message's sender, respectively.
24472
24473
24474 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24475 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24476 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24477 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24478 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24479 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24480 example,
24481 .code
24482 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24483 .endd
24484 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24485 whereas
24486 .code
24487 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24488 .endd
24489 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24490 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24491 part.
24492
24493 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24494 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24495 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24496 expressions work in address lists.
24497 .display
24498 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24499 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24500 .endd
24501
24502
24503 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24504 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24505 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24506 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24507 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24508 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24509 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24510 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24511 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24512
24513 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24514 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24515 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24516 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24517 local transports).
24518
24519 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24520 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24521 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24522 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24523 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24524 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24525 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24526 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24527 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24528 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24529 commands.
24530
24531
24532
24533 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24534 "SECID160"
24535 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24536 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24537 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24538 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24539 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24540 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24541 .code
24542 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24543 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24544 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24545 .endd
24546 and the retry rules are
24547 .code
24548 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24549 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24550 .endd
24551 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24552 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24553 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24554 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24555 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24556 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24557
24558 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24559 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24560 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24561 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24562
24563 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24564 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24565 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24566 .code
24567 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24568 .endd
24569 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24570 textual form of the IP address.
24571
24572 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24573 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24574 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24575 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24576
24577 .vlist
24578 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24579 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24580 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24581
24582 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24583 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24584 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24585
24586 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24587 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24588
24589 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24590 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24591 .endlist
24592
24593 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24594 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24595 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24596 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24597 retry rule of this form:
24598 .code
24599 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24600 .endd
24601 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24602 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24603
24604 .vlist
24605 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24606 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24607 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24608 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24609
24610 .new
24611 .vitem &%lookup%&
24612 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24613 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24614 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24615 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24616 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24617 .wen
24618
24619 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24620 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24621
24622 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24623 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24624
24625 .vitem &%refused%&
24626 A connection was refused.
24627
24628 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24629 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24630
24631 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24632 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24633
24634 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24635 A connection attempt timed out.
24636
24637 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24638 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24639 obtained from an MX record.
24640
24641 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24642 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24643 obtained from an MX record.
24644
24645 .vitem &%timeout%&
24646 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24647
24648 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24649 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24650 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24651 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24652
24653 .vitem &%quota%&
24654 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24655 transport.
24656
24657 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24658 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24659 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24660 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24661 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24662 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24663 for four days.
24664 .endlist
24665
24666 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24667 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24668 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24669 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24670 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24671 heuristic rules:
24672
24673 .ilist
24674 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24675 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24676 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24677 .next
24678 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24679 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24680 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24681 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24682 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24683 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24684 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24685 .next
24686 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24687 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24688 .endlist
24689
24690 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24691 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24692 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24693 error).
24694
24695
24696
24697 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24698 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24699 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24700 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24701 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24702 form:
24703 .display
24704 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24705 .endd
24706 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24707 .code
24708 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24709 .endd
24710 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24711 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24712 For example:
24713 .code
24714 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24715 .endd
24716 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24717 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24718 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24719 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24720 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24721
24722 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24723 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24724 .code
24725 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24726 .endd
24727 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24728 list is never matched.
24729
24730
24731
24732
24733
24734 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24735 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24736 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24737 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24738 .display
24739 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24740 .endd
24741 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24742 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24743 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24744 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24745 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24746
24747 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24748 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24749 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24750 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24751 The available algorithms are:
24752
24753 .ilist
24754 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24755 the interval.
24756 .next
24757 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24758 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24759 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24760 .next
24761 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24762 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24763 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24764 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24765 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24766 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24767 queue processing times.
24768 .endlist
24769
24770 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24771 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24772 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24773 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24774 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24775 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24776 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24777 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24778 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24779 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24780 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24781 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24782
24783 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24784 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24785 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24786 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24787 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24788 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24789 time.
24790
24791 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24792 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24793 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24794 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24795 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24796 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24797 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24798 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24799 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24800 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24801 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24802 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24803
24804 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24805 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24806 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24807 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24808 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24809 deliveries that have been deferred.
24810
24811
24812 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24813 Here are some example retry rules:
24814 .code
24815 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24816 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24817 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24818 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24819 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24820 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24821 .endd
24822 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24823 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24824 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24825 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24826 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24827 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24828 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24829 days.
24830
24831 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24832 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24833 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24834 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24835 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24836
24837 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24838 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24839 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24840 were not obtained from an MX record.
24841
24842 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24843 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24844 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24845 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24846 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24847
24848
24849
24850 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24851 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24852 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24853 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24854 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24855 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24856 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24857 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24858 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24859 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24860 failing for the first time.
24861
24862 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24863 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24864 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24865 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24866
24867 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24868 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24869 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24870
24871
24872
24873
24874 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24875 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24876 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24877 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24878 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24879 default retry rule:
24880 .code
24881 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24882 .endd
24883 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24884 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24885 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24886
24887 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24888 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24889 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24890 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24891 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24892
24893 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24894 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24895 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24896
24897 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24898 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24899 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24900 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24901 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24902 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24903 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24904 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24905
24906 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24907 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24908 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24909 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24910 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24911 notice.
24912
24913 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24914 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24915 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24916 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24917 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24918 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24919 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24920 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24921 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24922 true.
24923
24924 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24925 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24926 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24927 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24928 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24929 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24930 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24931 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24932 reached.
24933
24934 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24935 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24936 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24937 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24938 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24939 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24940 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24941 time out the address.
24942
24943 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24944 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24945 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24946 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24947 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24948 considered immediately.
24949 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24950 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24951
24952
24953
24954
24955
24956
24957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24959
24960 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24961 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24962 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24963 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24964 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24965 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24966 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24967 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24968 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24969 other.
24970
24971 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24972 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24973
24974 .ilist
24975 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24976 the client's EHLO command.
24977 .next
24978 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24979 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24980 .next
24981 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24982 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24983 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24984 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24985 with the AUTH command.
24986 .next
24987 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24988 .next
24989 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24990 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24991 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24992 connection.
24993 .next
24994 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24995 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24996 unauthenticated connection.
24997 .endlist
24998
24999 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25000 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25001 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25002 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25003 .display
25004 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25005 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25006 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25007 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25008 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25009 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25010 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25011 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25012 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25013 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25014 &`250 HELP`&
25015 .endd
25016 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25017 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25018 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25019 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25020 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25021 included by setting
25022 .code
25023 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25024 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25025 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25026 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25027 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25028 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25029 AUTH_SPA=yes
25030 AUTH_TLS=yes
25031 .endd
25032 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25033 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25034 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25035 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25036 work via a socket interface.
25037 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25038 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25039 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25040 supporting setting a server keytab.
25041 The sixth can be configured to support
25042 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25043 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25044 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25045 .new
25046 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25047 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25048 .wen
25049
25050 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25051 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25052 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25053 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25054 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25055 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25056 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25057
25058 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25059 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25060 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25061 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25062 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25063 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25064 .code
25065 cram:
25066 driver = cram_md5
25067 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25068 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25069 client_name = ph10
25070 client_secret = secret2
25071 .endd
25072 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25073 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25074
25075 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25076 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25077 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25078 in Exim.
25079
25080 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25081 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25082 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25083 authenticating data.
25084
25085 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25086 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25087 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25088 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25089 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25090 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25091 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25092 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25093 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25094 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25095 choose to honour.
25096
25097 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25098 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25099 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25100 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25101
25102
25103
25104 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25105 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25106 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25107
25108 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25109 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25110 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25111 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25112 encrypted by a setting such as:
25113 .code
25114 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25115 .endd
25116
25117
25118 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25119 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25120 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
25121 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25122
25123
25124 .option driver authenticators string unset
25125 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25126 authenticators is to be used.
25127
25128
25129 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25130 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25131 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25132 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25133 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25134 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25135
25136
25137 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25138 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25139 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25140 mechanism is not advertised.
25141 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25142 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25143 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25144
25145
25146 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25147 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25148 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25149 for details.
25150
25151 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25152 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25153
25154 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25155 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25156 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25157 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25158 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25159 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25160 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25161 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25162 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25163 the error text.
25164
25165
25166 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25167 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25168 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25169 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25170 out the values of variables.
25171 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25172 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25173
25174
25175 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25176 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25177 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25178 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25179 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25180 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25181 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25182 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25183 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25184
25185
25186 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25187 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25188 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25189 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25190 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25191 remembered for later use.
25192 How it is used is described in the following section.
25193
25194
25195
25196
25197
25198 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25199 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25200 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25201 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25202 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25203 message:
25204
25205 .ilist
25206 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25207 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25208 .next
25209 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25210 .next
25211 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25212 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25213 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25214 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25215 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25216 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25217 given for the MAIL command.
25218 .next
25219 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25220 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25221 authenticated.
25222 .next
25223 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25224 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25225 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25226 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25227 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25228 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25229 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25230 message.
25231 .endlist
25232
25233
25234 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25235 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25236 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25237 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25238
25239 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25240 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25241 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25242 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25243 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25244 ACL is run.
25245
25246
25247
25248 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25249 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25250 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25251 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25252 conditions:
25253
25254 .ilist
25255 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25256 .next
25257 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25258 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25259 .endlist
25260
25261 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25262 the mechanisms are advertised.
25263
25264 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25265 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25266 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25267 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25268 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25269 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25270 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25271 .code
25272 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25273 .endd
25274 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25275
25276 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25277 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25278 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25279 such as:
25280 .code
25281 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25282 .endd
25283 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25284 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25285 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25286
25287 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25288 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25289 command. This is the case if
25290
25291 .ilist
25292 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25293 .next
25294 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25295 .next
25296 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25297 server authenticators.
25298 .endlist
25299
25300
25301 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25302 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25303 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25304
25305 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25306 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25307 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25308 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25309 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25310 rejected with a 504 error.
25311
25312 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25313 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25314 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25315 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25316 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25317 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25318 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25319 no successful authentication.
25320
25321
25322
25323
25324 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25325 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25326 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25327 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25328 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25329 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25330 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25331 script:
25332 .code
25333 use MIME::Base64;
25334 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25335 .endd
25336 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25337 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25338 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25339 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25340 command line to run this script on such data might be
25341 .code
25342 encode '\0user\0password'
25343 .endd
25344 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25345 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25346 whose code value is zero.
25347
25348 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25349 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25350 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25351 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25352
25353 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25354 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25355 example, a command such as
25356 .code
25357 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25358 .endd
25359 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25360
25361 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25362 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25363 .code
25364 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25365 .endd
25366 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25367 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25368 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25369 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25370
25371
25372
25373 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25374 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25375 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25376 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25377 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25378 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25379
25380 .ilist
25381 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25382 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25383 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25384 of the authenticator.
25385 .next
25386 .vindex "&$host$&"
25387 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25388 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25389 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25390 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25391 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25392 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25393 delivery to be deferred.
25394 .next
25395 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25396 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25397 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25398 usual way.
25399 .next
25400 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25401 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25402 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25403 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25404 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25405 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25406 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25407 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25408 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25409 .endlist
25410
25411 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25412 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25413 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25414 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25415 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25416 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25417 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25418 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25419 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25420 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25421 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25422 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25423 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25424
25425
25426
25427
25428
25429
25430 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25432
25433 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25434 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25435 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25436 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25437 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25438 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25439 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25440 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25441 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25442 connections as you do for login accounts.
25443
25444 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25445 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25446 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25447
25448 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25449 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25450 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25451
25452 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25453 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25454 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25455 given.
25456
25457 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25458 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25459 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25460 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25461 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25462 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25463 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25464
25465 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25466 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25467 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25468 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25469 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25470 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25471 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25472
25473 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25474 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25475 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25476 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25477
25478 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25479 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25480 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25481
25482 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25483 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25484 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25485 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25486 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25487 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25488 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25489 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25490 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25491 string as the error text
25492
25493 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25494 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25495 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25496
25497
25498
25499 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25500 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25501 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25502 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25503 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25504 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25505 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25506 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25507
25508 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25509 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25510 configured as follows:
25511 .code
25512 fixed_plain:
25513 driver = plaintext
25514 public_name = PLAIN
25515 server_prompts = :
25516 server_condition = \
25517 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25518 server_set_id = $auth2
25519 .endd
25520 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25521 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25522 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25523 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25524
25525 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25526 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25527 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25528 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25529 .code
25530 250-AUTH PLAIN
25531 .endd
25532 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25533 .code
25534 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25535 .endd
25536 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25537 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25538 .code
25539 AUTH PLAIN
25540 .endd
25541 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25542 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25543
25544 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25545 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25546 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25547 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25548 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25549
25550 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25551 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25552 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25553
25554 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25555 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25556 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25557 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25558 This is an incorrect example:
25559 .code
25560 server_condition = \
25561 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25562 .endd
25563 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25564 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25565 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25566 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25567 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25568 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25569 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25570 .code
25571 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25572 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25573 .endd
25574 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25575 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25576 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25577 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25578 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25579
25580
25581 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25582 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25583 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25584 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25585 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25586 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25587 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25588 .code
25589 fixed_login:
25590 driver = plaintext
25591 public_name = LOGIN
25592 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25593 server_condition = \
25594 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25595 server_set_id = $auth1
25596 .endd
25597 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25598 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25599 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25600 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25601
25602 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25603 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25604 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25605 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25606 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25607 .code
25608 login:
25609 driver = plaintext
25610 public_name = LOGIN
25611 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25612 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25613 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25614 ldapauth{\
25615 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25616 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25617 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25618 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25619 .endd
25620 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25621 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25622 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25623 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25624 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25625 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25626 uninterpreted string.
25627
25628
25629 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25630 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25631 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25632 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25633 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25634 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25635
25636
25637
25638
25639 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25640 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25641 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25642
25643 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25644 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25645 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25646 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25647 usual.
25648
25649 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25650 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25651 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25652 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25653 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25654 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25655 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25656 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25657 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25658 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25659 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25660 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25661
25662 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25663 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25664
25665 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25666 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25667 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25668 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25669 the string.
25670
25671 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25672 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25673 .code
25674 fixed_plain:
25675 driver = plaintext
25676 public_name = PLAIN
25677 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25678 .endd
25679 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25680 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25681 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25682 .code
25683 fixed_login:
25684 driver = plaintext
25685 public_name = LOGIN
25686 client_send = : username : mysecret
25687 .endd
25688 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25689 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25690 prompts.
25691 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25692 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25693
25694
25695
25696
25697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25699
25700 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25701 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25702 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25703 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25704 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25705 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25706 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25707 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25708 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25709 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25710 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25711 available in plain text at either end.
25712
25713
25714 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25715 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25716 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25717 authenticator as a server:
25718
25719 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25720 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25721 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25722 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25723 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25724 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25725 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25726 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25727 returned to the client.
25728
25729 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25730 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25731 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25732 numeric variables for other things.
25733
25734 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25735 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25736 user name, authentication fails.
25737 .code
25738 fixed_cram:
25739 driver = cram_md5
25740 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25741 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25742 server_set_id = $auth1
25743 .endd
25744 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25745 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25746 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25747 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25748 .code
25749 lookup_cram:
25750 driver = cram_md5
25751 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25752 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25753 {$value}fail}
25754 server_set_id = $auth1
25755 .endd
25756 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25757 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25758
25759 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25760 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25761 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25762 realm, with:
25763 .code
25764 cyrusless_crammd5:
25765 driver = cram_md5
25766 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25767 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25768 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25769 server_set_id = $auth1
25770 .endd
25771
25772 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25773 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25774 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25775
25776
25777
25778 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25779 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25780 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25781
25782
25783 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25784 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25785 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25786
25787
25788 .vindex "&$host$&"
25789 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25790 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25791 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25792 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25793 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25794 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25795 send the message to the current server.
25796
25797 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25798 strings, is:
25799 .code
25800 fixed_cram:
25801 driver = cram_md5
25802 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25803 client_name = ph10
25804 client_secret = secret
25805 .endd
25806 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25807 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25808
25809
25810
25811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25813
25814 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25815 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25816 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25817 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25818 .cindex "Kerberos"
25819 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25820 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25821
25822 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25823 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25824 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25825 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25826 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25827
25828 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25829 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25830 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25831 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25832
25833 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25834 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25835 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25836 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25837 depending on the driver you are using.
25838
25839 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25840 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25841 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25842 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25843 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25844 implementation.
25845
25846 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25847 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25848 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25849 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25850 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25851 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25852 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25853 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25854
25855
25856 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25857 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25858 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25859 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25860 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25861 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25862 things.
25863
25864
25865 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25866 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25867 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25868 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25869
25870
25871 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25872 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25873 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25874 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25875 example:
25876 .code
25877 sasl:
25878 driver = cyrus_sasl
25879 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25880 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25881 server_set_id = $auth1
25882 .endd
25883
25884 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25885 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25886
25887
25888 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25889 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25890
25891
25892 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25893 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25894 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25895 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25896 .code
25897 sasl_cram_md5:
25898 driver = cyrus_sasl
25899 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25900 server_set_id = $auth1
25901
25902 sasl_plain:
25903 driver = cyrus_sasl
25904 public_name = PLAIN
25905 server_set_id = $auth2
25906 .endd
25907 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25908 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25909 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25910 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25911 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25912
25913
25914
25915
25916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25917 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25918 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25919 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25920 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25921 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25922 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25923 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25924 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25925 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25926 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25927
25928 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25929
25930 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25931 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25932 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25933 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25934 .code
25935 dovecot_plain:
25936 driver = dovecot
25937 public_name = PLAIN
25938 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25939 server_set_id = $auth1
25940
25941 dovecot_ntlm:
25942 driver = dovecot
25943 public_name = NTLM
25944 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25945 server_set_id = $auth1
25946 .endd
25947 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25948 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25949 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25950 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25951 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25952 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25953 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25954 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25955
25956
25957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25959 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25960 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25961 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25962 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25963 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25964 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25965 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25966 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25967 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25968 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25969 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25970 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25971 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25972 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25973 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25974 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25975 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25976 without code changes in Exim.
25977
25978
25979 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25980 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25981 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25982 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25983 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25984 context.
25985
25986 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25987 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25988 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25989
25990 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25991 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25992 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25993
25994 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25995 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25996 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25997
25998
25999 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26000 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26001 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26002 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26003
26004
26005 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26006 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26007 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26008 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26009 example:
26010 .code
26011 sasl:
26012 driver = gsasl
26013 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26014 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26015 server_set_id = $auth1
26016 .endd
26017
26018
26019 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26020 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26021 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26022 the password itself.
26023
26024 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26025 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26026 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26027 if available, else the empty string.
26028 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26029 else the empty string.
26030
26031 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26032
26033 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26034 option to be simply "true".
26035
26036
26037 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26038 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26039 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26040
26041
26042 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26043 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26044 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26045 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26046
26047
26048 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26049 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26050 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26051 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26052
26053
26054 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26055 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26056 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26057
26058
26059 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26060 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26061 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26062 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26063
26064 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26065 meanings for these variables:
26066
26067 .ilist
26068 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26069 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26070 .next
26071 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26072 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26073 .next
26074 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26075 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26076 .endlist
26077
26078 On a per-mechanism basis:
26079
26080 .ilist
26081 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26082 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26083 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26084 .next
26085 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26086 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26087 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26088 .next
26089 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26090 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26091 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26092 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26093 .endlist
26094
26095 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26096 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26097 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26098
26099
26100 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26101 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26102 .code
26103 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26104 driver = gsasl
26105 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26106 server_realm = imap.example.org
26107 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26108 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26109 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26110 server_condition = yes
26111 .endd
26112
26113
26114 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26116
26117 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26118 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26119 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26120 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26121 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26122 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26123 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26124 reliably.
26125
26126 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26127 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26128 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26129 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26130
26131 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26132 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26133 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26134 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26135
26136 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26137 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26138 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
26139 from the keytab.
26140
26141
26142 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26143 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26144 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26145 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26146
26147 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26148 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26149 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26150 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26151
26152 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26153 .ilist
26154 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26155 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26156 .next
26157 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26158 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26159 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26160 GSS Display Name.
26161 .endlist
26162
26163
26164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26166
26167 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26168 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26169 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26170 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26171 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26172 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26173 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26174 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26175 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26176 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26177 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26178 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26179 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26180 follows:
26181
26182 .ilist
26183 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26184 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26185 .next
26186 The server sends back a challenge.
26187 .next
26188 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26189 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26190 .endlist
26191
26192 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26193
26194
26195
26196 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26197 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26198 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26199
26200 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26201 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26202 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26203 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26204 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26205 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26206 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26207 for other things. For example:
26208 .code
26209 spa:
26210 driver = spa
26211 public_name = NTLM
26212 server_password = \
26213 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26214 .endd
26215 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26216 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26217
26218
26219
26220
26221
26222 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26223 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26224 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26225
26226
26227
26228 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26229 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26230
26231
26232 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26233 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26234
26235
26236 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26237 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26238 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26239 &'msn.com'&:
26240 .code
26241 msn:
26242 driver = spa
26243 public_name = MSN
26244 client_username = msn/msn_username
26245 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26246 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26247 .endd
26248 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26249 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26250
26251
26252
26253
26254
26255 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26257
26258 .new
26259 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26260 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26261 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26262 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26263 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26264 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26265 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26266 authentication based on client certificates.
26267
26268 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26269 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26270 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26271 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26272 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26273 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26274
26275 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26276 for which it must have been requested via the
26277 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26278 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26279
26280 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26281 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26282 and can authenticate the connection.
26283 If it does, SMTP suthentication is not offered.
26284
26285 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26286
26287
26288 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26289 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26290
26291 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26292 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26293 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26294 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26295 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26296 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26297
26298 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26299 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26300 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26301
26302 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26303
26304
26305 Example:
26306 .code
26307 tls:
26308 driver = tls
26309 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26310 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26311 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26312 {!= {0} \
26313 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26314 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26315 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26316 } } } }
26317 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26318 .endd
26319 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26320 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26321 .wen
26322
26323
26324 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26325 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26326 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26327
26328
26329
26330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26332
26333 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26334 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26335 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26336 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26337 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26338 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26339 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26340 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26341 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26342 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26343 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26344 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26345 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26346 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26347 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26348 certificates are used.
26349
26350 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26351 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26352 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26353 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26354 between them is encrypted.
26355
26356 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26357 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26358 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26359 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26360 encryption state.
26361
26362 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26363 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26364 in order to get TLS to work.
26365
26366
26367
26368 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26369 "SECID284"
26370 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26371 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26372 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26373 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26374 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26375 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26376 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26377 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26378 allocated for this purpose.
26379
26380 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26381 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26382 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26383 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26384 .code
26385 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26386 .endd
26387 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26388 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26389 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26390 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26391 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26392 defined elsewhere.
26393
26394 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26395 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26396
26397
26398
26399
26400
26401
26402 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26403 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26404 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26405 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26406 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26407 .code
26408 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26409 .endd
26410 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26411 .code
26412 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26413 .endd
26414 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26415 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26416
26417 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26418
26419 .ilist
26420 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26421 cannot be the path of a directory
26422 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26423 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26424 .next
26425 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26426 .next
26427 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26428 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26429 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26430 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26431 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26432 .next
26433 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26434 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26435 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26436 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26437 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26438 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26439 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26440 option).
26441 .next
26442 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26443 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26444 .next
26445 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26446 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26447 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26448 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26449 .next
26450 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26451 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26452 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26453 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26454 .endlist
26455
26456
26457 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26458 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26459 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26460 but not the chosen filename.
26461 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26462 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26463
26464 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26465 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26466 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26467 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26468 of bits requested.
26469 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26470 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26471 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26472 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26473 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26474 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26475 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26476
26477 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26478 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26479 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26480 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26481 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26482
26483 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26484 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26485 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26486 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26487 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26488 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26489
26490 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26491 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26492 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26493
26494 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26495 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26496 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26497 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26498 .code
26499 # ls
26500 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26501 # rm -f new-params
26502 # touch new-params
26503 # chown exim:exim new-params
26504 # chmod 0600 new-params
26505 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26506 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26507 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26508 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26509 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26510 # chmod 0400 new-params
26511 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26512 .endd
26513 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26514 stalling is removed.
26515
26516 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26517 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26518 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26519 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26520 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26521 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26522 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26523 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26524 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26525 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26526 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26527
26528 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26529 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26530 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26531 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26532
26533 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26534 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26535 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26536 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26537 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26538
26539
26540 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26541 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26542 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26543 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26544 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26545 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26546 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26547 directly to this function call.
26548 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26549 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26550 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26551 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26552
26553 .ilist
26554 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26555 .next
26556 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26557 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26558 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26559 SSL v3 algorithms.
26560 .next
26561 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26562 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26563 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26564 algorithms.
26565 .endlist
26566
26567 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26568 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26569 .ilist
26570 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26571 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26572 stated.
26573 .next
26574 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26575 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26576 .next
26577 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26578 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26579 .endlist
26580
26581 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26582 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26583 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26584 not be moved to the end of the list.
26585 .endlist
26586
26587 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26588 string:
26589 .code
26590 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26591 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26592 .endd
26593
26594 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26595 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26596 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26597 choice of clients used:
26598 .code
26599 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26600 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26601 {DEFAULT}\
26602 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26603 .endd
26604
26605
26606
26607 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26608 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26609 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26610 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26611 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26612 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26613 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26614 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26615 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26616 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26617 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26618 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26619
26620 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26621 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26622
26623 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26624 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26625 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26626 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26627 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26628 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26629
26630 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26631 "Priority strings". This is online as
26632 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26633 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26634 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26635 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26636 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26637
26638 For example:
26639 .code
26640 # Disable older versions of protocols
26641 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26642 .endd
26643
26644 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26645 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26646 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26647
26648 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26649 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26650 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26651 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26652 used:
26653 .code
26654 # GnuTLS variant
26655 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26656 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26657 {SECURE128}}
26658 .endd
26659
26660
26661 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26662 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26663 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26664 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26665 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26666 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26667 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26668 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26669
26670 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26671 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26672 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26673 with the error
26674 .code
26675 554 Security failure
26676 .endd
26677 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26678 rejected with a 554 error code.
26679
26680 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26681 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26682 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26683 without some further configuration at the server end.
26684
26685 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26686 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26687 .code
26688 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26689 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26690 .endd
26691 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26692 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26693 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26694 that goes with it. These files need to be
26695 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26696 always be given as full path names.
26697 The key must not be password-protected.
26698 They can be the same file if both the
26699 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26700 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26701 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26702 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26703 the server's certificate.
26704
26705 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26706 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26707 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26708
26709 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26710 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26711 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26712 transport.
26713
26714 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26715 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26716 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26717 .code
26718 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26719 .endd
26720 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26721 with the parameters contained in the file.
26722 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26723 available:
26724 .code
26725 tls_dhparam = none
26726 .endd
26727 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26728 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26729 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26730 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26731
26732 See the command
26733 .code
26734 openssl dhparam
26735 .endd
26736 for a way of generating file data.
26737
26738 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26739 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26740 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26741 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26742 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26743
26744 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26745 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26746 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26747 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26748 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26749 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26750 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26751 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26752 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26753
26754 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26755 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26756 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26757 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26758 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26759 documentation for more details.
26760
26761 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26762 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26763
26764
26765 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26766 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26767 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26768 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26769 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26770 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26771 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26772 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26773 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26774 expected certificates.
26775 .new
26776 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26777 .wen
26778 an explicit file or,
26779 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26780 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26781
26782 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26783 directory is used
26784 (OpenSSL only),
26785 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26786 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26787 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26788 .code
26789 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26790 .endd
26791 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26792
26793 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26794 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26795 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26796 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26797 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26798 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26799 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26800 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26801 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26802 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26803
26804 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26805 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26806 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26807 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26808
26809 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26810 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26811 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26812 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26813 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26814 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26815
26816
26817 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26818 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26819 .cindex "revocation list"
26820 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26821 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26822 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26823 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26824 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26825 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26826 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26827 CRL in PEM format.
26828 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26829 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26830
26831 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26832 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26833 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26834 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26835 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26836 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26837
26838 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26839 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26840 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26841 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26842
26843 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26844 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26845 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26846 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26847 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26848 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26849 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26850 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26851
26852 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26853 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26854 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26855
26856 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26857 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26858 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26859 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26860 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26861
26862 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26863 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26864 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26865 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26866 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26867 next connection.
26868
26869 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26870 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26871 ignored.
26872
26873 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26874 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26875 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26876 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26877 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26878 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26879
26880 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26881 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26882
26883 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26884
26885 .code
26886 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26887 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26888 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26889
26890 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26891 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26892 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26893 .endd
26894
26895
26896
26897
26898 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26899 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26900 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26901 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26902 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26903 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26904 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26905 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26906 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26907
26908 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26909 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26910 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26911 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26912 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26913
26914 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26915 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26916 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26917 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26918 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26919 usual way.
26920
26921 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26922 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26923 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26924 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26925 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26926 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26927 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26928 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26929 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26930 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26931 unencrypted.
26932
26933 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26934 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26935 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26936 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26937
26938 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26939 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26940 .new
26941 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26942 .wen
26943 a file or,
26944 depnding on liibrary version, a directory,
26945 must name a file or,
26946 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26947 The client verifies the server's certificate
26948 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26949 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26950 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26951 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26952
26953 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26954 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26955 or need not succeed respectively.
26956
26957 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26958 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26959 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26960 value is empty.
26961 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26962 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26963 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26964 otherwise.
26965
26966 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26967 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26968 for OCSP to be relevant.
26969
26970 If
26971 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26972 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26973 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26974 alternative hosts, if any.
26975
26976 &*Note*&:
26977 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26978 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26979 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26980 client.
26981
26982 .vindex "&$host$&"
26983 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26984 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26985 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26986 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26987 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26988
26989 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26990 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26991 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26992 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26993 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26994 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26995 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26996 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26997 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26998 outgoing connection.
26999
27000
27001
27002 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27003 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27004 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27005 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27006 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27007 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27008 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27009 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27010 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27011 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27012 for this session.
27013
27014 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27015 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27016 address.
27017
27018 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27019 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27020 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27021 be of limited use in that environment.
27022
27023 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27024 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27025 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27026 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27027 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27028
27029 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27030 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27031 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27032 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27033 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27034
27035 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27036 received from a client.
27037 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27038
27039 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27040 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27041 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27042
27043 .ilist
27044 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27045 &%tls_certificate%&
27046 .next
27047 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27048 &%tls_crl%&
27049 .next
27050 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27051 &%tls_privatekey%&
27052 .next
27053 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27054 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27055 .next
27056 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27057 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27058 .endlist
27059
27060 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27061 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27062 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27063 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27064
27065 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27066 are re-expanded.
27067
27068 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27069 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27070 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27071 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27072
27073 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27074 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27075 built, then you have SNI support).
27076
27077
27078
27079 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27080 "SECTmulmessam"
27081 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27082 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27083 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27084 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27085 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27086 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27087 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27088 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27089 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27090 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27091 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27092
27093 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27094 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27095 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27096 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27097 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27098 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27099 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27100 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27101 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27102
27103 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27104 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27105 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27106 information is recorded.
27107
27108 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27109 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27110 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27111
27112
27113
27114
27115 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27116 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27117 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27118 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27119 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27120 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27121 to Apache, currently at
27122 .display
27123 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27124 .endd
27125 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27126 links to further files.
27127 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27128 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27129 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27130 .display
27131 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27132 .endd
27133
27134
27135 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27136 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27137 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27138 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27139 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27140 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27141 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27142 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27143 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27144 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27145 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27146 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27147 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27148
27149 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27150 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27151 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27152 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27153
27154
27155
27156 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27157 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27158 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27159 with OpenSSL, like this:
27160 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27161 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27162 .code
27163 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27164 -days 9999 -nodes
27165 .endd
27166 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27167 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27168 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27169 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27170 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27171 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27172 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27173
27174 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27175 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27176 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27177 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27178 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27179 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27180 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27181 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27182 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27183 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27184 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27185 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27186 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27187 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27188 be a sensible resolution).
27189
27190 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27191 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27192 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27193
27194 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27195 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27196 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27197 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27198 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27199 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27200
27201 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27202 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27203 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27204 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27205 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27206 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27207
27208
27209
27210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27212
27213 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27214 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27215 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27216 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27217 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27218 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27219 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27220 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27221 one very small ACL:
27222 .code
27223 begin acl
27224 small_acl:
27225 accept hosts = one.host.only
27226 .endd
27227 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27228 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27229
27230 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27231 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27232 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27233 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27234 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27235 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27236 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27237 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27238
27239
27240 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27241 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27242 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27243 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27244 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27245
27246
27247
27248 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27249 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27250 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27251 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27252 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27253 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27254 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27255 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27256 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27257 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27258 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27259 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27260 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27261 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27262 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27263 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27264 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27265 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27266 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27267 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27268
27269 .table2 140pt
27270 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27271 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27272 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27273 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27274 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27275 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27276 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27277 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27278 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27279 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27280 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27281 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27282 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27283 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27284 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27285 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27286 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27287 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27288 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27289 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27290 .endtable
27291
27292 For example, if you set
27293 .code
27294 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27295 .endd
27296 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27297 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27298 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27299 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27300 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27301 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27302 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27303
27304
27305 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27306 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27307 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27308 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27309 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27310 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27311 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27312 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27313 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27314 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27315 in any of these ACLs.
27316
27317 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27318 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27319 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27320 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27321 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27322 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27323 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27324 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27325 .code
27326 control = suppress_local_fixups
27327 .endd
27328 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27329 run, it is too late.
27330
27331 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27332 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27333
27334 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27335 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27336 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27337
27338
27339 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27340 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27341 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27342 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27343 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27344 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27345 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27346 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27347 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27348
27349
27350 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27351 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27352 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27353 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27354 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27355 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27356 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27357 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27358 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27359
27360 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27361 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27362 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27363 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27364 an EHLO response.
27365
27366
27367 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27368 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27369 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27370 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27371 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27372 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27373 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27374 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27375 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27376 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27377
27378 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27379 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27380 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27381 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27382 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27383 associated with the DATA command.
27384
27385 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27386 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27387 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27388 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27389 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27390 your resources.
27391
27392 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27393 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27394 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27395 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27396
27397 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27398 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27399 enabled (which is the default).
27400
27401 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27402 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27403 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27404
27405 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27406
27407 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27408
27409
27410 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27411 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27412 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27413
27414 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27415
27416
27417 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27418 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27419 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27420 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27421 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27422 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27423 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27424 has been accepted.
27425
27426 The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27427 has been recieved, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27428 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27429 The test may accept, defer or deny for inividual recipients.
27430 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27431 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27432 for some or all recipients.
27433
27434 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27435 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27436 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27437 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27438 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27439 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27440 will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
27441
27442 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27443 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27444
27445 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27446 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27447 the feature was not requested by the client.
27448
27449 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27450 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27451 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27452 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27453 does not in fact control any access.
27454 .new
27455 For this reason, it may only accept
27456 or warn as its final result.
27457 .wen
27458
27459 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27460 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27461 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27462 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27463
27464 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27465 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27466
27467 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27468 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27469 response to QUIT.
27470
27471 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27472 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27473 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27474 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27475 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27476
27477
27478 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27479 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27480 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27481 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27482 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27483 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27484 situation even worse.
27485
27486 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27487 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27488 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27489 and &%warn%&.
27490
27491 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27492 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27493 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27494 connection. The possible values are:
27495 .table2
27496 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27497 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27498 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27499 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27500 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27501 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27502 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27503 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27504 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27505 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27506 .endtable
27507 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27508 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27509 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27510 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27511 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27512 used.
27513
27514
27515 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27516 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27517 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27518 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27519 .code
27520 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27521 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27522 .endd
27523 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27524 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27525 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27526 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27527 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27528
27529 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27530 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27531 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27532
27533 .ilist
27534 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27535 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27536 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27537 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27538 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27539 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27540 .code
27541 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27542 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27543 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27544 .endd
27545 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27546 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27547 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27548 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27549 .next
27550 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27551 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27552 matches the string.
27553 .next
27554 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27555 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27556 want to have something like
27557 .code
27558 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27559 .endd
27560 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27561 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27562 .endlist
27563
27564
27565
27566
27567 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27568 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27569 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27570 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27571 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27572 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27573 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27574 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27575 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27576
27577 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27578 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27579 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27580
27581
27582 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27583 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27584 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27585 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27586
27587 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27588 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27589 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27590 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27591 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27592 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27593 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27594
27595
27596 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27597 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27598 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27599
27600
27601
27602 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27603 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27604 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27605 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27606 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27607 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27608
27609 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27610 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27611 used to accept or reject anything.
27612
27613 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27614 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27615 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27616 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27617
27618 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27619 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27620 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27621 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27622 configuration file.
27623
27624
27625
27626
27627 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27628 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27629 .vindex &$domain$&
27630 .vindex &$local_part$&
27631 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27632 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27633 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27634 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27635 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27636 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27637 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27638 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27639 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27640
27641 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27642 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27643 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27644 how it is used.
27645
27646 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27647 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27648 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27649 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27650 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27651 received).
27652
27653 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27654 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27655 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27656 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27657 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27658 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27659 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27660 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27661
27662
27663
27664
27665
27666 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27667 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27668 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27669 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27670 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27671 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27672 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27673 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27674 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27675 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27676 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27677 unencrypted connections.
27678 .code
27679 acl_check_auth:
27680 accept encrypted = *
27681 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27682 {CRAM-MD5}}
27683 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27684 .endd
27685 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27686 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27687 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27688 option to do this.)
27689
27690
27691
27692 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27693 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27694 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27695 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27696 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27697 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27698 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27699
27700 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27701 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27702 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27703 example:
27704 .code
27705 deny dnslists = list1.example
27706 dnslists = list2.example
27707 .endd
27708 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27709 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27710 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27711 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27712 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27713
27714
27715 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27716 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27717
27718 .ilist
27719 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27720 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27721 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27722 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27723 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27724 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27725 check a RCPT command:
27726 .code
27727 accept domains = +local_domains
27728 endpass
27729 verify = recipient
27730 .endd
27731 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27732 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27733 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27734 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27735 &%endpass%&.
27736
27737 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27738 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27739 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27740 configuration.
27741
27742 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27743 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27744 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27745 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27746 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27747 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27748 .display
27749 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27750 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27751 .endd
27752 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27753 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27754 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27755
27756 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27757 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27758 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27759 of &%endpass%&.
27760
27761
27762 .next
27763 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27764 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27765 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27766 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27767 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27768 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27769 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27770
27771
27772 .next
27773 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27774 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27775 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27776 example,
27777 .code
27778 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27779 .endd
27780 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27781
27782
27783 .next
27784 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27785 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27786 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27787 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27788 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27789 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27790 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27791 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27792 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27793
27794 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27795 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27796 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27797
27798
27799 .next
27800 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27801 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27802 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27803 .code
27804 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27805 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27806 .endd
27807 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27808 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27809
27810 .next
27811 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27812 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27813 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27814 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27815 .code
27816 require message = Sender did not verify
27817 verify = sender
27818 .endd
27819 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27820 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27821 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27822 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27823
27824 .next
27825 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27826 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27827 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27828 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27829 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27830 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27831 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27832
27833 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27834 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27835 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27836 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27837 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27838
27839 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27840 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27841 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27842 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27843 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27844 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27845 onwards.
27846
27847
27848 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27849 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27850 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27851 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27852 .code
27853 warn !verify = sender
27854 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27855 .endd
27856 .endlist
27857
27858 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27859
27860 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27861 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27862 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27863 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27864 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27865
27866
27867
27868 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27869 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27870 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27871 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27872 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27873 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27874 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27875 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27876 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27877 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27878 .ilist
27879 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27880 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27881 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27882 on the same SMTP connection.
27883 .next
27884 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27885 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27886 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27887 .endlist
27888
27889 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27890 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27891 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27892 .code
27893 accept hosts = whatever
27894 set acl_m4 = some value
27895 accept authenticated = *
27896 set acl_c_auth = yes
27897 .endd
27898 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27899 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27900 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27901
27902 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27903 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27904 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27905 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27906 error is generated.
27907
27908 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27909 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27910
27911
27912 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27913 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27914 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27915 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27916 .code
27917 deny domains = *.dom.example
27918 !verify = recipient
27919 .endd
27920 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27921 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27922 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27923 two statements are equivalent:
27924 .code
27925 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27926 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27927 .endd
27928 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27929 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27930
27931 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27932 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27933 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27934 .code
27935 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27936 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27937 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27938 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27939 .endd
27940 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27941 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27942 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27943 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27944 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27945 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27946 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27947
27948 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27949 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27950 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27951 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27952 message is handled.
27953
27954 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27955 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27956 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27957 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27958 .code
27959 require message = Can't verify sender
27960 verify = sender
27961 message = Can't verify recipient
27962 verify = recipient
27963 message = This message cannot be used
27964 .endd
27965 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27966 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27967 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27968 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27969 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27970 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27971
27972 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27973 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27974 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27975 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27976 .code
27977 deny hosts = ...
27978 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27979 message = Invalid sender from client host
27980 .endd
27981 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27982 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27983
27984
27985
27986 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27987 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27988 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27989
27990 .vlist
27991 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27992 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27993 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27994 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27995
27996 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27997 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27998 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27999 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28000 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28001 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28002 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28003 write rather ugly lines like this:
28004 .display
28005 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28006 .endd
28007 Instead, all you need is
28008 .display
28009 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28010 .endd
28011
28012 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28013 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28014 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28015 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28016 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28017 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28018 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28019 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28020
28021 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28022 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28023 in several different ways. For example:
28024
28025 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28026 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28027 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28028 . ==== way.
28029
28030 .ilist
28031 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28032 .code
28033 accept ...some conditions
28034 control = queue_only
28035 .endd
28036 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28037 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28038
28039 .next
28040 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28041 .code
28042 accept ...some conditions...
28043 control = queue_only
28044 ...some more conditions...
28045 .endd
28046 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28047 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28048 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28049 to be relevant.
28050
28051 .next
28052 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28053 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28054 example:
28055 .code
28056 warn ...some conditions...
28057 control = freeze
28058 accept ...
28059 .endd
28060 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28061 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28062 log entry.
28063
28064 .next
28065 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28066 &%require%& verb. For example:
28067 .code
28068 require control = no_multiline_responses
28069 .endd
28070 .endlist
28071
28072 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28073 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28074 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28075 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28076 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28077 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28078 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28079 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28080 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28081
28082 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28083 example:
28084 .code
28085 deny ...some conditions...
28086 delay = 30s
28087 .endd
28088 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28089 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28090 .code
28091 deny delay = 30s
28092 ...some conditions...
28093 .endd
28094 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28095 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28096 .code
28097 warn ...some conditions...
28098 delay = 2m
28099 control = freeze
28100 accept ...
28101 .endd
28102
28103 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28104 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28105 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28106 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28107 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28108 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28109 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28110
28111
28112 .vitem &*endpass*&
28113 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28114 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28115 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28116 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28117 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28118 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28119 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28120
28121
28122 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28123 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28124 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28125 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28126 .code
28127 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28128 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28129 .endd
28130 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28131 example:
28132 .display
28133 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28134 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28135 .endd
28136 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28137 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28138 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28139 message.
28140
28141 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28142 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28143 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28144 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28145 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28146 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28147 ignored.
28148
28149 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28150 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28151 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28152 error message.
28153
28154 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28155 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28156 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28157 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28158 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28159 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28160
28161 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28162 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28163 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28164 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28165 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28166 logging rejections.
28167
28168
28169 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28170 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28171 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28172 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28173 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28174 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28175 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28176 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28177 .display
28178 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28179 &` log_reject_target =`&
28180 .endd
28181 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28182 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28183 current ACL.
28184
28185
28186 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28187 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28188 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28189 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28190 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28191 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28192 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28193 ACLs. For example:
28194 .display
28195 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28196 &` control = freeze`&
28197 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28198 .endd
28199 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28200 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28201 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28202 example:
28203 .code
28204 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28205 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28206 .endd
28207
28208
28209 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28210 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28211 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28212 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28213 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28214 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28215 &%accept%& for details.)
28216
28217 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28218 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28219 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28220 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28221 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28222 .code
28223 require message = Host not recognized
28224 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28225 .endd
28226 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28227 processed.)
28228
28229 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28230 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28231 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28232 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28233 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28234 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28235 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28236 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28237 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28238 EHLO options.
28239
28240 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28241 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28242 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28243 .code
28244 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28245 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28246 .endd
28247 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28248 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28249 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28250 2&'xx'&.
28251
28252 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28253 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28254
28255 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28256 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28257 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28258 response.
28259
28260 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28261 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28262 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28263
28264 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28265 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28266 However, the original message is available in the variable
28267 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28268 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28269 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28270 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28271
28272 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28273 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28274 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28275 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28276 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28277 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28278 effect.
28279
28280
28281 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28282 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28283 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28284 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28285
28286
28287 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28288 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28289 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28290 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28291
28292
28293 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28294 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28295 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28296 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28297 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28298 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28299 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28300 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28301 when:
28302 .code
28303 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28304 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28305 .endd
28306 .endlist
28307
28308
28309
28310
28311 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28312 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28313 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28314
28315 .vlist
28316 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28317 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28318 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28319 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28320 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28321 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28322 not work without it. For example:
28323 .code
28324 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28325 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28326 .endd
28327 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28328 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28329 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28330 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28331 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28332
28333
28334 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28335 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28336 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28337 .cindex "case of local parts"
28338 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28339 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28340 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28341 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28342 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28343 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28344 is encountered.
28345
28346 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28347 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28348 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28349 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28350 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28351
28352 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28353 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28354 spam score:
28355 .code
28356 warn control = caseful_local_part
28357 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28358 $acl_m4 + \
28359 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28360 }
28361 control = caselower_local_part
28362 .endd
28363 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28364 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28365
28366
28367 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28368 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28369 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28370 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28371
28372 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28373 If enabled for a message recieved via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28374 .new
28375 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28376 is used for all recipients of the message,
28377 .wen
28378 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28379 and data is copied from one to the other.
28380
28381 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28382 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28383 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28384 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28385 .new
28386 any subsequent receipients and the data,
28387 .wen
28388 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28389
28390 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28391 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28392 Note also that headers cannot be
28393 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28394 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28395
28396 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28397 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28398 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28399 .new
28400 It is not supported for messages recieved with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28401 .wen
28402
28403 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28404 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28405 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28406 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28407 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28408 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28409
28410 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28411 (possibly faked)
28412 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28413
28414
28415 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28416 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28417 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28418 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28419 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28420 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28421 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28422 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28423 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28424 contexts):
28425 .code
28426 control = debug
28427 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28428 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28429 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28430 .endd
28431
28432
28433 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28434 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28435 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28436 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28437 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28438
28439
28440 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28441 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28442 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28443 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28444 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28445 strings or to numeric value.
28446 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28447 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28448 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28449
28450 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28451 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28452 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28453 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28454 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28455
28456
28457 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28458 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28459 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28460 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28461 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28462 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28463 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28464 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28465
28466 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28467 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28468 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28469 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28470 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28471 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28472 work with.
28473
28474
28475 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28476 .cindex "fake defer"
28477 .cindex "defer, fake"
28478 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28479 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28480 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28481 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28482 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28483
28484 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28485 .cindex "fake rejection"
28486 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28487 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28488 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28489 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28490 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28491 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28492 the same SMTP connection.
28493
28494 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28495 message is supplied, the following is used:
28496 .code
28497 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28498 550-kept for evaluation.
28499 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28500 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28501 .endd
28502 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28503
28504 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28505 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28506 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28507 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28508 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28509 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28510 SMTP connection.
28511
28512 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28513 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28514 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28515 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28516
28517 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28518 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28519 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28520 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28521 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28522 disables such output flushing.
28523
28524 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28525 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28526 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28527 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28528 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28529 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28530
28531 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28532 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28533 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28534 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28535 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28536 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28537 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28538 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28539 to be useful in production.
28540
28541 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28542 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28543 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28544 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28545 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28546
28547 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28548 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28549 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28550 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28551 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28552 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28553
28554 .ilist
28555 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28556 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28557 verification failed"&) is sent.
28558 .next
28559 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28560 line is output.
28561 .endlist
28562
28563 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28564 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28565
28566 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28567 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28568 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28569 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28570 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28571 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28572 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28573
28574 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28575 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28576 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28577 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28578 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28579 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28580 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28581 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28582 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28583 same SMTP connection.
28584
28585 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28586 .cindex "message" "submission"
28587 .cindex "submission mode"
28588 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28589 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28590 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28591 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28592 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28593 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28594 late (the message has already been created).
28595
28596 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28597 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28598 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28599 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28600 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28601
28602 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28603 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28604 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28605 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28606 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28607
28608 .ilist
28609 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28610 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28611 .next
28612 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28613 .next
28614 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28615 .endlist ilist
28616
28617 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28618 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28619 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28620 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28621 data is read.
28622
28623 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28624 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28625 .endlist vlist
28626
28627
28628 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28629 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28630
28631 .ilist
28632 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28633 .next
28634 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28635 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28636 .next
28637 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28638 .next
28639 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28640 .endlist
28641
28642
28643
28644 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28645 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28646 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28647 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28648 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28649 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28650 .code
28651 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28652 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28653 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28654 .endd
28655 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28656 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28657 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28658 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28659 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28660 RCPT ACL).
28661
28662 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28663 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28664
28665 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28666 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28667 contains one or more newlines that
28668 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28669 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28670 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28671
28672 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28673 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28674 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28675 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28676 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28677 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28678 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28679 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28680 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28681 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28682 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28683
28684 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28685 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28686 of message headers
28687 until they are added to the
28688 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28689 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28690 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28691 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28692 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28693 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28694 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28695
28696 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28697
28698 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28699 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28700 .display
28701 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28702 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28703
28704 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28705 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28706 .endd
28707 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28708 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28709 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28710 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28711 honoured.
28712
28713 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28714 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28715 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28716 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28717 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28718 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28719 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28720 specifications.
28721
28722 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28723 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28724 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28725 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28726 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28727
28728 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28729 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28730 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28731 to be a header name first.) For example:
28732 .code
28733 warn add_header = \
28734 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28735 .endd
28736 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28737 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28738 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28739 up in reverse order.
28740
28741 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28742 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28743 system filter or in a router or transport.
28744
28745
28746
28747 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28748 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28749 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28750 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28751 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28752 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28753 .code
28754 warn message = Remove internal headers
28755 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28756 .endd
28757 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28758 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28759 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28760 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28761 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28762 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28763
28764 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28765 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28766
28767 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28768 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28769 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28770 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28771 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28772 .code
28773 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28774 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28775 warn message = Remove internal headers
28776 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28777 .endd
28778 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28779 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28780 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28781 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28782 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28783 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28784 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28785 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28786 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28787 would have been removed.
28788
28789 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28790 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28791 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28792 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28793 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28794 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28795 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28796 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28797 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28798
28799 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28800 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28801 .display
28802 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28803 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28804
28805 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28806 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28807 .endd
28808 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28809 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28810 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28811 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28812 are honoured.
28813
28814 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28815 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28816 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28817
28818
28819
28820
28821 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28822 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28823 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28824 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28825 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28826 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28827
28828 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28829 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28830 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28831 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28832 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28833 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28834 The conditions are as follows:
28835
28836
28837 .vlist
28838 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28839 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28840 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28841 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28842 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28843 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28844 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28845 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28846 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28847 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28848 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28849 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28850
28851 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28852 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28853 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28854 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28855 The name and values are expanded separately.
28856 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28857 will act as argument separators.
28858
28859 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28860 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28861 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28862 conditions are tested.
28863
28864 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28865 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28866 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28867 for different local users or different local domains.
28868
28869 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28870 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28871 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28872 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28873 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28874 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28875 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28876 .code
28877 authenticated = *
28878 .endd
28879
28880 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28881 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28882 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28883 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28884 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28885 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28886 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28887 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28888 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28889 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28890 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28891 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28892 negative.
28893
28894 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28895 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28896 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28897 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28898 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28899 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28900 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28901 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28902
28903 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28904 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28905 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28906 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28907 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28908
28909 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28910 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28911 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28912 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28913 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28914 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28915 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28916 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28917 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28918 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28919
28920 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28921 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28922 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28923 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28924 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28925 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28926 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28927 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28928 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28929 &%domains%& test.
28930
28931 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28932 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28933
28934
28935 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28936 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28937 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28938 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28939 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28940 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28941 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28942 .code
28943 encrypted = *
28944 .endd
28945
28946
28947 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28948 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28949 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28950 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28951 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28952 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28953 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28954 .code
28955 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28956 .endd
28957 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28958 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28959 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28960
28961 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28962 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28963 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28964 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28965 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28966 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28967
28968 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28969 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28970 .code
28971 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28972 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28973 .endd
28974 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28975 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28976 statement can then check the IP address.
28977
28978 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28979 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28980 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28981 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28982 .code
28983 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28984 message = $host_data
28985 .endd
28986 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28987
28988 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28989 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28990 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28991 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28992 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28993 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28994 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28995 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28996 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28997 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28998
28999 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29000 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29001 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29002 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29003 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29004 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29005 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29006
29007 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29008 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29009 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29010 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29011 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29012 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29013 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29014 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29015
29016 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29017 .cindex "rate limiting"
29018 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29019 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29020
29021 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29022 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29023 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29024 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29025 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29026 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29027
29028 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29029 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29030 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29031 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29032 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29033 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29034 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29035
29036 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29037 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29038 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29039 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29040 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29041 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29042 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29043 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29044 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29045 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29046 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29047 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29048 influence the sender checking.
29049
29050 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29051 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29052
29053 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29054 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29055 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29056 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29057 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29058 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29059 .code
29060 senders = :
29061 .endd
29062 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29063 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29064
29065 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29066 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29067 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29068 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29069 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29070 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29071
29072 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29073 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29074 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29075 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29076 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29077 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29078 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29079 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29080 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29081 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29082
29083 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29084 .cindex "CSA verification"
29085 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29086 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29087 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29088
29089 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29090 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29091 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29092 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29093 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29094 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29095 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29096 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29097 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29098 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29099
29100 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29101 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29102 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29103
29104 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29105 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29106 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29107 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29108 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29109 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29110 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29111 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29112 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29113 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29114 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29115 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29116 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29117 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29118 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29119
29120 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29121 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29122 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29123 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29124 .code
29125 deny senders = :
29126 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29127 !verify = header_sender
29128 .endd
29129
29130 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29131 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29132 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29133 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29134 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29135 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29136 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29137 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29138 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29139 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29140 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29141 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29142 appropriate.
29143
29144 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29145 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29146 .code
29147 To: @
29148 .endd
29149 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29150 common as they used to be.
29151
29152 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29153 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29154 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29155 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29156 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29157 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29158 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29159 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29160 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29161 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29162 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29163 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29164 independently of this condition.
29165
29166 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29167 option), this condition is always true.
29168
29169
29170 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29171 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29172 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29173 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29174 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29175 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29176 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29177 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29178 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29179
29180 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29181 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29182
29183
29184 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29185 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29186 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29187 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29188 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29189 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29190 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29191 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29192 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29193 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29194 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29195 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29196 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29197 value for the child address.
29198
29199 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29200 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29201 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29202 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29203 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29204 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29205 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29206 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29207 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29208 original IP address.
29209
29210 .new
29211 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29212 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29213 .wen
29214
29215 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29216 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29217
29218 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29219 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29220 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29221 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29222 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29223 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29224 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29225 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29226 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29227
29228 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29229 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29230 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29231 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29232 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29233 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29234 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29235
29236 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29237 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29238 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29239
29240 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29241 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29242 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29243 verified as a sender.
29244 .endlist
29245
29246
29247
29248 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29249 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29250 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29251 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29252 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29253 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29254 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29255 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29256 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29257 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29258 .code
29259 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29260 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29261 .endd
29262 the following records are looked up:
29263 .code
29264 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29265 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29266 .endd
29267 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29268 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29269 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29270 use two separate conditions:
29271 .code
29272 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29273 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29274 .endd
29275 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29276 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29277 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29278 processed.
29279
29280 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29281 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29282 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29283 following special items in the list:
29284 .display
29285 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29286 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29287 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29288 .endd
29289 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29290 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29291 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29292 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29293 .code
29294 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29295 .endd
29296 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29297 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29298 .code
29299 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29300 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29301 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29302 .endd
29303 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
29304 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29305 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29306 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29307
29308
29309
29310 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29311 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29312 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29313 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29314 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29315 .code
29316 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29317 .endd
29318 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29319 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29320 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29321 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29322
29323
29324
29325
29326 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29327 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29328 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29329 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29330 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29331 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29332 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29333 .code
29334 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29335 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29336 .endd
29337 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29338 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29339 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29340 up by this example is
29341 .code
29342 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29343 .endd
29344 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29345 addresses. For example:
29346 .code
29347 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29348 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29349 .endd
29350 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29351 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29352
29353
29354
29355
29356 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29357 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29358 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29359 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29360 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29361 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29362 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29363 either to double the separators like this:
29364 .code
29365 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29366 .endd
29367 or to change the separator character, like this:
29368 .code
29369 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29370 .endd
29371 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29372 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29373 occurs. Consider this condition:
29374 .code
29375 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29376 .endd
29377 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29378 .code
29379 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29380 a.domain.black.list.tld
29381 .endd
29382 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29383 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29384 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29385 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29386 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29387 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29388 error for a previous item.
29389
29390 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29391 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29392 .code
29393 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29394 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29395 .endd
29396 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29397 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29398 .code
29399 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29400 $sender_address_domain \
29401 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29402 see $dnslist_text.
29403 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29404 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29405 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29406 .endd
29407 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29408 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29409 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29410 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29411 .code
29412 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29413 .endd
29414 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29415 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29416
29417 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29418 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29419
29420
29421
29422
29423 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29424 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29425 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29426 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29427 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29428 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29429 .display
29430 127.1.0.1 RBL
29431 127.1.0.2 DUL
29432 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29433 127.1.0.4 RSS
29434 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29435 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29436 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29437 .endd
29438 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29439 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29440 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29441
29442
29443 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29444 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29445 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29446 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29447 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29448 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29449 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29450 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29451 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29452 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29453 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29454 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29455 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29456 cases, for example:
29457 .code
29458 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29459 .endd
29460 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29461 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29462 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29463 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29464 .code
29465 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29466 .endd
29467 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29468 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29469
29470 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29471 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29472 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29473 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29474 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29475 information.
29476
29477 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29478 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29479 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29480 .code
29481 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29482 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29483 at $dnslist_domain
29484 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29485 .endd
29486
29487
29488
29489 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29490 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29491 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29492 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29493 For example,
29494 .code
29495 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29496 .endd
29497 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29498 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29499 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29500 describes how multiple records are handled.
29501
29502 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29503 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29504 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29505 .code
29506 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29507 .endd
29508 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29509 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29510 first. For example:
29511 .code
29512 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29513 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29514 .endd
29515
29516 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29517 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29518 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29519 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29520 tested. For example:
29521 .code
29522 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29523 .endd
29524 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29525 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29526 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29527 .code
29528 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29529 .endd
29530 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29531 an odd number.
29532
29533
29534
29535 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29536 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29537 condition. Whereas
29538 .code
29539 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29540 .endd
29541 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29542 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29543 .code
29544 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29545 .endd
29546 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29547 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29548 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29549 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29550
29551 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29552 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29553
29554 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29555 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29556 .code
29557 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29558 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29559 .endd
29560 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29561 Consider this example:
29562 .code
29563 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29564 list.dsbl.org : \
29565 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29566 relays.ordb.org
29567 .endd
29568 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29569 .code
29570 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29571 list.dsbl.org
29572 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29573 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29574 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29575 .endd
29576 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29577
29578
29579
29580
29581 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29582 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29583 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29584 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29585 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29586 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29587 .code
29588 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29589 .endd
29590 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29591 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29592 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29593 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29594 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29595 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29596
29597 .ilist
29598 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29599 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29600 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29601 .next
29602 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29603 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29604 changed to:
29605 .code
29606 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29607 .endd
29608 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29609 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29610 .code
29611 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29612 .endd
29613 for the condition to be true.
29614 .endlist
29615
29616 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29617 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29618 .ilist
29619 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29620 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29621 .code
29622 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29623 .endd
29624 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29625 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29626 .next
29627 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29628 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29629 .code
29630 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29631 .endd
29632 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29633 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29634 .code
29635 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29636 .endd
29637 for the condition to be false.
29638 .endlist
29639 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29640 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29641
29642
29643
29644
29645 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29646 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29647 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29648 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29649 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29650 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29651 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29652 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29653 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29654 lists.
29655
29656 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29657 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29658 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29659 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29660 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29661 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29662 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29663 .code
29664 reject message = \
29665 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29666 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29667 dnslists = \
29668 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29669 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29670 .endd
29671 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29672 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29673 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29674 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29675 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29676 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29677
29678 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29679 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29680 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29681 .code
29682 reject dnslists = \
29683 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29684 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29685 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29686 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29687 .endd
29688 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29689 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29690 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29691
29692
29693
29694 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29695 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29696 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29697 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29698 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29699 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29700 .code
29701 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29702 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29703 .endd
29704 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29705 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29706 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29707 .code
29708 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29709 .endd
29710 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29711 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29712
29713 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29714 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29715 .code
29716 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29717 dnslists = some.list.example
29718 .endd
29719
29720 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29721 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29722 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29723 .code
29724 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29725 .endd
29726
29727 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29728 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29729 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29730 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29731 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29732 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29733 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29734 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29735 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29736 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29737 .display
29738 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29739 .endd
29740 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29741 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29742
29743 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29744 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29745 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29746 of &'p'&.
29747
29748 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29749 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29750 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29751 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29752 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29753 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29754 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29755 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29756 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29757
29758 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29759 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29760 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29761 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29762
29763 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29764 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29765 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29766 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29767 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29768 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29769 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29770 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29771 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29772 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29773
29774 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29775 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29776 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29777 ACL.
29778
29779 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29780 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29781 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29782 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29783 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29784 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29785
29786 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29787 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29788 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29789 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29790 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29791 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29792 the &%count=%& option.
29793
29794
29795 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29796 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29797 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29798 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29799 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29800
29801 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29802 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29803 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29804 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29805
29806 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29807 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29808 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29809 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29810 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29811 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29812 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29813
29814 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29815 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29816 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29817 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29818 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29819 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29820 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29821
29822 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29823 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29824 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29825 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29826 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29827
29828 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29829 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29830 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29831 multiple different commands.
29832
29833 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29834 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29835 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29836 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29837 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29838
29839 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29840
29841
29842 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29843 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29844 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29845 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29846 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29847
29848 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29849 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29850
29851 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29852 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29853 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29854 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29855 new rate.
29856 .code
29857 acl_check_connect:
29858 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29859 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29860 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29861 # ...
29862 acl_check_mail:
29863 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29864 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29865 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29866 .endd
29867
29868 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29869 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29870 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29871 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29872 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29873 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29874 checks.
29875
29876 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29877 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29878 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29879 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29880 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29881
29882
29883 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29884 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29885 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29886 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29887 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29888 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29889 rest of the ACL.
29890
29891 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29892 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29893 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29894 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29895 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29896 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29897 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29898 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29899 from getting any email through.
29900
29901 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29902 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29903 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29904 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29905 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29906 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29907 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29908 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29909 .code
29910 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29911 .endd
29912
29913
29914 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29915 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29916 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29917 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29918 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29919 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29920 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29921 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29922 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29923
29924 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29925 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29926 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29927 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29928 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29929 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29930
29931 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29932 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29933 rate.
29934
29935 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29936 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29937 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29938 required increases with larger limits.
29939
29940 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29941 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29942 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29943 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29944 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29945 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29946 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29947 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29948 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29949 as intended.
29950
29951
29952 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29953 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29954 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29955 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29956 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29957 message. For example:
29958 .code
29959 # Log all senders' rates
29960 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29961 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29962
29963 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29964 # at the decimal point.
29965 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29966 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29967 $sender_rate_limit }s
29968
29969 # Keep authenticated users under control
29970 deny authenticated = *
29971 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29972
29973 # System-wide rate limit
29974 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29975 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29976
29977 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29978 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29979 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29980 messages per $sender_rate_period
29981 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29982 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29983 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29984 .endd
29985 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29986 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29987 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29988 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29989 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29990 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29991 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29992
29993
29994
29995 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29996 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29997 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29998 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29999 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30000 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30001 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30002 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30003 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30004 .code
30005 verify = sender/callout
30006 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30007 .endd
30008 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30009 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30010 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30011 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30012 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30013 The available options are as follows:
30014
30015 .ilist
30016 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30017 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30018 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30019 .next
30020 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30021 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30022 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30023 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30024 .next
30025 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30026 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30027 .next
30028 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30029 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30030 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30031 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30032 .endlist
30033
30034 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30035 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30036 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30037 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30038 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30039 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30040 coding like this:
30041 .code
30042 warn !verify = sender
30043 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30044 .endd
30045 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30046 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30047 verification failure.
30048
30049 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30050 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30051
30052 .ilist
30053 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30054 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30055 .next
30056 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30057 .next
30058 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30059 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30060 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30061 .next
30062 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30063 .next
30064 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30065 .endlist
30066
30067 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30068 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30069
30070
30071
30072
30073 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30074 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30075 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30076 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30077 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30078 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30079 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30080 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30081 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30082 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30083 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30084 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30085 sender's domain.
30086
30087 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30088 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30089 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30090 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30091 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30092 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30093
30094 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30095 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30096 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30097 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30098 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30099
30100 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30101 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30102 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30103 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30104 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30105 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30106 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30107 supplies a host list.
30108 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30109
30110 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30111 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30112 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30113 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30114 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30115 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30116 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30117
30118 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30119 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30120 following SMTP commands are sent:
30121 .display
30122 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30123 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30124 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30125 &`QUIT`&
30126 .endd
30127 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30128 set to &"lmtp"&.
30129
30130 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30131 settings.
30132
30133 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30134 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30135 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30136 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30137 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30138 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30139
30140 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30141 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30142 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30143 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30144 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30145
30146 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30147 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30148 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30149 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30150 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30151
30152
30153
30154
30155 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30156 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30157 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30158 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30159 .code
30160 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30161 .endd
30162 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30163 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30164 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30165
30166
30167 .vlist
30168 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30169 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30170 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30171 For example:
30172 .code
30173 verify = sender/callout=5s
30174 .endd
30175 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30176 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30177 the &%connect%& parameter.
30178
30179
30180 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30181 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30182 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30183 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30184 .code
30185 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30186 .endd
30187 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30188
30189 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30190 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30191 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30192 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30193 updated in this circumstance.
30194
30195 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30196 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30197 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30198 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30199 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30200 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30201
30202
30203 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30204 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30205 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30206 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30207 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30208 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30209 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30210 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30211 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30212 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30213 .code
30214 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30215 .endd
30216 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30217
30218
30219 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30220 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30221 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30222 For example:
30223 .code
30224 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30225 .endd
30226 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30227 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30228 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30229 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30230 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30231
30232
30233 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30234 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30235 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30236 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30237
30238 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30239 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30240 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30241 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30242 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30243 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30244 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30245 made, until the cache record expires.
30246
30247 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30248 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30249 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30250 For example:
30251 .code
30252 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30253 .endd
30254 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30255 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30256 .code
30257 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30258 .endd
30259 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30260 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30261 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30262 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30263
30264
30265 .vitem &*random*&
30266 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30267 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30268 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30269 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30270 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30271 .code
30272 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30273 .endd
30274 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30275 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30276 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30277 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30278 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30279
30280 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30281 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30282 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30283 .code
30284 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30285 .endd
30286 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30287 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30288 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30289 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30290 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30291
30292 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30293 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30294 .code
30295 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30296 .endd
30297 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30298 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30299 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30300 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30301 usefulness of callout caching.
30302 .endlist
30303
30304 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30305 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30306 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30307 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30308 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30309 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30310 these circumstances.
30311
30312 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30313 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30314 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30315 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30316 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30317 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30318 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30319
30320 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30321 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30322 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30323 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30324
30325
30326
30327
30328 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30329 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30330 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30331 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30332 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30333 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30334 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30335 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30336 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30337 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30338
30339 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30340 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30341 is not available.
30342
30343 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30344 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30345 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30346
30347 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30348 commands up to and including
30349 .code
30350 MAIL FROM:<>
30351 .endd
30352 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30353 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30354 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30355 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30356 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30357 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30358 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30359
30360 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30361 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30362 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30363 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30364 will eventually be noticed.
30365
30366 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30367 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30368 behaviour will be the same.
30369
30370
30371
30372 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30373 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30374 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30375 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30376 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30377 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30378 you might see:
30379 .code
30380 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30381 250 OK
30382 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30383 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30384 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30385 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30386 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30387 550 Sender verification failed
30388 .endd
30389 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30390 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30391 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30392 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30393 example:
30394 .code
30395 verify = sender/no_details
30396 .endd
30397
30398 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30399 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30400 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30401 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30402 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30403 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30404 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30405
30406 .ilist
30407 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30408 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30409 verification also fails.
30410 .next
30411 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30412 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30413 .endlist
30414
30415 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30416 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30417 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30418 .code
30419 A.Wol: aw123
30420 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30421 .endd
30422 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30423 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30424 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30425 verification to succeed.
30426
30427 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30428 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30429 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30430 option. For example:
30431 .code
30432 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30433 .endd
30434 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30435 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30436
30437 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30438 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30439 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30440 address and a report is output for each of them.
30441
30442
30443
30444 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30445 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30446 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30447 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30448 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30449 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30450 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30451 .code
30452 verify = csa
30453 .endd
30454 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30455 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30456 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30457 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30458 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30459 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30460
30461 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30462 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30463 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30464 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30465
30466 .ilist
30467 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30468 .next
30469 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30470 .next
30471 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30472 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30473 .next
30474 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30475 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30476 .endlist
30477
30478 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30479 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30480 .code
30481 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30482 .endd
30483 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30484 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30485 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30486 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30487 meaningful to say:
30488 .code
30489 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30490 .endd
30491 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30492 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30493 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30494
30495 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30496 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30497 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30498 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30499 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30500 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30501 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30502 of legitimate HELO domains.
30503
30504 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30505 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30506 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30507 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30508 lookup such as:
30509 .code
30510 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30511 .endd
30512 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30513 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30514 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30515
30516
30517
30518
30519 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30520 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30521 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30522 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30523 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30524 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30525 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30526 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30527
30528 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30529 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30530 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30531 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30532 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30533 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30534 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30535
30536 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30537 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30538 like this:
30539 .code
30540 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30541 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30542 }{$value}}
30543 .endd
30544 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30545 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30546 use this:
30547 .code
30548 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30549 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30550 senders = :
30551 recipients = +batv_senders
30552
30553 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30554 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30555 senders = :
30556 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30557 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30558 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30559 .endd
30560 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30561 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30562 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30563 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30564 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30565
30566 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30567 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30568 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30569 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30570 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30571 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30572 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30573
30574 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30575 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30576 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30577 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30578 .code
30579 batv_redirect:
30580 driver = redirect
30581 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30582 .endd
30583 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30584 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30585 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30586 local addresses.
30587
30588 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30589 can be used:
30590 .code
30591 external_smtp_batv:
30592 driver = smtp
30593 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30594 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30595 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30596 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30597 {$value}fail}}}
30598 .endd
30599 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30600
30601
30602
30603 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30604 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30605 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30606 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30607 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30608 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30609 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30610 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30611 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30612 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30613
30614 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30615 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30616 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30617 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30618 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30619 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30620 . ///
30621 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30622 . ///
30623 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30624 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30625 system to arbitrary domains.
30626
30627
30628 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30629 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30630 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30631 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30632
30633 .ilist
30634 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30635 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30636 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30637 .next
30638 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30639 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30640 .next
30641 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30642 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30643 .endlist
30644
30645
30646 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30647 .code
30648 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30649 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30650 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30651 .endd
30652 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30653 command:
30654 .code
30655 acl_check_rcpt:
30656 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30657 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30658 .endd
30659 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30660 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30661 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30662 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30663 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30664 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30665 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30666
30667
30668
30669 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30670 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30671 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30672 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30673 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30674
30675 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30676 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30677 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30678 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30679 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30680 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30681 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30682 .ecindex IIDacl
30683
30684
30685
30686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30688
30689 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30690 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30691 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30692 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30693 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30694 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30695 specification.
30696
30697 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30698 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30699 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30700 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30701 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30702
30703 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30704 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30705 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30706
30707 .ilist
30708 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30709 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30710 .next
30711 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30712 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30713 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30714 .next
30715 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30716 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30717 .next
30718 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30719 conditions.
30720 .next
30721 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30722 .endlist
30723
30724 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30725 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30726 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30727
30728 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30729 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30730 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30731 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30732 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30733 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30734
30735 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30736 temporarily created in a file called:
30737 .display
30738 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30739 .endd
30740 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30741 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30742 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30743 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30744 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30745 .code
30746 control = no_mbox_unspool
30747 .endd
30748 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30749 same directory by default.
30750
30751
30752
30753 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30754 .cindex "virus scanning"
30755 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30756 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30757 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30758 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30759 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30760 in memory and thus are much faster.
30761
30762 .new
30763 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30764 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30765 .wen
30766
30767 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30768 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30769 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30770 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30771 .display
30772 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30773 .endd
30774 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30775 .code
30776 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30777 .endd
30778 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30779 before use.
30780 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30781 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30782
30783 .vlist
30784 .new
30785 .vitem &%avast%&
30786 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30787 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30788 Security (currenty at version 1.1.7).
30789 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30790 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30791 This scanner type takes one option,
30792 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30793 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30794 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30795 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30796 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30797 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30798 For example:
30799 .code
30800 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30801 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30802 .endd
30803 If you omit the argument, the default path
30804 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30805 is used.
30806 If you use a remote host,
30807 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30808 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30809 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30810 .code
30811 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30812 FLAGS
30813 SENSITIVITY
30814 PACK
30815 .endd
30816 .wen
30817
30818
30819 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30820 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30821 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30822 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30823 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30824 example:
30825 .code
30826 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30827 .endd
30828
30829
30830 .vitem &%clamd%&
30831 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30832 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30833 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30834 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30835 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30836
30837 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30838 a UNIX socket specification,
30839 a TCP socket specification,
30840 or a (global) option.
30841
30842 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30843 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30844 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30845 and the second a port number,
30846 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30847 These per-server options are supported:
30848 .code
30849 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30850 .endd
30851
30852 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30853 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30854
30855 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30856
30857 Examples:
30858 .code
30859 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30860 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30861 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30862 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30863 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30864 .endd
30865 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30866 &`local`&
30867 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30868 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30869 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30870 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30871 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30872 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30873
30874 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30875 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30876 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30877 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30878 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30879 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30880 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30881 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30882 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30883 .code
30884 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30885 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30886 (Connection refused)
30887 .endd
30888
30889 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30890 contributing the code for this scanner.
30891
30892 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30893 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30894 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30895 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30896 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30897
30898 .olist
30899 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30900 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30901
30902 .next
30903 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30904 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30905 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30906 the &"trigger"& expression.
30907
30908 .next
30909 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30910 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30911 &"name"& expression.
30912 .endlist olist
30913
30914 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30915 .code
30916 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30917 .endd
30918 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30919 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30920 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30921 configuration setting:
30922 .code
30923 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30924 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30925 found in file:'(.+)'
30926 .endd
30927 .vitem &%drweb%&
30928 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30929 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30930 takes one option,
30931 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30932 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30933 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30934 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30935 For example:
30936 .code
30937 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30938 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30939 .endd
30940 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30941 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30942
30943 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30944 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30945 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30946 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30947 (or port-range).
30948 For example:
30949 .code
30950 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30951 .endd
30952 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30953
30954 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30955 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30956 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30957 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30958 .code
30959 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30960 .endd
30961 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30962 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30963
30964 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30965 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30966 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30967 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30968 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30969 For example:
30970 .code
30971 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30972 .endd
30973 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30974
30975 .vitem &%mksd%&
30976 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30977 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30978 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30979 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30980 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30981 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30982 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30983 .code
30984 av_scanner = mksd:2
30985 .endd
30986 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30987
30988 .vitem &%sock%&
30989 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30990 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30991 running on the local machine.
30992 There are four options:
30993 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30994 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30995 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30996 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30997 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30998 For example:
30999 .code
31000 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31001 .endd
31002 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31003 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31004 Both regular-expressions are required.
31005
31006 .vitem &%sophie%&
31007 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31008 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31009 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31010 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31011 client communication. For example:
31012 .code
31013 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31014 .endd
31015 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31016 the option.
31017 .endlist
31018
31019 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31020 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31021 ACL.
31022
31023 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31024 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31025 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31026 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31027 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31028 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31029 message.
31030
31031 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31032 .new
31033 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31034 .wen
31035 The first element can then be one of
31036
31037 .ilist
31038 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31039 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31040 recommended usage.
31041 .next
31042 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31043 the condition fails immediately.
31044 .next
31045 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31046 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31047 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31048 .new
31049 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31050 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31051 .wen
31052 .endlist
31053
31054 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31055 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31056 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31057
31058 .new
31059 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31060 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31061 For example:
31062 .code
31063 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31064 .endd
31065 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31066 .wen
31067
31068 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31069 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31070 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31071 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31072 logging data.
31073
31074 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31075 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31076 &%malware%& condition.
31077
31078 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31079 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31080
31081 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31082 .code
31083 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31084 demime = *
31085 malware = *
31086 .endd
31087 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31088 .code
31089 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31090 demime = *
31091 malware = */defer_ok
31092 .endd
31093 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31094 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31095 .code
31096 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31097 .endd
31098 in the main Exim configuration.
31099 .code
31100 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31101 set acl_m0 = sophie
31102 malware = *
31103
31104 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31105 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31106 malware = *
31107 .endd
31108
31109
31110 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31111 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31112 .cindex "spam scanning"
31113 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31114 .cindex "Rspamd"
31115 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31116 score and a report for the message.
31117 .new
31118 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31119
31120 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31121 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31122 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31123 .wen
31124
31125 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31126 .code
31127 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31128 .endd
31129 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31130 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31131 nicely, however.
31132
31133 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31134 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31135 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31136 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31137 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31138 configuration as follows (example):
31139 .code
31140 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31141 .endd
31142
31143 .new
31144 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31145 on TCP port 11333)
31146 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31147 .code
31148 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31149 .endd
31150 .wen
31151
31152 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31153 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31154 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31155 .code
31156 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31157 .endd
31158 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31159 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31160 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31161 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31162 .code
31163 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31164 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31165 192.168.2.12 783
31166 .endd
31167 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31168 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31169 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31170 condition defers.
31171
31172 .new
31173 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31174 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31175 and changeable in the usual way.
31176
31177 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31178 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31179 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31180 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31181
31182 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31183 are options.
31184 The supported option are:
31185 .code
31186 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31187 weight=<value> Selection bias
31188 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31189 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31190 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31191 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31192 .endd
31193
31194 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31195 higher values being tried first.
31196 The deafult priority is 1.
31197
31198 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31199 Within a priority set
31200 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31201 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31202
31203 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31204 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31205 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31206 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31207
31208 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31209 are the usual Exim time interval standard, eg. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31210
31211 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31212 The default value is two minutes.
31213
31214 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31215 a failed connect is made.
31216 The default is to not retry.
31217 .wen
31218
31219 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31220 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31221 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31222 expansion.
31223
31224 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31225 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31226 .code
31227 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31228 spam = joe
31229 .endd
31230 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31231 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31232 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31233 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31234 .new
31235 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31236 right-hand side.
31237 .wen
31238
31239 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31240 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31241 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31242 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31243 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31244 are not set.
31245 .new
31246 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31247 (eg. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31248 after the first),
31249 or the use of PRDR,
31250 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31251 are needed to use this feature.
31252 .wen
31253
31254 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31255 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31256 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31257
31258
31259 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31260 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31261 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31262 example:
31263 .code
31264 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31265 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31266 spam = nobody
31267 .endd
31268
31269 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31270 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31271 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31272 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31273
31274 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31275 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31276 variables.
31277 .new
31278 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31279 .wen
31280 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31281 available for use at delivery time.
31282
31283 .vlist
31284 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31285 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31286 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31287
31288 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31289 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31290 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31291 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31292 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31293
31294 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31295 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31296 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31297 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31298 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
31299
31300 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31301 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31302 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31303 .new
31304 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31305 .wen
31306
31307 .new
31308 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31309 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31310 spam score versus threshold.
31311 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31312 .wen
31313
31314 .endlist
31315
31316 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31317 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31318 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31319
31320 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31321 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31322 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31323 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31324 spam condition, like this:
31325 .code
31326 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31327 spam = joe/defer_ok
31328 .endd
31329 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31330
31331 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31332 condition:
31333 .code
31334 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31335 warn spam = nobody:true
31336 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31337 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31338
31339 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31340 # is over threshold
31341 warn spam = nobody
31342 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31343
31344 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31345 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31346 spam = nobody:true
31347 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31348 .endd
31349
31350
31351
31352 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31353 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31354 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31355 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31356 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31357 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31358 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31359 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31360 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31361 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31362 cases.
31363
31364 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31365 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31366 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31367 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31368 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31369 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31370 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31371
31372 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31373 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31374 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31375 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31376 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31377
31378 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31379 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31380 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31381 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31382 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31383 syntax is:
31384 .display
31385 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31386 .endd
31387 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31388 the value can be:
31389
31390 .olist
31391 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31392 .next
31393 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31394 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31395 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31396 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31397 .next
31398 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31399 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31400 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31401 the full path and file name.
31402 .next
31403 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31404 filename, and the default path is then used.
31405 .endlist
31406 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31407 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31408 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31409 .code
31410 decode = $mime_filename
31411 .endd
31412 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31413 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31414 automatically unlinked.
31415
31416 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31417 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31418 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31419 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31420 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31421
31422 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31423 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31424 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31425
31426 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31427 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31428 available in the MIME ACL:
31429
31430 .vlist
31431 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31432 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31433 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31434 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31435 contains the empty string.
31436
31437 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31438 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31439 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31440 .code
31441 us-ascii
31442 gb2312 (Chinese)
31443 iso-8859-1
31444 .endd
31445 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31446 case-insensitively.
31447
31448 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31449 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31450 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31451 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31452 only used for display purposes.
31453
31454 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31455 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31456 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31457
31458 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31459 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31460 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31461
31462 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31463 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31464 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31465 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31466 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31467
31468 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31469 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31470 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31471 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31472
31473 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31474 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31475 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31476 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31477 .code
31478 text/plain
31479 text/html
31480 application/octet-stream
31481 image/jpeg
31482 audio/midi
31483 .endd
31484 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31485 empty string.
31486
31487 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31488 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31489 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31490 containing the decoded data.
31491 .endlist
31492
31493 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31494 .vlist
31495 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31496 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31497 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31498 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31499 RFC2047
31500 .new
31501 or RFC2231
31502 .wen
31503 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31504 If no filename was
31505 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31506
31507 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31508 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31509 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31510 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31511
31512 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31513 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31514 follows:
31515
31516 .olist
31517 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31518
31519 .next
31520 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31521 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31522
31523 .next
31524 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31525 and the rest are attachments.
31526
31527 .next
31528 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31529 .endlist olist
31530
31531 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31532 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31533 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31534 .code
31535 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31536 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31537 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31538 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31539 .endd
31540 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31541 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31542 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31543 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31544 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31545
31546 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31547 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31548 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31549 decoding is fully recursive.
31550
31551 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31552 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31553 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31554 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31555 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31556 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31557 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31558 .endlist
31559
31560
31561
31562 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31563 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31564 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31565 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31566 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31567
31568 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31569 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31570 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31571 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31572 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31573
31574 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31575 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31576 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31577 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31578 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31579 32K characters are checked.
31580
31581 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31582 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31583 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31584 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31585 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31586 .code
31587 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31588 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31589 .endd
31590 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31591 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31592 matching regular expression.
31593
31594 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31595 CPU-intensive.
31596
31597
31598
31599
31600 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31601 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31602 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31603 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31604 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31605 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31606 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31607 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31608 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31609 use the &%demime%& condition.
31610
31611 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31612 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31613 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31614 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31615 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31616 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31617
31618 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31619 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31620 example:
31621 .code
31622 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31623 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31624 .endd
31625 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31626 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31627 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31628 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31629
31630 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31631 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31632 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31633
31634 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31635
31636 .vlist
31637 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31638 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31639 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31640 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31641 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31642 zero, no error occurred.
31643
31644 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31645 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31646 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31647 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31648 .endlist
31649
31650 .vlist
31651 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31652 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31653 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31654 extension it found.
31655 .endlist
31656
31657 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31658 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31659
31660 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31661 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31662 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31663 facility:
31664 .code
31665 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31666 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31667 demime = *
31668 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31669
31670 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31671 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31672 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31673 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31674
31675 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31676 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31677 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31678 demime = exe:doc
31679 control = freeze
31680 .endd
31681 .ecindex IIDcosca
31682
31683
31684
31685
31686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31688
31689 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31690 "Local scan function"
31691 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31692 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31693 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31694 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31695 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31696
31697 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31698 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31699 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31700 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31701 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31702
31703 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31704 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31705 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31706 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31707
31708 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31709 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31710 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31711 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31712
31713 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31714 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31715 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31716 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31717 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31718 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31719 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31720 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31721 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31722
31723
31724
31725 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31726 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31727 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31728 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31729 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31730 directory, so you might set
31731 .code
31732 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31733 .endd
31734 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31735 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31736 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31737 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31738 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31739 _src/local_scan.c_.
31740
31741 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31742 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31743 .code
31744 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31745 .endd
31746 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31747
31748
31749
31750
31751 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31752 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31753 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31754 .code
31755 #include "local_scan.h"
31756 .endd
31757 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31758 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31759 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31760 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31761 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31762 strings and pointers to character strings:
31763 .code
31764 #define CS (char *)
31765 #define CCS (const char *)
31766 #define CSS (char **)
31767 #define US (unsigned char *)
31768 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31769 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31770 .endd
31771 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31772 .code
31773 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31774 .endd
31775 The arguments are as follows:
31776
31777 .ilist
31778 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31779 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31780 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31781
31782 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31783 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31784 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31785 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31786 case this changes in some future version.
31787 .next
31788 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31789 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31790 .endlist
31791
31792 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31793
31794 .vlist
31795 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31796 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31797 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31798 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31799 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31800 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31801
31802 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31803 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31804 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31805
31806 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31807 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31808 queued without immediate delivery.
31809
31810 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31811 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31812 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31813 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31814 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31815 used.
31816
31817 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31818 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31819 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31820 problem"& is used.
31821
31822 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31823 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31824 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31825 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31826 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31827 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31828 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31829
31830 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31831 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31832 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31833 .endlist
31834
31835 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31836 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31837 &%-oe%& command line options.
31838
31839
31840
31841 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31842 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31843 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31844 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31845 want to do this, you must have the line
31846 .code
31847 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31848 .endd
31849 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31850 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31851 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31852 to define them.
31853
31854 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31855 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31856 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31857 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31858 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31859 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31860 .code
31861 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31862 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31863
31864 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31865 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31866 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31867 };
31868
31869 int local_scan_options_count =
31870 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31871 .endd
31872 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31873 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31874 .code
31875 begin local_scan
31876 my_integer = 99
31877 my_string = some string of text...
31878 .endd
31879 The available types of option data are as follows:
31880
31881 .vlist
31882 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31883 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31884 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31885 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31886 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31887 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31888 values.)
31889
31890 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31891 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31892 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31893 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31894
31895 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31896 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31897 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31898 Exim.
31899
31900 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31901 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31902 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31903 printed with the suffix K or M.
31904
31905 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31906 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31907 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31908 always output in octal.
31909
31910 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31911 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31912 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31913
31914 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31915 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31916 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31917 .endlist
31918
31919 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31920 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31921
31922
31923
31924 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31925 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31926 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31927 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31928 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31929 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31930 C variables are as follows:
31931
31932 .vlist
31933 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31934 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31935
31936 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31937 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31938
31939 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31940 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31941 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31942 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31943
31944 .ilist
31945 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31946 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31947 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31948
31949 .next
31950 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31951 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31952 of debugging bits.
31953 .endlist ilist
31954
31955 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31956 selected, you should use code like this:
31957 .code
31958 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31959 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31960 .endd
31961 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31962 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31963 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31964
31965 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31966 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31967 discussed below.
31968
31969 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31970 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31971
31972 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31973 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31974
31975 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31976 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31977 &%-bh%& command line option.
31978
31979 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31980 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31981 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31982
31983 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31984 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31985 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31986 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31987
31988 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31989 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31990 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31991
31992 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31993 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31994
31995 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31996 The number of accepted recipients.
31997
31998 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31999 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32000 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32001 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32002 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32003 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32004 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32005 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32006 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32007 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32008 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32009 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32010
32011 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32012 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32013
32014 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32015 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32016 locally-submitted messages.
32017
32018 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32019 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32020 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32021
32022 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32023 The name of the sending host, if known.
32024
32025 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32026 The port on the sending host.
32027
32028 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32029 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32030
32031 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32032 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32033
32034 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32035 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32036 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32037 .endlist
32038
32039
32040 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32041 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32042 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32043 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32044 their type to *.
32045
32046
32047 .vlist
32048 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32049 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32050
32051 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32052 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32053 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32054 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32055 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32056 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32057 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32058
32059 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32060 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32061 internal newlines.
32062
32063 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32064 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32065 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32066 .endlist
32067
32068
32069
32070 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32071 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32072
32073 .vlist
32074 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32075 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32076
32077 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32078 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32079 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32080 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32081
32082 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32083 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32084 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32085 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32086 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32087 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32088 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32089 is NULL for all recipients.
32090 .endlist
32091
32092
32093
32094 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32095 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32096 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32097 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32098 release:
32099
32100 .vlist
32101 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32102 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32103
32104 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32105 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32106 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32107 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32108
32109 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32110 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32111 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32112 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32113 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32114
32115 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32116
32117 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32118 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32119 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32120 return value is as follows:
32121
32122 .ilist
32123 >= 0
32124
32125 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32126 ending status.
32127
32128 .next
32129 < 0 and > &--256
32130
32131 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32132 signal number.
32133
32134 .next
32135 &--256
32136
32137 The process timed out.
32138 .next
32139 &--257
32140
32141 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32142 .endlist
32143
32144 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32145 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32146 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32147 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32148 forks a subprocess that is running
32149 .code
32150 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32151 .endd
32152 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32153 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32154 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32155 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32156
32157 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32158 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32159 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32160 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32161
32162
32163 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32164 *sender_authentication)*&
32165 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32166 that it runs is:
32167 .display
32168 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32169 .endd
32170 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32171
32172
32173 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32174 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32175 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32176 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32177 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32178 .code
32179 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32180 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32181 .endd
32182
32183 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32184 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32185 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32186 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32187 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32188 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32189 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32190 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32191
32192 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32193 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32194 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32195 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32196 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32197 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32198
32199 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32200 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32201 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32202 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32203
32204 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32205 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32206 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32207 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32208 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32209 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32210 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32211 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32212 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32213 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32214 .code
32215 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32216 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32217 .endd
32218 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32219 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32220
32221
32222 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32223 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32224 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32225 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32226 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32227
32228
32229 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32230 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32231 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32232 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32233 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32234 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32235 .code
32236 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32237 .endd
32238 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32239 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32240 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32241 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32242 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32243 zero-terminated.
32244
32245 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32246 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32247 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32248 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32249 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32250 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32251 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32252 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32253
32254 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32255 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32256 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32257 .display
32258 &`OK `& match succeeded
32259 &`FAIL `& match failed
32260 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32261 .endd
32262 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32263 inability to contact a database.
32264
32265 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32266 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32267 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32268 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32269 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32270
32271 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32272 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32273 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32274 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32275 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32276
32277 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32278 uschar&~*list)*&"
32279 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32280 expected to be
32281 .code
32282 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32283 .endd
32284 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32285 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32286 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32287 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32288 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32289 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32290 failed.
32291
32292 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32293 *format,&~...)*&"
32294 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32295 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32296 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32297 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32298 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32299 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32300
32301
32302 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32303 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32304 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32305 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32306
32307 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32308 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32309 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32310 value afterwards. For example:
32311 .code
32312 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32313 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32314 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32315 .endd
32316
32317 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32318 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32319 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32320 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32321 address.
32322 .endlist
32323
32324
32325 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32326 .vlist
32327 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32328 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32329 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32330 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32331 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32332 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32333 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32334 binary string is returned with an error message.
32335
32336 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32337 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32338 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32339
32340 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32341 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32342 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32343 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32344 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32345
32346 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32347 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32348 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32349
32350 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32351 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32352 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32353 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32354 with translation.
32355
32356
32357 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32358 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32359 below.
32360
32361 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32362 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32363 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32364 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32365 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32366 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32367 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32368 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32369 is involved.
32370
32371 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32372 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32373
32374 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32375 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32376 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32377 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32378 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32379 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32380 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32381 .code
32382 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32383 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32384 .endd
32385 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32386 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32387 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32388 multiple output lines.
32389
32390 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32391 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32392 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32393 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32394 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32395 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32396 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32397 is an error.
32398
32399 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32400 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32401 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32402 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32403
32404 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32405 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32406 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32407
32408 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32409 See below.
32410
32411 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32412 See below.
32413
32414 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32415 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32416 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32417 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32418 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32419 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32420 more discussion.
32421 .endlist
32422
32423
32424
32425 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32426 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32427 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32428 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32429 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32430 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32431 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32432 terminates.
32433
32434 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32435 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32436 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32437 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32438
32439 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32440 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32441 .code
32442 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32443 .endd
32444 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32445 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32446 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32447 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32448
32449 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32450 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32451 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32452 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32453 &%store_pool%&.
32454 .ecindex IIDlosca
32455
32456
32457
32458
32459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32461
32462 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32463 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32464 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32465 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32466 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32467 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32468 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32469 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32470
32471 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32472 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32473 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32474 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32475 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32476
32477 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32478 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32479 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32480 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32481 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32482 prevent it happening on retries.
32483
32484 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32485 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32486 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32487 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32488 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32489 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32490 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32491 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32492
32493
32494 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32495 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32496 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32497 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32498 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32499 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32500 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32501 .code
32502 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32503 system_filter_user = exim
32504 .endd
32505 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32506 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32507 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32508 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32509 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32510 by the &%reply%& command.
32511
32512
32513 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32514 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32515 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32516 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32517
32518 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32519 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32520
32521
32522
32523 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32524 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32525 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32526 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32527 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32528 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32529 they cause errors.
32530
32531 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32532 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32533 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32534 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32535 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32536 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32537 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32538
32539 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32540 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32541 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32542 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32543 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32544
32545 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32546 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32547 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32548 to which users' filter files can refer.
32549
32550
32551
32552 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32553 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32554 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32555 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32556 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32557
32558
32559
32560 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32561 .cindex "freezing messages"
32562 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32563 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32564 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32565 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32566 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32567 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32568 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32569 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32570 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32571 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32572 .code
32573 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32574 .endd
32575 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32576
32577 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32578 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32579 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32580 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32581 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32582 run.
32583
32584 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32585 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32586 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32587 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32588
32589 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32590 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32591 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32592 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32593 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32594 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32595 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32596 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32597 message. For example:
32598 .code
32599 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32600 because it contains attachments that we are \
32601 not prepared to receive."
32602 .endd
32603
32604 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32605 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32606 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32607 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32608 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32609 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32610 use, for example
32611 .code
32612 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32613 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32614 .endd
32615 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32616 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32617 generated by the filter.
32618
32619 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32620 &%defer%&,
32621 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32622 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32623 as
32624 .code
32625 mail ...
32626 freeze
32627 .endd
32628 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32629 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32630 take place.
32631
32632
32633
32634 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32635 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32636 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32637 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32638 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32639 .code
32640 headers add <string>
32641 headers remove <string>
32642 .endd
32643 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32644 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32645 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32646 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32647 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32648
32649 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32650 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32651 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32652 example:
32653 .code
32654 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32655 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32656 X-header-2: ...."
32657 .endd
32658 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32659 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32660 space after input continuations is ignored.
32661
32662 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32663 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32664 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32665 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32666 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32667
32668 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32669 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32670 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32671 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32672 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32673 used for all recipients of the message.
32674
32675 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32676 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32677 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32678 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32679 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32680 until the message is actually being written (see section
32681 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32682
32683 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32684 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32685 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32686 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32687 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32688 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32689 modified more than once.
32690
32691 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32692 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32693 For example:
32694 .code
32695 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32696 headers remove "Subject"
32697 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32698 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32699 .endd
32700
32701
32702
32703 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32704 .cindex "envelope sender"
32705 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32706 .code
32707 errors_to <some address>
32708 .endd
32709 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32710 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32711 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32712 might use
32713 .code
32714 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32715 .endd
32716 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32717 address if its delivery failed.
32718
32719
32720
32721 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32722 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32723 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32724 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32725 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32726 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32727 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32728 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32729 which implements such a filter:
32730 .code
32731 central_filter:
32732 check_local_user
32733 driver = redirect
32734 domains = +local_domains
32735 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32736 no_verify
32737 allow_filter
32738 allow_freeze
32739 .endd
32740 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32741 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32742 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32743 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32744
32745 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32746 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32747 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32748 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32749 normal way.
32750 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32751 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32752 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32753
32754
32755
32756
32757
32758
32759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32761
32762 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32763 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32764 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32765 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32766 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32767 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32768 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32769 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32770
32771 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32772 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32773 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32774 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32775 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32776
32777 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32778 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32779 loopback interface specially in any way.
32780
32781 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32782 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32783
32784
32785
32786
32787 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32788 .cindex "message" "submission"
32789 .cindex "submission mode"
32790 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32791 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32792 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32793 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32794 .code
32795 control = submission
32796 .endd
32797 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32798 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32799 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32800 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32801 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32802 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32803 .code
32804 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32805 control = submission
32806 .endd
32807 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32808 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32809 is used to separate options. For example:
32810 .code
32811 control = submission/sender_retain
32812 .endd
32813 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32814 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32815 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32816 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32817 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32818 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32819 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32820
32821 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32822 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32823 example:
32824 .code
32825 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32826 .endd
32827 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32828 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32829 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32830 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32831 .code
32832 accept authenticated = *
32833 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32834 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32835 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32836 .endd
32837 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32838 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32839 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32840 .code
32841 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32842 .endd
32843 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32844 line would be:
32845 .code
32846 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32847 .endd
32848 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32849 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32850 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32851 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32852
32853 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32854 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32855 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32856 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32857 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32858 spoof another's address.
32859
32860 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32861 .cindex "line endings"
32862 .cindex "carriage return"
32863 .cindex "linefeed"
32864 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32865 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32866 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32867 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32868 use CRLF or just CR.
32869
32870 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32871 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32872 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32873 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32874 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32875 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32876 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32877 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32878 follows:
32879
32880 .ilist
32881 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32882 .next
32883 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32884 is ignored.
32885 .next
32886 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32887 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32888 terminator.
32889 .next
32890 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32891 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32892 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32893 people trying to play silly games.
32894 .next
32895 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32896 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32897 line.
32898 .endlist
32899
32900
32901
32902
32903
32904 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32905 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32906 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32907 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32908 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32909 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32910 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32911 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32912
32913 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32914 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32915 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32916 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32917 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32918
32919 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32920 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32921 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32922 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32923 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32924 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32925 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32926 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32927
32928
32929
32930
32931 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32932 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32933 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32934 .cindex "sender" "address"
32935 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32936 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32937 .cindex "envelope sender"
32938 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32939 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32940 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32941 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32942 .code
32943 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32944 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32945 .endd
32946 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32947 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32948 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32949 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32950 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32951 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32952 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32953 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32954 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32955
32956 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32957 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32958 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32959 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32960 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32961 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32962 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32963
32964 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32965 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32966 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32967
32968 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32969 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32970 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32971 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32972
32973
32974
32975 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32976 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32977 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32978 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32979 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32980 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32981 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32982
32983 .blockquote
32984 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32985 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32986 .endblockquote
32987
32988 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32989 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32990 follows:
32991
32992 .ilist
32993 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32994 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32995 .next
32996 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32997 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32998 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32999 .next
33000 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33001 also removed.
33002 .next
33003 For a locally-submitted message,
33004 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33005 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33006 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33007 included in log lines in this case.
33008 .next
33009 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33010 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33011 .endlist
33012
33013
33014
33015
33016 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33017 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33018 includes the header line:
33019 .code
33020 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33021 .endd
33022
33023 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33024 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33025 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33026 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33027 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33028 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33029
33030
33031 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33032 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33033 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33034 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33035 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33036
33037 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33038 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33039 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33040 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33041 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33042 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33043 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33044 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33045 messages.
33046
33047
33048 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33049 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33050 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33051 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33052 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33053 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33054 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33055 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33056 messages.
33057
33058
33059 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33060 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33061 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33062 .cindex "message" "submission"
33063 .cindex "submission mode"
33064 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33065 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33066
33067 .ilist
33068 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33069 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33070 .next
33071 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33072 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33073 .olist
33074 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33075 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33076 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33077 .next
33078 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33079 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33080 .next
33081 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33082 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33083 .endlist
33084 .endlist
33085
33086 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33087
33088 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33089 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33090 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33091 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33092 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33093 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33094 &%qualify_domain%&.
33095
33096 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33097 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33098 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33099 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33100
33101
33102 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33103 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33104 .cindex "message" "submission"
33105 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33106 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33107 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33108 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33109 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33110 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33111 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33112 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33113 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33114 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33115
33116
33117 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33118 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33119 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33120 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33121 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33122
33123 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33124 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33125 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33126 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33127
33128 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33129 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33130 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33131
33132
33133 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33134 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33135 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33136 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33137 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33138 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33139 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33140 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33141 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33142 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33143 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33144
33145
33146
33147 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33148 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33149 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33150 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33151 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33152 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33153 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33154 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33155
33156
33157
33158 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33159 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33160 .cindex "message" "submission"
33161 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33162 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33163 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33164 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33165 control setting.
33166
33167 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33168 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33169 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33170 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33171 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33172 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33173 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33174 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33175 line is added to the message.
33176
33177 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33178 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33179 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33180 options true at the same time.
33181
33182 .cindex "submission mode"
33183 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33184 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33185 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33186 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33187
33188 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33189 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33190 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33191 created as follows:
33192
33193 .ilist
33194 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33195 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33196 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33197 .next
33198 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33199 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33200 .next
33201 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33202 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33203 .endlist
33204
33205 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33206 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33207 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33208 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33209
33210 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33211 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33212 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33213 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33214
33215
33216
33217 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33218 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33219 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33220 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33221 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33222 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33223 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33224 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33225 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33226
33227 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33228 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33229 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33230 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33231 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33232 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33233
33234 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33235 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33236 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33237
33238 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33239 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33240 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33241 .code
33242 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33243 X-added-second: another added header line
33244 .endd
33245 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33246
33247 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33248 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33249 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33250
33251 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33252 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33253 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33254 not part of the names. For example:
33255 .code
33256 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33257 .endd
33258
33259 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33260 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33261 Each item is separately expanded.
33262 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33263 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33264 will act as list separators.
33265
33266 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33267 items are expanded at routing time,
33268 and then associated with all addresses that are
33269 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33270 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33271 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33272
33273 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33274 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33275 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33276 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33277
33278 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33279 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33280 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33281 requirements.
33282
33283 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33284 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33285 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33286 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33287 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33288 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33289 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33290
33291 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33292 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33293 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33294 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33295
33296 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33297 the following consequences:
33298
33299 .ilist
33300 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33301 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33302 to it, at all times.
33303 .next
33304 Header lines that are added by a router's
33305 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33306 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33307 .next
33308 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33309 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33310 .next
33311 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33312 a later router or by a transport.
33313 .next
33314 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33315 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33316 .code
33317 headers_remove = subject
33318 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33319 .endd
33320 .endlist
33321
33322 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33323 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33324
33325
33326
33327
33328
33329 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33330 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33331 .cindex "constructed address"
33332 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33333 the form
33334 .display
33335 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33336 .endd
33337 For example:
33338 .code
33339 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33340 .endd
33341 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33342 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33343 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33344 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33345 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33346 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33347 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33348 there is no password file entry.
33349
33350 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33351 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33352 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33353 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33354 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33355 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33356 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33357 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33358 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33359
33360
33361
33362 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33363 .cindex "case of local parts"
33364 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33365 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33366 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33367 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33368 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33369 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33370 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33371 router option.
33372
33373 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33374 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33375 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33376 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33377 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33378 .code
33379 correct_case:
33380 driver = redirect
33381 domains = +local_domains
33382 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33383 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33384 @$domain
33385 .endd
33386 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33387 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33388 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33389 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33390 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33391
33392
33393
33394 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33395 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33396 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33397 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33398 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33399 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33400 empty components for compatibility.
33401
33402
33403
33404 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33405 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33406 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33407 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33408 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33409 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33410
33411 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33412 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33413 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33414 example, a header such as
33415 .code
33416 To: hare@teaparty
33417 .endd
33418 might get rewritten as
33419 .code
33420 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33421 .endd
33422 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33423 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33424 been routed.
33425
33426 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33427 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33428 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33429 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33430 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33431 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33432 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33433
33434
33435
33436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33438
33439 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33440 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33441 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33442 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33443 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33444 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33445 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33446
33447 .ilist
33448 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33449 .next
33450 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33451 .next
33452 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33453 .endlist
33454
33455 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33456
33457 .ilist
33458 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33459 .next
33460 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33461 &"lmtp"&);
33462 .next
33463 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33464 transport);
33465 .next
33466 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33467 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33468 .endlist
33469
33470 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33471 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33472 used to contain the envelope information.
33473
33474
33475
33476 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33477 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33478 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33479 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33480 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33481 .cindex "EHLO"
33482 .cindex "HELO"
33483 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33484 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33485 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33486 processing is the same in both cases.
33487
33488 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33489 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33490 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33491 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33492 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33493 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33494 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33495 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33496 suppressed.
33497
33498 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33499 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33500 required for the transaction.
33501
33502 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33503 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33504 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33505 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33506 is called for verification.
33507
33508 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33509 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33510 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33511
33512 .cindex "carriage return"
33513 .cindex "linefeed"
33514 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33515 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33516 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33517 line terminator.
33518
33519 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33520 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33521 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33522 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33523 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33524 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33525 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33526 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33527 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33528
33529 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33530 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33531 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33532 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33533
33534 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33535 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33536 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33537 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33538
33539 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33540 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33541 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33542 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33543 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33544 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33545 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33546 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33547 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33548 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33549
33550 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33551 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33552
33553 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33554 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33555 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33556 square bracket of the IP address.
33557
33558
33559
33560
33561 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33562 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33563 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33564 .cindex "host" "error"
33565 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33566 message errors, and recipient errors.
33567
33568 .vlist
33569 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33570 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33571 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33572
33573 .ilist
33574 Connection refused or timed out,
33575 .next
33576 Any error response code on connection,
33577 .next
33578 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33579 .next
33580 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33581 .next
33582 I/O errors at any time,
33583 .next
33584 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33585 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33586 .endlist ilist
33587
33588 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33589 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33590 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33591 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33592 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33593 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33594 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33595 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33596
33597 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33598 .cindex "message" "error"
33599 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33600 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33601 message errors are:
33602
33603 .ilist
33604 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33605 the data,
33606 .next
33607 Timeout after MAIL,
33608 .next
33609 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33610 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33611 connection at any other time.
33612 .endlist ilist
33613
33614 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33615 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33616 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33617 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33618 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33619 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33620 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33621 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33622 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33623 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33624
33625 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33626 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33627 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33628 response to MAIL.
33629
33630 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33631 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33632 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33633 recipient errors are:
33634
33635 .ilist
33636 Any error response to RCPT,
33637 .next
33638 Timeout after RCPT.
33639 .endlist
33640
33641 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33642 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33643 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33644 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33645 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33646 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33647 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33648 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33649 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33650 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33651 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33652 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33653 the retry clock is reset.
33654
33655 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33656 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33657 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33658 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33659 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33660 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33661 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33662 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33663 recipient's retry time.
33664 .endlist
33665
33666 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33667 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33668 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33669 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33670 until the next delivery attempt.
33671
33672 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33673 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33674 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33675 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33676 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33677 is created.
33678
33679 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33680 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33681 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33682 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33683 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33684 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33685 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33686
33687 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33688 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33689 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33690 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33691 then to be treated as a host error.
33692
33693 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33694 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33695 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33696 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33697 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33698
33699
33700
33701
33702 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33703 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33704 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33705 .cindex "inetd"
33706 .cindex "daemon"
33707 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33708 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33709 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33710 .code
33711 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33712 .endd
33713 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33714 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33715 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33716 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33717 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33718 stream and exits with an error code.
33719
33720 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33721 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33722 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33723 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33724
33725 .cindex "carriage return"
33726 .cindex "linefeed"
33727 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33728 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33729 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33730 line terminator.
33731 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33732 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33733 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33734
33735 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33736 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33737 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33738 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33739 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33740 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33741 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33742 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33743
33744 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33745 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33746 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33747 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33748 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33749 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33750 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33751 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33752 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33753
33754 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33755 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33756 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33757
33758 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33759 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33760 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33761 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33762 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33763
33764 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33765 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33766 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33767 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33768 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33769 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33770 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33771
33772 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33773 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33774 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33775 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33776 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33777
33778 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33779 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33780 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33781 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33782 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33783 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33784 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33785 a delivery process.
33786
33787 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33788 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33789 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33790 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33791 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33792
33793 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33794 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33795 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33796 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33797
33798 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33799 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33800 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33801
33802
33803
33804 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33805 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33806 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33807 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33808 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33809 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33810 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33811 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33812
33813
33814 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33815 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33816 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33817 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33818 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33819 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33820 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33821 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33822 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33823 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33824 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33825
33826
33827
33828 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33829 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33830 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33831 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33832 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33833 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33834 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33835 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33836
33837 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33838 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33839 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33840 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33841 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33842 counted.
33843
33844 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33845 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33846 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33847
33848 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33849 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33850 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33851 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33852 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33853
33854
33855
33856
33857 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33858 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33859 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33860 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33861 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33862
33863 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33864 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33865 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33866
33867 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33868 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33869 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33870 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33871 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33872 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33873 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33874 RCPT failures.
33875
33876
33877
33878 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33879 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33880 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33881 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33882 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33883 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33884 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33885
33886 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33887 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33888 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33889 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33890 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33891 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33892 argument. For example,
33893 .code
33894 ETRN #brigadoon
33895 .endd
33896 runs the command
33897 .code
33898 exim -R brigadoon
33899 .endd
33900 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33901 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33902 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33903 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33904 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33905
33906 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33907 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33908 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33909 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33910 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33911 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33912 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33913 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33914
33915 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33916 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33917 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33918 whatever the form of its argument. For
33919 example:
33920 .code
33921 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33922 $sender_host_address
33923 .endd
33924 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33925 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33926 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33927 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33928 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33929 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33930 for it to change them before running the command.
33931
33932
33933
33934 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33935 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33936 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33937 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33938 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33939 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33940 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33941 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33942 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33943 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33944 runs for RCPT commands:
33945 .code
33946 accept hosts = :
33947 .endd
33948 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33949
33950
33951
33952 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33953 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33954 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33955 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33956 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33957 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33958 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33959 envelope along with the message.
33960
33961 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33962 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33963 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33964 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33965 can be used to specify it.
33966
33967 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33968 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33969 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33970 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33971 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33972
33973 .vindex "&$host$&"
33974 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33975 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33976 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33977 router:
33978 .code
33979 begin routers
33980 route_append:
33981 driver = manualroute
33982 transport = smtp_appendfile
33983 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33984
33985 begin transports
33986 smtp_appendfile:
33987 driver = appendfile
33988 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33989 batch_max = 1000
33990 use_bsmtp
33991 user = exim
33992 .endd
33993 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33994 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33995 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33996
33997
33998
33999 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34000 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34001 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34002 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34003 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34004 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34005 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34006 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34007 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34008 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34009
34010 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34011 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34012
34013 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34014 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34015 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34016 make some use of automatically, for example:
34017 .code
34018 554 Unexpected end of file
34019 Transaction started in line 10
34020 Error detected in line 14
34021 .endd
34022 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34023 file, for example:
34024 .code
34025 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34026 The error message was:
34027
34028 501 '>' missing at end of address
34029
34030 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34031 The error was detected in line 12.
34032 The SMTP command at fault was:
34033
34034 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34035
34036 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34037 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34038 .endd
34039 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34040 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34041 accepted.
34042 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34043 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34044
34045
34046
34047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34049
34050 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34051 "Customizing messages"
34052 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34053 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34054 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34055 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34056 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34057
34058 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34059 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34060 option. Exim also adds the line
34061 .code
34062 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34063 .endd
34064 to all warning and bounce messages,
34065
34066
34067 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34068 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34069 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34070 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34071 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34072 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34073 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34074
34075 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34076 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34077 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34078 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34079 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34080 item.
34081
34082 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34083 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34084 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34085 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34086 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34087 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34088 option, rounded to a whole number.
34089
34090 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34091
34092 .ilist
34093 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34094 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34095 .next
34096 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34097 failing addresses with their error messages.
34098 .next
34099 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34100 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34101 .next
34102 .new
34103 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34104 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34105 .wen
34106 .endlist
34107
34108 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34109 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34110 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34111 .code
34112 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34113 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34114 {: returning message to sender}}
34115 ****
34116 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34117
34118 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34119 {that you sent }{sent by
34120
34121 <$sender_address>
34122
34123 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34124 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34125 ****
34126 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34127 ****
34128 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34129 ------
34130 ****
34131 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34132 only the first
34133 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34134 ****
34135 .endd
34136 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34137 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34138 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34139 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34140 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34141 text sections:
34142
34143 .ilist
34144 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34145 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34146 .next
34147 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34148 the delayed addresses.
34149 .next
34150 The third item then ends the message.
34151 .endlist
34152
34153 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34154 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34155 .code
34156 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34157 $warn_message_delay
34158 ****
34159 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34160
34161 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34162 {that you sent }{sent by
34163
34164 <$sender_address>
34165
34166 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34167 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34168
34169 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34170 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34171 The date of the message is: $h_date
34172
34173 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34174 ****
34175 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34176 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34177 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34178 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34179 the message will be returned to you.
34180 .endd
34181 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34182 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34183 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34184 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34185 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34186 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34187 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34188 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34189 handled them.
34190
34191
34192
34193
34194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34196
34197 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34198 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34199 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34200
34201
34202
34203 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34204 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34205 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34206 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34207 routing explicitly:
34208 .code
34209 send_to_smart_host:
34210 driver = manualroute
34211 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34212 transport = remote_smtp
34213 .endd
34214 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34215 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34216 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34217 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34218 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34219
34220
34221
34222
34223 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34224 .cindex "mailing lists"
34225 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34226 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34227 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34228
34229 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34230 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34231 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34232 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34233 .code
34234 lists:
34235 driver = redirect
34236 domains = lists.example
34237 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34238 forbid_pipe
34239 forbid_file
34240 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34241 no_more
34242 .endd
34243 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34244 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34245 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34246 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34247
34248 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34249 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34250 a mailing list.
34251
34252 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34253 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34254 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34255 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34256 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34257
34258 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34259 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34260 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34261 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34262 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34263 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34264 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34265 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34266 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34267
34268
34269
34270 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34271 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34272 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34273 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34274 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34275 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34276 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34277
34278 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34279 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34280 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34281 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34282 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34283
34284
34285
34286 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34287 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34288 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34289 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34290 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34291 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34292 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34293 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34294 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34295 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34296
34297 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34298 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34299 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34300 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34301 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34302 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34303 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34304 pre-existing messages.
34305
34306 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34307 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34308 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34309 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34310 one level of expansion anyway.
34311
34312
34313
34314 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34315 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34316 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34317 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34318 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34319 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34320
34321 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34322 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34323 .code
34324 lists_request:
34325 driver = redirect
34326 domains = lists.example
34327 local_part_suffix = -request
34328 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34329 no_more
34330
34331 lists_post:
34332 driver = redirect
34333 domains = lists.example
34334 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34335 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34336 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34337 forbid_pipe
34338 forbid_file
34339 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34340 no_more
34341
34342 lists_closed:
34343 driver = redirect
34344 domains = lists.example
34345 allow_fail
34346 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34347 .endd
34348 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34349 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34350 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34351 mailing list.
34352
34353 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34354 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34355 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34356 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34357 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34358 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34359 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34360 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34361 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34362
34363 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34364 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34365 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34366
34367
34368
34369
34370 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34371 .cindex "VERP"
34372 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34373 .cindex "envelope sender"
34374 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34375 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34376 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34377 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34378 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34379 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34380
34381 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34382 .oindex &%return_path%&
34383 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34384 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34385 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34386 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34387 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34388 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34389 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34390 .code
34391 verp_smtp:
34392 driver = smtp
34393 max_rcpt = 1
34394 return_path = \
34395 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34396 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34397 .endd
34398 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34399 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34400 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34401 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34402 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34403 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34404 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34405 rewritten as
34406 .code
34407 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34408 .endd
34409 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34410 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34411 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34412 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34413 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34414 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34415
34416 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34417 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34418 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34419 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34420 .code
34421 dnslookup:
34422 driver = dnslookup
34423 domains = ! +local_domains
34424 transport = \
34425 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34426 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34427 no_more
34428 .endd
34429 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34430 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34431 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34432 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34433 address.
34434
34435 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34436 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34437 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34438 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34439 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34440 .code
34441 verp_dnslookup:
34442 driver = dnslookup
34443 domains = ! +local_domains
34444 transport = remote_smtp
34445 errors_to = \
34446 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34447 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34448 no_more
34449 .endd
34450 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34451 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34452 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34453 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34454 them.
34455
34456 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34457 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34458 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34459 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34460 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34461 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34462 used).
34463
34464
34465
34466
34467
34468
34469 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34470 .cindex "virtual domains"
34471 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34472 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34473 meanings:
34474
34475 .ilist
34476 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34477 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34478 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34479 .next
34480 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34481 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34482 have login accounts on that host.
34483 .endlist
34484
34485 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34486 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34487 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34488 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34489 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34490 to a router of this form:
34491 .code
34492 virtual:
34493 driver = redirect
34494 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34495 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34496 no_more
34497 .endd
34498 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34499 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34500 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34501 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34502 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34503 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34504
34505 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34506 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34507 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34508 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34509
34510 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34511 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34512 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34513 .code
34514 my_domains:
34515 driver = accept
34516 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34517 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34518 transport = my_mailboxes
34519 .endd
34520 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34521 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34522 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34523 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34524 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34525 follows:
34526 .code
34527 my_mailboxes:
34528 driver = appendfile
34529 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34530 user = mail
34531 .endd
34532 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34533 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34534
34535 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34536 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34537 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34538 information about the domains.
34539
34540
34541
34542 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34543 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34544 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34545 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34546 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34547 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34548 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34549 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34550 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34551 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34552 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34553 example, consider this router:
34554 .code
34555 userforward:
34556 driver = redirect
34557 check_local_user
34558 file = $home/.forward
34559 local_part_suffix = -*
34560 local_part_suffix_optional
34561 allow_filter
34562 .endd
34563 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34564 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34565 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34566 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34567 .code
34568 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34569 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34570 endif
34571 .endd
34572 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34573 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34574 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34575 control over which suffixes are valid.
34576
34577 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34578 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34579 another MTA:
34580 .code
34581 userforward:
34582 driver = redirect
34583 check_local_user
34584 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34585 local_part_suffix = -*
34586 local_part_suffix_optional
34587 allow_filter
34588 .endd
34589 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34590 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34591 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34592 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34593 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34594
34595
34596
34597 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34598 .cindex "vacation processing"
34599 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34600 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34601 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34602 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34603 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34604
34605 .ilist
34606 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34607 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34608 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34609 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34610 .code
34611 spqr, vacation-spqr
34612 .endd
34613 .next
34614 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34615 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34616 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34617 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34618 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34619 message.
34620 .endlist
34621
34622 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34623 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34624
34625
34626
34627 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34628 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34629 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34630 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34631 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34632 each day's messages.
34633
34634 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34635 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34636 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34637 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34638
34639
34640
34641 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34642 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34643 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34644 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34645 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34646 permanently connected.
34647
34648 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34649 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34650 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34651
34652
34653 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34654 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34655 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34656 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34657 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34658 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34659 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34660 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34661
34662 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34663 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34664 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34665 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34666 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34667 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34668 if required.
34669
34670 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34671 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34672 intermittent host. For example:
34673 .code
34674 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34675 .endd
34676 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34677 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34678 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34679 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34680 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34681 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34682 immediately.
34683
34684 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34685 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34686 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34687 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34688 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34689 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34690 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34691
34692
34693
34694 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34695 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34696 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34697 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34698 delivered immediately.
34699
34700 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34701 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34702 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34703 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34704 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34705 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34706 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34707 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34708 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34709 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34710 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34711 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34712 single SMTP connection.
34713
34714
34715
34716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34718
34719 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34720 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34721 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34722 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34723 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34724 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34725 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34726 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34727 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34728 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34729 messages this way.
34730
34731 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34732 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34733 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34734 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34735 email is not desirable.
34736
34737 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34738 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34739 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34740 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34741 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34742 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34743 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34744
34745 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34746 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34747 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34748 before sending a message to the smart host.
34749
34750 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34751 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34752 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34753
34754 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34755 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34756 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34757 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34758 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34759 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34760 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34761
34762 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34763 following ways:
34764
34765 .ilist
34766 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34767 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34768 .next
34769 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34770 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34771 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34772 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34773 successful, a zero return code is given.
34774 .next
34775 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34776 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34777 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34778 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34779 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34780 are.
34781 .next
34782 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34783 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34784 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34785 .next
34786 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34787 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34788 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34789 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34790 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34791 .next
34792 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34793 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34794 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34795 .next
34796 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34797 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34798 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34799 are ever generated.
34800 .next
34801 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34802 .next
34803 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34804 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34805 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34806 .endlist
34807
34808 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34809 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34810 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34811 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34812 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34813 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34814
34815
34816
34817
34818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34820
34821 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34822 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34823 .cindex "log" "types of"
34824 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34825 and the panic log:
34826
34827 .ilist
34828 .cindex "main log"
34829 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34830 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34831 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34832 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34833 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34834 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34835 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34836 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34837 .next
34838 .cindex "reject log"
34839 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34840 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34841 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34842 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34843 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34844 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34845 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34846 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34847 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34848 false.
34849 .next
34850 .cindex "panic log"
34851 .cindex "system log"
34852 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34853 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34854 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34855 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34856 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34857 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34858 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34859 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34860 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34861 .endlist
34862
34863 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34864 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34865 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34866 .code
34867 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34868 by QUIT
34869 .endd
34870 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34871 ways of changing this:
34872
34873 .ilist
34874 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34875 you set
34876 .code
34877 timezone = UTC
34878 .endd
34879 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34880 .next
34881 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34882 example:
34883 .code
34884 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34885 .endd
34886 .endlist
34887
34888 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34889 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34890 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34891 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34892 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34893 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34894
34895
34896
34897
34898 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34899 .cindex "log" "destination"
34900 .cindex "log" "to file"
34901 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34902 .cindex "syslog"
34903 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34904 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34905 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34906 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34907 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34908 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34909 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34910
34911 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34912 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34913 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34914 references to the host name:
34915 .code
34916 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34917 .endd
34918 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34919 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34920 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34921 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34922 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34923 log at all.
34924
34925 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34926 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34927 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34928 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34929 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34930 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34931 implying the use of a default path.
34932
34933 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34934 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34935 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34936 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34937 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34938 equivalent to the setting:
34939 .code
34940 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34941 .endd
34942 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34943 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34944 that is where the logs are written.
34945
34946 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34947 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34948
34949 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34950 .display
34951 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34952 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34953 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34954 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34955 .endd
34956 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34957 error is logged.
34958
34959
34960
34961 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34962 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34963 .cindex "cycling logs"
34964 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34965 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34966 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34967 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34968 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34969 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34970 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34971
34972 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34973 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34974 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34975 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34976 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34977 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34978 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34979 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34980 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34981 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34982 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34983 renamed.
34984
34985
34986
34987 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34988 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34989 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34990 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34991 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34992 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34993 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34994 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34995 .code
34996 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34997 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34998 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34999 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35000 .endd
35001 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35002 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35003 .code
35004 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35005 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35006 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35007 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35008 .endd
35009 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35010 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35011 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35012 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35013
35014 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35015 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35016 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35017 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35018 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35019 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35020 log names:
35021 .code
35022 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35023 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35024 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35025 /var/log/exim/panic
35026 .endd
35027
35028
35029 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35030 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35031 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35032 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35033 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35034 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35035 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35036 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35037 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35038 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35039 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35040 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35041 the time and host name to each line.
35042 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35043
35044 .ilist
35045 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35046 .next
35047 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35048 .next
35049 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35050 .endlist
35051
35052 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35053 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35054 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35055 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35056
35057 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35058 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35059 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35060 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35061 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35062 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35063 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35064 RFC 3164, you should set
35065 .code
35066 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35067 .endd
35068 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35069 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35070
35071 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35072 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35073 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35074 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35075 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35076 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35077 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35078 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35079 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35080 .code
35081 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35082 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35083 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35084 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35085 [5/5] mple>)
35086 .endd
35087 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35088 (LOG_NOTICE):
35089 .code
35090 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35091 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35092 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35093 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35094 [5\18] .example>)
35095 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35096 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35097 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35098 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35099 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35100 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35101 [12\18] F From: <>
35102 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35103 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35104 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35105 [16\18] le>
35106 [17\18] B Bcc:
35107 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35108 .endd
35109 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35110 without modification.
35111
35112 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35113 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35114 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35115 where it is.
35116
35117
35118
35119 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35120 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35121 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35122 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35123 timestamp. The flags are:
35124 .display
35125 &`<=`& message arrival
35126 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35127 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35128 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35129 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35130 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35131 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35132 .endd
35133
35134
35135 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35136 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35137 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35138 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35139 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35140 .code
35141 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35142 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35143 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35144 .endd
35145 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35146 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35147 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35148 .code
35149 R=<message id>
35150 .endd
35151 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35152
35153 .cindex "HELO"
35154 .cindex "EHLO"
35155 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35156 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35157 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35158 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35159 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35160 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35161 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35162 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35163 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35164 name in parentheses.
35165
35166 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35167 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35168 the log containing text like these examples:
35169 .code
35170 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35171 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35172 .endd
35173 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35174 on.
35175
35176 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35177 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35178 of Exim.
35179
35180 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35181 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35182 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35183 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35184 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35185 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35186 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35187 suite that was used.
35188
35189 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35190 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35191 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35192 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35193 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35194 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35195 authenticator name.
35196
35197 .cindex "size" "of message"
35198 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35199 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35200 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35201 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35202 other).
35203
35204 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35205 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35206
35207
35208
35209 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35210 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35211 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35212 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35213 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35214 to fit it on the page:
35215 .code
35216 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35217 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35218 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35219 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35220 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35221 .endd
35222 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35223 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35224 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35225 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35226 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35227
35228 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35229 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35230 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35231 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35232
35233 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35234 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35235 .display
35236 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35237 .endd
35238 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35239 parentheses afterwards.
35240
35241 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35242 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35243 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35244 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35245 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35246 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35247
35248 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35249 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35250 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35251 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35252 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35253
35254 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35255 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35256
35257 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35258 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35259
35260
35261 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35262 .cindex "discarded messages"
35263 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35264 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35265 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35266 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35267 .code
35268 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35269 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35270 .endd
35271 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35272 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35273 .code
35274 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35275 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35276 .endd
35277
35278
35279 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35280 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35281 .code
35282 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35283 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35284 .endd
35285 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35286 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35287 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35288 .code
35289 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35290 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35291 .endd
35292 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35293 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35294 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35295
35296
35297
35298 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35299 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35300 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35301 following form is logged:
35302 .code
35303 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35304 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35305 .endd
35306 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35307 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35308 .code
35309 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35310 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35311 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35312 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35313 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35314 .endd
35315 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35316 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35317 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35318 flagged with &`**`&.
35319
35320
35321
35322 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35323 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35324 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35325 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35326 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35327
35328
35329
35330 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35331 A line of the form
35332 .code
35333 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35334 .endd
35335 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35336 at the end of its processing.
35337
35338
35339
35340
35341 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35342 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35343 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35344 the following table:
35345 .display
35346 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35347 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35348 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35349 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35350 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35351 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35352 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35353 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35354 &`H `& host name and IP address
35355 &`I `& local interface used
35356 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35357 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35358 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35359 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35360 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35361 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35362 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35363 &`S `& size of message
35364 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35365 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35366 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35367 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35368 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35369 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35370 .endd
35371
35372
35373 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35374 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35375 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35376
35377 .ilist
35378 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35379 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35380 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35381 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35382 during the first delivery attempt.
35383 .next
35384 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35385 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35386 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35387 .next
35388 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35389 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35390 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35391 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35392 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35393 doing.
35394 .next
35395 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35396 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35397 message:
35398 .olist
35399 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35400 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35401 .next
35402 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35403 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35404 .next
35405 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35406 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35407 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35408 .code
35409 errors_to = <>
35410 .endd
35411 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35412 .endlist olist
35413 .endlist ilist
35414
35415
35416
35417
35418
35419 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35420 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35421 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35422 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35423 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35424 example:
35425 .code
35426 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35427 .endd
35428 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35429 selection marked by asterisks:
35430 .display
35431 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35432 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35433 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35434 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35435 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35436 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35437 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35438 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35439 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35440 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35441 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35442 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35443 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35444 .new
35445 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35446 .wen
35447 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35448 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35449 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35450 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35451 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35452 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35453 &` pid `& Exim process id
35454 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35455 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35456 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35457 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35458 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35459 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35460 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35461 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35462 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35463 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35464 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
35465 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35466 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35467 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35468 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35469 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35470 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35471 .new
35472 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35473 .wen
35474 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35475 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35476 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35477 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35478
35479 &` all `& all of the above
35480 .endd
35481 More details on each of these items follows:
35482
35483 .ilist
35484 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35485 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35486 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35487 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35488 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35489 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35490 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35491 .next
35492 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35493 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35494 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35495 this log selector is set.
35496 .next
35497 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35498 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35499 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35500 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35501 such users cannot access the log).
35502 .next
35503 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35504 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35505 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35506 parentheses between them.
35507 .next
35508 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35509 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35510 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35511 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35512 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35513 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35514 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35515 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35516 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35517 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35518 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35519 between the caller and Exim.
35520 .next
35521 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35522 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35523 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35524 .next
35525 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35526 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35527 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35528 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35529 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35530 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35531 .next
35532 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35533 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35534 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35535 .next
35536 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35537 .cindex "size" "of message"
35538 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35539 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35540 .next
35541 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35542 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35543 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35544 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35545 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35546 .next
35547 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35548 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35549 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35550 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35551 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35552 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35553 .next
35554 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35555 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35556 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35557 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35558 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35559 .next
35560 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35561 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35562 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35563 client's ident port times out.
35564 .next
35565 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35566 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35567 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35568 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35569 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35570 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35571 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35572 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35573 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35574 rejection lines
35575 .new
35576 and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35577 .wen
35578 .next
35579 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35580 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35581 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35582 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35583 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35584 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35585 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35586 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35587 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35588 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35589 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35590 .next
35591 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35592 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35593 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35594 .next
35595 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35596 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35597 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35598 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35599 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35600 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35601 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35602 .next
35603 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35604 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35605 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35606 immediately after the time and date.
35607 .next
35608 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35609 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35610 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35611 .next
35612 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35613 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35614 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35615 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35616 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35617 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35618 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35619 message has been successfully received.
35620 .next
35621 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35622 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35623 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35624 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35625 .next
35626 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35627 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35628 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35629 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35630 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35631 has taken place.
35632 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35633 in the list.
35634 .next
35635 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35636 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35637 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35638 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35639 .next
35640 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35641 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35642 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35643 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35644 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35645 .next
35646 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35647 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35648 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35649 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35650 attempt.
35651 .next
35652 .cindex "log" "return path"
35653 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35654 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35655 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35656 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35657 .next
35658 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35659 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35660 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35661 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35662 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35663 .next
35664 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35665 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35666 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35667 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35668 detail is lost.
35669 .next
35670 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35671 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35672 it is too big.
35673 .next
35674 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35675 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35676 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35677 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35678 it.
35679 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35680 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35681 .next
35682 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35683 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35684 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35685 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35686 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35687 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35688 response.
35689 .next
35690 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35691 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35692 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
35693 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35694 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35695 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35696 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35697 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35698 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35699 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35700
35701 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35702 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35703 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35704 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35705 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35706 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35707 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35708 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35709 .next
35710 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35711 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35712 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35713 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35714 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35715 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35716 .next
35717 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35718 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35719 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35720 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35721 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35722 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35723 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35724 already have their own log lines.
35725
35726 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35727 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35728 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35729 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35730 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35731 the same logging options.
35732
35733 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35734 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35735 .code
35736 C=EHLO,QUIT
35737 .endd
35738 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35739 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35740 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35741 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35742 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35743 .next
35744 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35745 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35746 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35747 was accepted or used.
35748 .next
35749 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35750 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35751 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35752 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35753 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35754 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35755 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35756 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35757 .next
35758 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35759 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35760 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35761 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35762 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35763 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35764 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35765 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35766 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35767 .next
35768 .cindex "log" "subject"
35769 .cindex "subject, logging"
35770 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35771 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35772 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35773 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35774 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35775 .next
35776 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35777 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35778 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35779 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35780 .next
35781 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35782 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35783 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35784 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35785 .next
35786 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35787 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35788 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35789 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35790 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35791 .next
35792 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35793 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35794 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35795 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35796 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35797 .next
35798 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35799 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35800 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35801 .endlist
35802
35803
35804 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35805 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35806 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35807 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35808 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35809 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35810 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35811 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35812 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35813 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35814 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35815 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35816 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35817
35818 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35819 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35820 &%message_logs%& option false.
35821 .ecindex IIDloggen
35822
35823
35824
35825
35826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35828
35829 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35830 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35831 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35832 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35833 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35834
35835 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35836 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35837 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35838 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35839 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35840 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35841 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35842 various criteria"
35843 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35844 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35845 "extract statistics from the log"
35846 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35847 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35848 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35849 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35850 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35851 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35852 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35853 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35854 .endtable
35855
35856 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35857 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35858 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35859
35860
35861
35862
35863 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35864 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35865 .cindex "process, querying"
35866 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35867 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35868 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35869 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35870 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35871 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35872 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35873 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35874 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35875
35876 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35877 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35878 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35879
35880
35881 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35882 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35883 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35884 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35885 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35886 options:
35887 .display
35888 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35889 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35890 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35891 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35892 .endd
35893 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35894 .code
35895 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35896 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35897 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35898 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35899 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35900 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35901 .endd
35902 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35903 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35904
35905
35906
35907 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35908 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35909 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35910 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35911 .code
35912 exim -bpu
35913 .endd
35914 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35915 .code
35916 exim -bp
35917 .endd
35918 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35919 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35920
35921 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35922 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35923
35924 .vlist
35925 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35926 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35927 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35928 .code
35929 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35930 .endd
35931 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35932 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35933 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35934
35935 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35936 Match against the size field.
35937
35938 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35939 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35940
35941 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35942 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35943
35944 .vitem &*-z*&
35945 Match only frozen messages.
35946
35947 .vitem &*-x*&
35948 Match only non-frozen messages.
35949 .endlist
35950
35951 The following options control the format of the output:
35952
35953 .vlist
35954 .vitem &*-c*&
35955 Display only the count of matching messages.
35956
35957 .vitem &*-l*&
35958 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35959 the default.
35960
35961 .vitem &*-i*&
35962 Display message ids only.
35963
35964 .vitem &*-b*&
35965 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35966
35967 .vitem &*-R*&
35968 Display messages in reverse order.
35969
35970 .vitem &*-a*&
35971 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35972 .endlist
35973
35974 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35975
35976
35977
35978 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35979 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35980 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35981 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35982 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35983 running a command such as
35984 .code
35985 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35986 .endd
35987 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35988 it, as in the following example:
35989 .code
35990 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35991 .endd
35992 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35993 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35994 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35995 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35996
35997 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35998 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35999 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36000 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36001 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36002 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36003 sender.
36004
36005 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36006 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36007 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36008 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36009 level"& addresses).
36010
36011
36012
36013
36014 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36015 "SECTextspeinf"
36016 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36017 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36018 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36019 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36020 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36021 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36022 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36023 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36024 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36025 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36026 .display
36027 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36028 .endd
36029 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36030
36031 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36032 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36033 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36034
36035 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36036 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36037 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36038 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36039 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36040
36041 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36042 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36043 regular expression.
36044
36045 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36046 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36047
36048 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36049 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36050 normally.
36051
36052 Example of &%-M%&:
36053 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36054 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36055 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36056 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36057 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36058 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36059 search term.
36060
36061 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36062 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36063 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36064 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36065 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36066
36067
36068 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36069 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36070 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36071 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36072 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36073 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36074 the &%--help%& option.
36075
36076
36077 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36078 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36079 .cindex "cycling logs"
36080 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36081 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36082 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36083 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36084 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36085 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36086 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36087 .ilist
36088 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36089 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36090 .next
36091 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36092 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36093 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36094 configuration.
36095 .endlist
36096
36097 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36098 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36099 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36100 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36101 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36102 logs are handled similarly.
36103
36104 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36105 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36106 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36107 any existing log files.
36108
36109 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36110 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36111 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36112 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36113 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36114 .code
36115 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36116 .endd
36117 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36118 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36119
36120
36121
36122 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36123 .cindex "statistics"
36124 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36125 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36126 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36127 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36128 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36129
36130 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36131 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36132 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36133 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36134 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36135 .code
36136 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36137 .endd
36138 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36139 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36140 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36141 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36142 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36143 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36144 also produced per user.
36145
36146 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36147 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36148 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36149 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36150 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36151
36152 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36153 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36154 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36155 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36156 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36157 an entirely separate message.
36158
36159 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36160 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36161 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36162 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36163 least one address that failed.
36164
36165 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36166 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36167 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36168 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36169 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36170 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36171 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36172
36173 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36174 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36175 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36176
36177 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36178 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36179 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36180 .code
36181 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36182 .endd
36183
36184 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36185 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36186 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36187 .cindex "checking access"
36188 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36189 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36190 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36191 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36192 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36193 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36194
36195 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36196 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36197 .code
36198 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36199 .endd
36200 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36201 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36202 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36203 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36204 .code
36205 Rejected:
36206 550 Relay not permitted
36207 .endd
36208 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36209 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36210 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36211 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36212 you can use:
36213 .code
36214 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36215 -f himself@there.example
36216 .endd
36217 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36218 mandatory arguments.
36219
36220 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36221 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36222 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36223
36224
36225
36226 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36227 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36228 .cindex "building DBM files"
36229 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36230 .cindex "lower casing"
36231 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36232 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36233 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36234 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36235 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36236 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36237
36238 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36239 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36240 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36241 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36242 files.
36243
36244 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36245 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36246 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36247 well.
36248
36249 .cindex "USE_DB"
36250 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36251 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36252 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36253 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36254 .code
36255 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36256 .endd
36257 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36258 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36259
36260 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36261 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36262 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36263 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36264 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36265 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36266
36267 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36268 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36269 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36270 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36271 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36272 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36273 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36274 return code is 2.
36275
36276
36277
36278
36279 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36280 .cindex "retry" "times"
36281 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36282 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36283 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36284 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36285 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36286 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36287 output. For example:
36288 .code
36289 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36290 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36291 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36292 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36293 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36294 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36295 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36296 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36297 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36298 past final cutoff time
36299 .endd
36300 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36301 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36302 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36303 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36304 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36305 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36306 run very often.
36307
36308 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36309 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36310 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36311 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36312 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36313 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36314
36315
36316
36317 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36318 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36319 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36320 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36321 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36322 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36323 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36324
36325 .ilist
36326 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36327 .next
36328 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36329 for remote hosts
36330 .next
36331 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36332 .next
36333 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36334 .next
36335 &'misc'&: other hints data
36336 .endlist
36337
36338 The &'misc'& database is used for
36339
36340 .ilist
36341 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36342 .next
36343 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36344 &(smtp)& transport)
36345 .endlist
36346
36347
36348
36349 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36350 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36351 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36352 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36353 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36354 .code
36355 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36356 .endd
36357 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36358 .code
36359 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36360 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36361 .endd
36362 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36363 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36364 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36365 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36366 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36367 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36368 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36369 and a textual description of the error.
36370
36371 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36372 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36373 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36374 exceeded.
36375
36376 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36377 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36378 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36379 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36380 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36381 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36382 cross-references.
36383
36384
36385
36386 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36387 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36388 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36389 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36390 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36391 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36392 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36393 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36394 updated sufficiently often.
36395
36396 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36397 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36398 the retry database:
36399 .code
36400 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36401 .endd
36402 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36403 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36404 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36405 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36406 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36407 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36408 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36409 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36410 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36411 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36412 whenever it removes information from the database.
36413
36414 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36415 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36416 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36417 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36418 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36419
36420 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36421 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36422 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36423 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36424 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36425 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36426 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36427 tidied.
36428
36429 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36430 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36431
36432
36433
36434
36435 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36436 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36437 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36438 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36439 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36440 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36441 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36442 displayed.
36443
36444 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36445 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36446 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36447 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36448 by new data, for example:
36449 .code
36450 > 4 951102:1000
36451 .endd
36452 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36453 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36454 used as optional separators.
36455
36456
36457
36458
36459 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36460 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36461 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36462 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36463 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36464 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36465 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36466 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36467 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36468 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36469 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36470 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36471 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36472
36473 .vlist
36474 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36475 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36476
36477 .vitem &%-flock%&
36478 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36479 supports it.
36480
36481 .vitem &%-interval%&
36482 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36483 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36484
36485 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36486 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36487
36488 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36489 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36490
36491 .vitem &%-q%&
36492 Suppress verification output.
36493
36494 .vitem &%-retries%&
36495 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36496 the lock (default 10).
36497
36498 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36499 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36500 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36501 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36502 subsequently sees.
36503
36504 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36505 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36506 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36507 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36508
36509 .vitem &%-v%&
36510 Generate verbose output.
36511 .endlist
36512
36513 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36514 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36515 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36516 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36517 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36518 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36519 more than 30 minutes old.
36520
36521 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36522 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36523 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36524 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36525 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36526 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36527
36528 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36529 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36530 suppresses all output except error messages.
36531
36532 A command such as
36533 .code
36534 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36535 .endd
36536 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36537 .display
36538 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36539 <&'some commands'&>
36540 &`End`&
36541 .endd
36542 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36543 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36544 such as
36545 .code
36546 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36547 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36548 .endd
36549 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36550 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36551 .ecindex IIDutils
36552
36553
36554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36556
36557 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36558 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36559 .cindex "X-windows"
36560 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36561 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36562 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36563 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36564 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36565 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36566 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36567 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36568
36569
36570
36571 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36572 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36573 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36574 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36575 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36576 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36577 parameters are for.
36578
36579 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36580 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36581 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36582 .code
36583 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36584 .endd
36585 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36586 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36587 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36588 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36589 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36590
36591 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36592 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36593 .code
36594 Eximon*background: gray94
36595 .endd
36596 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36597 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36598 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36599 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36600 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36601 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36602 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36603 .code
36604 xrdb -merge <<End
36605 Eximon*highlight: gray
36606 End
36607 .endd
36608 .cindex "admin user"
36609 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36610 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36611
36612 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36613 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36614 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36615 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36616 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36617
36618 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36619 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36620 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36621 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36622 different parts of the display.
36623
36624
36625
36626
36627 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36628 .cindex "stripchart"
36629 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36630 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36631 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36632 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36633 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36634 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36635 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36636 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36637 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36638
36639 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36640 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36641 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36642 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36643
36644 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36645 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36646 to a single partition.
36647
36648 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36649 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36650 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36651 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36652 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36653 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36654 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36655
36656
36657
36658
36659 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36660 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36661 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36662 .cindex "window size"
36663 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36664 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36665 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36666 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36667 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36668 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36669
36670 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36671 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36672 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36673 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36674
36675 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36676 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36677 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36678 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36679 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36680 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36681
36682 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36683 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36684 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36685
36686
36687
36688 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36689 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36690 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36691 the main log is maintained.
36692 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36693 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36694 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36695 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36696 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36697
36698 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36699 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36700 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36701 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36702 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36703 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36704 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36705 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36706 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36707 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36708 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36709
36710 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36711 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36712 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36713 It cannot go further back up the log.
36714
36715 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36716 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36717 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36718 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36719 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36720 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36721
36722 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36723 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36724 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36725 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36726 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36727 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36728
36729 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36730 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36731 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36732 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36733 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36734 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36735 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36736 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36737 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36738 window.
36739
36740
36741
36742 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36743 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36744 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36745 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36746 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36747 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36748 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36749 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36750 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36751 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36752
36753 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36754 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36755 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36756 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36757 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36758 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36759 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36760
36761 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36762 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36763 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36764 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36765 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36766 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36767 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36768
36769 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36770 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36771 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36772 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36773
36774 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36775 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36776 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36777 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36778 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36779 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36780 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36781 not shown.
36782
36783 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36784 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36785
36786 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36787 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36788 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36789 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36790 display is updated.
36791
36792
36793
36794 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36795 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36796 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36797 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36798 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36799 any selected text.
36800
36801 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36802 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36803 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36804 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36805 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36806 .code
36807 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36808 .endd
36809 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36810 follows:
36811
36812 .ilist
36813 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36814 in a new text window.
36815 .next
36816 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36817 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36818 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36819 .next
36820 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36821 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36822 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36823 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36824 .next
36825 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36826 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36827 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36828 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36829 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36830 .next
36831 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36832 that the message be frozen.
36833 .next
36834 .cindex "thawing messages"
36835 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36836 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36837 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36838 that the message be thawed.
36839 .next
36840 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36841 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36842 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36843 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36844 .next
36845 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36846 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36847 message.
36848 .next
36849 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36850 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36851 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36852 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36853 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36854 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36855 which case no action is taken.
36856 .next
36857 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36858 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36859 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36860 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36861 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36862 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36863 case no action is taken.
36864 .next
36865 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36866 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36867 .next
36868 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36869 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36870 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36871 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36872 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36873 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36874 the address is qualified with that domain.
36875 .endlist
36876
36877 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36878 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36879 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36880 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36881 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36882 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36883 if no output is generated.
36884
36885 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36886 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36887 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36888 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36889
36890 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36891 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36892 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36893 .ecindex IIDeximon
36894
36895
36896
36897
36898
36899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36901
36902 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36903 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36904 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36905 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36906
36907 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36908 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36909 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36910 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36911 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36912 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36913
36914 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36915 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36916 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36917 as soon as possible.
36918
36919
36920 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36921 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36922 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36923 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36924 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36925 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36926
36927 .ilist
36928 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36929 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36930 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36931 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36932 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36933 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36934
36935 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36936 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36937 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36938 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36939 .next
36940
36941 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36942 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36943 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36944 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36945 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36946 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36947 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36948 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36949 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36950 separate commands.
36951
36952 .next
36953 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36954 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36955 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36956 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36957 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36958 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36959 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36960 .next
36961 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36962 is disabled.
36963 .next
36964 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36965 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36966 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36967 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36968 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36969 .endlist
36970
36971
36972
36973 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36974 .cindex "setuid"
36975 .cindex "root privilege"
36976 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36977 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36978 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36979 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36980 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36981 is required for two things:
36982
36983 .ilist
36984 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36985 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36986 not required.
36987 .next
36988 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36989 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36990 configuration.
36991 .endlist
36992
36993 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36994 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36995 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36996 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36997 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36998 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36999 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37000 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37001
37002 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37003 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37004 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37005
37006 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37007 uid and gid in the following cases:
37008
37009 .ilist
37010 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37011 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37012 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37013 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37014 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37015 the calling process.
37016 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37017 option may not be used at all.
37018 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37019 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37020 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37021 .next
37022 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37023 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37024 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37025 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37026 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37027 calling process.
37028 .next
37029 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37030 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37031 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37032 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37033 testing address verification
37034 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37035 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37036 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37037 option).
37038 .next
37039 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37040 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37041 .endlist
37042
37043 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37044
37045 .ilist
37046 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37047 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37048 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37049 will be used during message reception.
37050 .next
37051 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37052 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37053 .next
37054 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37055 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37056 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37057 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37058 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37059 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37060 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37061 generating bounce and warning messages.
37062
37063 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37064 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37065 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37066 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37067 .next
37068 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37069 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37070 .endlist
37071
37072
37073
37074
37075 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37076 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37077 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37078 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37079 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37080 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37081 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37082 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37083 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37084 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37085 to any other uid.
37086
37087 .cindex SIGHUP
37088 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37089 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37090 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37091 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37092
37093 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37094 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37095 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37096 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37097 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37098
37099 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37100 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37101 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37102 effect.
37103
37104 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37105 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37106 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37107
37108 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37109 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37110 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37111 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37112 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37113 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37114 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37115 address this problem at this time.
37116
37117 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37118 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37119 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37120 be used in the most straightforward way.
37121
37122 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37123 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37124
37125 .ilist
37126 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37127 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37128 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37129 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37130 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37131 .next
37132 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37133 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37134 .next
37135 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37136 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37137 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37138 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37139 .next
37140 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37141 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37142
37143 .olist
37144 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37145 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37146 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37147 .next
37148 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37149 owned by the Exim user.
37150 .next
37151 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37152 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37153 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37154 .endlist olist
37155 .endlist ilist
37156
37157
37158 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37159 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37160 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37161 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37162
37163 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37164 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37165
37166
37167
37168
37169 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37170 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37171 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37172
37173
37174
37175 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37176 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37177 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37178 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37179 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37180 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37181 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37182
37183 .ilist
37184 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37185 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37186 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37187 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37188 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37189 .next
37190 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37191 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37192 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37193 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37194 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37195 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37196 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37197 .next
37198 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37199 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37200 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37201 .next
37202 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37203 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37204 .next
37205 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
37206 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37207 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37208 .next
37209 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37210 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37211 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37212 of opaque strings.
37213 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37214 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37215 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37216 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37217 .endlist
37218
37219
37220
37221
37222 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37223 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37224 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37225 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37226 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37227 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37228 are some issues to be aware of:
37229
37230 .ilist
37231 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37232 .next
37233 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37234 .next
37235 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37236 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37237 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37238 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37239 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37240 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37241 data.
37242 .next
37243 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37244 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37245 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37246 .next
37247 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37248 expected to yield one result.
37249 .endlist
37250
37251
37252
37253
37254 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37255 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37256 .cindex "IP source routing"
37257 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37258 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37259 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37260 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37261
37262
37263
37264 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37265 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37266 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37267
37268
37269
37270
37271 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37272 .cindex "trusted users"
37273 .cindex "admin user"
37274 .cindex "privileged user"
37275 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37276 .cindex "user" "admin"
37277 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37278 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37279 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37280 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37281 permit a remote host to be specified.
37282
37283 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37284 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37285 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37286 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37287 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37288 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37289 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37290
37291 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37292 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37293 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37294 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37295 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37296
37297 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37298 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37299 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37300 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37301 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37302
37303 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37304 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37305 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37306 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37307 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37308 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37309 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37310 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37311
37312 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37313 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37314 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37315 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37316 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37317 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37318 files.
37319
37320
37321
37322 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37323 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37324 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37325 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37326 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37327 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37328
37329
37330
37331 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37332 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37333 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37334 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37335 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37336 this.
37337
37338
37339
37340 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37341 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37342 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37343 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37344 converted output.
37345
37346
37347
37348 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37349 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37350 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37351 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37352 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37353
37354
37355
37356 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37357 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37358 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37359 loading it.
37360
37361
37362 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37363 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37364 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37365 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37366 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37367 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37368 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37369
37370 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37371 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37372 string.
37373
37374
37375
37376 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37377 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37378 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37379 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37380
37381
37382
37383 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37384 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37385 enough to hold the result.
37386 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37387
37388
37389
37390
37391 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37393
37394 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37395 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37396 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37397 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37398 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37399 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37400 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37401 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37402 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37403 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37404 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37405 themselves are recoverable.
37406
37407 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37408 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37409 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37410
37411 .ilist
37412 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37413 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37414 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37415 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37416 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37417 .next
37418 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37419 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37420 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37421 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37422 will always be the case.
37423 .next
37424 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37425 .next
37426 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37427 signature.
37428 .endlist
37429 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37430
37431 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37432 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37433 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37434 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37435 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37436 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37437 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37438 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37439 attempt.
37440
37441 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37442 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37443 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37444 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37445 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37446 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37447 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37448 normally the Exim user.
37449
37450 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37451 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37452 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37453 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37454 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37455 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37456 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37457 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37458
37459 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37460 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37461 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37462 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37463
37464 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37465 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37466
37467 .vlist
37468 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37469 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37470 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37471 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37472 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37473 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37474 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37475 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37476 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37477 newlines.
37478
37479 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37480 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37481 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37482 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37483 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37484 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37485
37486 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37487 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37488 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37489 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37490 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37491 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37492
37493 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37494 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37495 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37496
37497 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37498 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37499 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37500 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37501 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37502
37503 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37504 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37505 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37506 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37507 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37508
37509 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37510 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37511 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37512
37513 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37514 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37515 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37516
37517 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37518 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37519 present.
37520
37521 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37522 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37523 present if the number is greater than zero.
37524
37525 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37526 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37527 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37528
37529 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37530 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37531 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37532
37533 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37534 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37535 command.
37536
37537 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37538 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37539 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37540 messages.
37541
37542 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37543 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37544 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37545 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37546
37547 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37548 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37549 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37550
37551 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37552 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37553 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37554 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37555 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37556 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37557
37558 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37559 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37560 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37561 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37562 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37563
37564 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37565 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37566 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37567 generated messages.
37568
37569 .vitem &%-local%&
37570 The message is from a local sender.
37571
37572 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37573 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37574
37575 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37576 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37577 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37578 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37579
37580 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37581 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37582 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37583
37584 .vitem &%-N%&
37585 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37586 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37587 &%-N%& is assumed.
37588
37589 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37590 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37591 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37592
37593 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37594 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37595 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37596
37597 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37598 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37599 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37600
37601 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37602 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37603 certificate was verified by the server.
37604
37605 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37606 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37607 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37608
37609 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37610 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37611 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37612 certificate.
37613 .endlist
37614
37615 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37616 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37617 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37618 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37619 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37620 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37621 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37622 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37623 addresses are complete.
37624
37625 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37626 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37627 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37628 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37629 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37630 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37631 .code
37632 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37633 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37634 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37635 .endd
37636 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37637 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37638 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37639 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37640 example:
37641 .code
37642 4
37643 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37644 darcy@austen.fict.example
37645 rdo@foundation
37646 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37647 .endd
37648 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37649 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37650 line is of the following form:
37651 .display
37652 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37653 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37654 .endd
37655 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37656 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37657 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37658 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37659 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37660 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37661 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37662 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37663
37664
37665 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37666 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37667 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37668 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37669 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37670 following:
37671
37672 .table2 50pt
37673 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37674 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37675 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37676 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37677 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37678 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37679 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37680 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37681 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37682 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37683 .endtable
37684
37685 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37686 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37687 typical set of headers:
37688 .code
37689 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37690 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37691 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37692 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37693 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37694 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37695 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37696 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37697 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37698 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37699 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37700 .endd
37701 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37702 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37703 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37704 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37705 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37706 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37707
37708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37710
37711 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37712 "DKIM Support"
37713 .cindex "DKIM"
37714
37715 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37716 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37717 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37718 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37719
37720 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37721 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37722
37723 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37724 .olist
37725 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37726 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37727 (including transport filters)
37728 except cutthrough delivery.
37729 .next
37730 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37731 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37732 different signature contexts.
37733 .endlist
37734
37735 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37736 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37737 Exim's standard controls.
37738
37739 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37740 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37741 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37742 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37743 .code
37744 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37745 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37746 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37747 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37748 .endd
37749 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37750 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37751 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37752 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37753 senders).
37754
37755
37756 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37757 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37758
37759 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37760 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37761
37762 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37763 MANDATORY:
37764 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37765 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37766
37767 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37768 MANDATORY:
37769 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37770 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37771 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37772 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37773
37774 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37775 MANDATORY:
37776 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37777 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37778 The result can either
37779 .ilist
37780 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37781 .next
37782 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37783 the private key.
37784 .next
37785 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37786 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37787 is set.
37788 .endlist
37789
37790 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37791 OPTIONAL:
37792 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37793 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37794 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37795 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37796
37797 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37798 OPTIONAL:
37799 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37800 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37801 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37802 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37803 variables here.
37804
37805 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37806 OPTIONAL:
37807 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37808 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37809 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37810 used.
37811
37812
37813 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37814 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37815
37816 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37817 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37818 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37819 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37820 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37821 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37822 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37823
37824 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37825 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37826 runtime of the ACL.
37827
37828 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37829 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37830 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37831 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37832
37833 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37834 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37835 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37836 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37837 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37838 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37839 it defaults as:
37840 .code
37841 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37842 .endd
37843 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37844 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37845 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37846 .code
37847 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37848 .endd
37849 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37850 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37851 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37852 .code
37853 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37854 .endd
37855
37856 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37857 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37858
37859
37860 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37861 available (from most to least important):
37862
37863
37864 .vlist
37865 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37866 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37867 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37868 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37869 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37870 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37871 .ilist
37872 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37873 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37874 .next
37875 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37876 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37877 .next
37878 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37879 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37880 .next
37881 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37882 .endlist
37883 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37884 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37885 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37886 .ilist
37887 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37888 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37889 .next
37890 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37891 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37892 .next
37893 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37894 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37895 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37896 .next
37897 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37898 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37899 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37900 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37901 .endlist
37902 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37903 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37904 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37905 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37906 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37907 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37908 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37909 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37910 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37911 The key record selector string.
37912 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37913 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37914 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37915 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37916 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37917 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37918 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37919 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37920 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37921 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37922 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37923 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37924 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37925 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37926 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37927 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37928 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37929 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37930 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37931 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37932 integer size comparisons against this value.
37933 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37934 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37935 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37936 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37937 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37938 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37939 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37940 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37941 in the key record.
37942 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37943 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37944 in the key record.
37945 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37946 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37947 .endlist
37948
37949 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37950
37951 .vlist
37952 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37953 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37954 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37955 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37956 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37957
37958 .code
37959 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37960 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37961 sender_domains = gmail.com
37962 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37963 dkim_status = none
37964 .endd
37965
37966 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37967 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37968 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37969 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37970
37971 .code
37972 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37973 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37974 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37975 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37976 .endd
37977
37978 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37979 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37980 for more information of what they mean.
37981 .endlist
37982
37983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37985
37986 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37987 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37988 .cindex "adding drivers"
37989 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37990 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37991 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37992 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37993
37994 .olist
37995 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37996 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37997 .next
37998 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37999 .display
38000 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38001 .endd
38002 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38003 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38004 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38005 .next
38006 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38007 .code
38008 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38009 .endd
38010 .next
38011 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38012 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38013 .next
38014 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38015 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38016 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38017 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38018 simple form that most lookups have.
38019 .next
38020 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38021 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38022 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38023 .next
38024 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38025 &_src_&.
38026 .next
38027 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38028 as for other drivers and lookups.
38029 .endlist
38030
38031 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38032 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38033 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38034 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38035 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38036
38037 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38038 the interface that is expected.
38039
38040
38041
38042
38043 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38044 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38045
38046 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38047 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38048 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38049 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38050 . processors.
38051 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38052
38053 .literal xml
38054 <?sdop
38055 format="newpage"
38056 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38057 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38058 ?>
38059 .literal off
38060
38061 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38062 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38063 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38064
38065
38066 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38067 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////